Ricoh C242sf User Manual

Operating Instructions  
User Guide  
Guide to the Machine  
Getting Started  
1
2
Using the Printer Function  
Using the Copier Function  
Using the Scanner Function  
Using the Fax Function  
3
4
5
6
Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
7
Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
8
Troubleshooting  
Maintenance  
Appendix  
9
10  
11  
Read this manual carefully before you use this machine and keep it handy for future reference. For safe and correct use, be sure to read "Safety  
Information" before using the machine.  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
Introduction.......................................................................................................................................................11  
Trademarks...................................................................................................................................................11  
Disclaimer.....................................................................................................................................................13  
Manuals for This Machine...............................................................................................................................14  
List of Option.....................................................................................................................................................17  
How to Read This Manual...............................................................................................................................18  
Symbols........................................................................................................................................................18  
Notes............................................................................................................................................................18  
About IP Address.........................................................................................................................................18  
Using Manuals.................................................................................................................................................19  
Installing Manuals on Your Computer.......................................................................................................19  
Opening Manuals.......................................................................................................................................20  
Removing Manuals from Your Computer..................................................................................................21  
Feature Highlights............................................................................................................................................22  
Using the Machine as a Printer...................................................................................................................22  
Using the Machine as a Copier..................................................................................................................24  
Using the Machine as a Scanner...............................................................................................................27  
Using the Machine as a Fax Machine.......................................................................................................31  
Exterior: Front View......................................................................................................................................34  
Exterior: Rear View......................................................................................................................................35  
Interior...........................................................................................................................................................37  
Control Panel................................................................................................................................................38  
Installing the Machine......................................................................................................................................43  
Where to Put the Machine..........................................................................................................................43  
Unpacking....................................................................................................................................................46  
Turning the Power on...................................................................................................................................56  
Initial Setup...................................................................................................................................................59  
Changing Operation Modes......................................................................................................................60  
Saving Energy..............................................................................................................................................61  
1
Multi-access.................................................................................................................................................62  
Connecting the Machine.................................................................................................................................67  
Connecting with a Computer Using a USB Cable....................................................................................67  
Connecting with a Digital Camera Using a USB Cable...........................................................................68  
Connecting to a Telephone Line.................................................................................................................71  
Configuring the Machine.................................................................................................................................74  
Configuring the IPv4 Address Settings.......................................................................................................74  
Configuring the IPv6 Address Settings.......................................................................................................76  
Configuring Telephone Network Settings..................................................................................................79  
Sharing the Printer on a Network...................................................................................................................82  
Installing Option...............................................................................................................................................83  
Installing the Paper Feed Unit (Tray 2).......................................................................................................83  
Paper and Other Media..................................................................................................................................86  
Supported Paper for Each Tray..................................................................................................................86  
Specifications of Paper Types.....................................................................................................................90  
Unsupported Types of Paper......................................................................................................................96  
Paper Storage Precautions..........................................................................................................................97  
Printable Area..............................................................................................................................................97  
Loading Paper..................................................................................................................................................99  
Loading Paper in Tray 1..............................................................................................................................99  
Loading Paper in Tray 2...........................................................................................................................108  
Loading Paper in the Bypass Tray............................................................................................................111  
Loading Envelopes....................................................................................................................................113  
Specifying Paper Type and Paper Size...................................................................................................118  
Placing Originals...........................................................................................................................................122  
About Originals.........................................................................................................................................122  
Placing Originals.......................................................................................................................................124  
Entering Characters.......................................................................................................................................127  
Restricting Machine Functions According to User.......................................................................................129  
Enabling the User Restriction Settings......................................................................................................129  
When Machine Functions are Restricted.....................................................................................................133  
2
Windows....................................................................................................................................................135  
Mac OS X 10.3.........................................................................................................................................136  
Mac OS X 10.4.........................................................................................................................................136  
Mac OS X 10.5/10.6..............................................................................................................................136  
Accessing the Printer Properties....................................................................................................................138  
Accessing the Printer Properties from an Application.............................................................................138  
Basic Operation in Printer Mode..................................................................................................................140  
If a Paper Mismatch Occurs.....................................................................................................................140  
Canceling a Print Job................................................................................................................................141  
Storing a Locked Print file.........................................................................................................................143  
Printing a Locked Print file.........................................................................................................................144  
Deleting a Locked Print file.......................................................................................................................145  
Checking which Locked Print File Jobs Have Been Canceled...............................................................146  
What Is PictBridge?...................................................................................................................................149  
PictBridge Printing......................................................................................................................................149  
What Can Be Done on this Machine.......................................................................................................150  
Exiting PictBridge.......................................................................................................................................151  
When PictBridge Printing Does Not Work..............................................................................................151  
Using Various Print Functions........................................................................................................................153  
Print Quality Functions...............................................................................................................................153  
The Screen in Copier Mode.........................................................................................................................157  
Canceling a Copy.....................................................................................................................................160  
Making Enlarged or Reduced Copies.........................................................................................................162  
Copying Two or Four Pages onto One Sheet.........................................................................................164  
3
Copying Both Sides of an ID Card onto One Side of Paper.................................................................166  
Making 2-sided Copies................................................................................................................................169  
Specifying Scan Settings...............................................................................................................................172  
Adjusting Image Density...........................................................................................................................172  
Selecting the Document Type According to Original.............................................................................173  
The Screen in Scanner Mode.......................................................................................................................175  
Registering Scan Destinations.......................................................................................................................177  
Deleting Scan Destinations.......................................................................................................................183  
Scanning Using the Control Panel................................................................................................................184  
Basic Operation for Scan to E-mail/FTP/Folder....................................................................................184  
Scanning from a Computer...........................................................................................................................194  
The Screen in Fax Mode...............................................................................................................................199  
Setting the Date and Time.............................................................................................................................201  
Registering Fax Destinations.........................................................................................................................203  
Registering Fax Destinations Using the Control Panel............................................................................203  
Registering Fax Destinations Using Web Image Monitor......................................................................206  
Sending a Fax................................................................................................................................................209  
Selecting Transmission Mode...................................................................................................................209  
Internet Fax Transmission Overview........................................................................................................210  
Basic Operation for Sending a Fax.........................................................................................................211  
Specifying the Fax Destination.................................................................................................................214  
Useful Sending Functions..........................................................................................................................218  
Using the Fax Function from a Computer (LAN-Fax)..................................................................................223  
Configuring the LAN-Fax Address Book.................................................................................................223  
Basic Operation for Sending Faxes from a Computer...........................................................................230  
Editing a Fax Cover Sheet........................................................................................................................232  
4
Configuring Transmission Settings............................................................................................................234  
Selecting Reception Mode.......................................................................................................................237  
Forwarding or Storing Faxes in Memory................................................................................................241  
Receiving or Rejecting Faxes from Special Senders...............................................................................245  
Basic Operation Using the Menu Screen....................................................................................................247  
Menu Chart....................................................................................................................................................249  
Copy Settings.................................................................................................................................................253  
Changing Copy Settings...........................................................................................................................253  
Copy Setting Parameters..........................................................................................................................254  
Scanner Settings............................................................................................................................................259  
Changing Scanner Settings......................................................................................................................259  
Scanner Setting Parameters......................................................................................................................260  
Fax Transmission Settings..............................................................................................................................262  
Changing Fax Transmission Settings........................................................................................................262  
Fax Transmission Setting Parameters.......................................................................................................263  
Changing Fax Feature Settings................................................................................................................265  
Fax Feature Setting Parameters................................................................................................................265  
Registering Fax Destinations in Fax Quick Dial/Speed Dial.................................................................272  
Fax Address Book Parameters.................................................................................................................272  
Changing System Settings........................................................................................................................274  
System Setting Parameters........................................................................................................................274  
Changing Network Settings.....................................................................................................................283  
Network Setting Parameters.....................................................................................................................283  
Printing Lists/Reports.....................................................................................................................................287  
5
Types of Report..........................................................................................................................................287  
Reading the Configuration Page..............................................................................................................288  
Reading the Fax Journal...........................................................................................................................291  
Reading the TX/RX Standby File List........................................................................................................292  
Administrator Settings....................................................................................................................................295  
Changing Administrator Settings..............................................................................................................295  
Administrator Setting Parameters.............................................................................................................295  
Printer Feature Settings..................................................................................................................................300  
Changing Printer Feature Settings............................................................................................................300  
Printer Feature Setting Parameters...........................................................................................................300  
Using Web Image Monitor...........................................................................................................................305  
Displaying Top Page.....................................................................................................................................307  
Changing the Interface Language...........................................................................................................308  
Checking the System Information.................................................................................................................309  
Checking the Counter Information...........................................................................................................310  
Configuring the System Settings...................................................................................................................315  
Configuring the Sound Volume................................................................................................................315  
Configuring the Paper Settings.................................................................................................................316  
Specifying the Size of Paper for Printing Copies....................................................................................318  
Configuring the Fax Settings.....................................................................................................................318  
Specifying the Priority Tray.......................................................................................................................321  
Configuring the Toner Saving Setting......................................................................................................322  
Configuring the Black-and-White Print Priority Settings.........................................................................324  
Registering Destinations................................................................................................................................325  
Registering Fax Special Senders..................................................................................................................326  
Restricting Machine Functions According to User.......................................................................................327  
Configuring the Network Settings................................................................................................................328  
Checking the Network Status...................................................................................................................328  
6
Configuring the IPv6 Settings...................................................................................................................329  
Configuring the Network Application Settings.......................................................................................330  
Configuring the DNS Settings..................................................................................................................331  
Configuring the Auto E-mail Notification Settings..................................................................................332  
Configuring the SNMP Settings...............................................................................................................333  
Configuring the SMTP Settings.................................................................................................................335  
Configuring the POP3 Settings.................................................................................................................336  
Configuring the Internet Fax Settings.......................................................................................................337  
Configuring the IPsec Global Settings.....................................................................................................339  
Configuring the IPsec Policy.....................................................................................................................340  
Printing Lists/Reports.....................................................................................................................................345  
Configuring the Administrator Settings.........................................................................................................347  
Configuring the Administrator Password and E-mail Address...............................................................347  
Resetting the Machine’s Settings..............................................................................................................348  
Restoring the Machine's Settings from a Backup File.............................................................................350  
Configuring the Date and Time Settings..................................................................................................351  
Overview........................................................................................................................................................353  
Removing Printing Jams.............................................................................................................................358  
Removing Scanning Jams.........................................................................................................................364  
Print Quality Problems...................................................................................................................................369  
Checking the Condition of the Machine..................................................................................................369  
Printer Problems.............................................................................................................................................370  
Changing the Printer Driver Settings........................................................................................................372  
Printed Colors Do Not Match Displayed Colors....................................................................................373  
Print Positions Do Not Match Display Positions......................................................................................373  
Copier Problems............................................................................................................................................374  
Scanner Problems..........................................................................................................................................376  
7
Fax Problems..................................................................................................................................................377  
Error and Status Messages on the Screen...................................................................................................383  
Replacing Print Cartridges............................................................................................................................393  
Replacing the Waste Toner Bottle................................................................................................................399  
Cleaning.........................................................................................................................................................405  
Cautions to Take When Cleaning............................................................................................................405  
Cleaning the Toner Density Sensor..........................................................................................................406  
Cleaning the Friction Pad and Paper Feed Roller...................................................................................408  
Cleaning the Registration Roller and Paper Tray....................................................................................410  
Cleaning the Exposure Glass...................................................................................................................414  
Moving the Machine.....................................................................................................................................415  
Moving over a Long Distance..................................................................................................................416  
Disposal..........................................................................................................................................................418  
If the Machine is Not Going to Be Used for a Long Time..........................................................................419  
Preparing the Machine for a Long Period of Inactivity...........................................................................419  
Where to Inquire............................................................................................................................................422  
Print Cartridges..........................................................................................................................................423  
Waste Toner Bottle....................................................................................................................................424  
Functions and Network Settings Available in an IPv6 Environment..........................................................425  
Available Functions...................................................................................................................................425  
Transmission Using IPsec...............................................................................................................................427  
Encryption and Authentication by IPsec..................................................................................................427  
Security Association..................................................................................................................................428  
Encryption Key Exchange Settings Configuration Flow.........................................................................429  
Specifying Encryption Key Exchange Settings........................................................................................429  
Specifying IPsec Settings on the Computer.............................................................................................430  
Enabling and Disabling IPsec Using the Control Panel..........................................................................432  
8
Specifications of the Machine......................................................................................................................433  
General Function Specifications..............................................................................................................433  
Printer Function Specifications..................................................................................................................435  
Copier Function Specifications.................................................................................................................435  
Fax Function Specifications......................................................................................................................438  
Specifications of Options..............................................................................................................................441  
Electromagnetic Interference........................................................................................................................442  
Copyright Information about Installed Applications...................................................................................443  
JPEG LIBRARY............................................................................................................................................443  
INDEX...........................................................................................................................................................445  
9
10  
1. Guide to the Machine  
This chapter provides basic information about the product and this manual.  
1
Introduction  
This manual contains detailed instructions and notes on the operation and use of this machine. For your  
safety and benefit, read this manual carefully before using the machine. Keep this manual in a handy  
place for quick reference.  
Trademarks  
®
®
®
®
®
Microsoft , Windows , Windows Server , Windows Vista , and Internet Explorer are either  
registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other  
countries.  
®
®
The proper name of Internet Explorer 6 is Microsoft Internet Explorer 6.  
Adobe, Acrobat, PostScript, and Reader are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Adobe  
Systems Incorporated in the United States and/or other countries.  
®
PCL is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.  
Apple, Bonjour, Macintosh, Mac OS, TrueType, and Safari are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in  
the U.S. and other countries.  
®
Firefox is a registered trademark of the Mozilla Foundation.  
®
LINUX is the registered trademark of Linus Torvalds in the U.S. and other countries.  
“Presto! PageManager” and “NewSoft” are trademarks and/or registered trademarks of NewSoft  
Technology Corporation subject to trademark protection of domestic trademark laws and international  
trademark conventions.  
PictBridge is a trademark.  
RED HAT is a registered trademark of Red Hat, Inc.  
Solaris is a trademark or registered trademark of Sun Microsystems, Inc. in the United States and other  
countries.  
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and might be trademarks of their  
respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights to those marks.  
The proper names of the Windows operating systems are as follows:  
• The product names of Windows XP are as follows:  
®
®
Microsoft Windows XP Professional Edition  
®
®
Microsoft Windows XP Home Edition  
®
®
Microsoft Windows XP Professional x64 Edition  
11  
       
1. Guide to the Machine  
• The product names of Windows Vista are as follows:  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Vista Ultimate  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Vista Business  
®
®
1
Microsoft Windows Vista Home Premium  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Vista Home Basic  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Vista Enterprise  
• The product names of Windows 7 are as follows:  
®
®
Microsoft Windows 7 Starter  
®
®
Microsoft Windows 7 Home Premium  
®
®
Microsoft Windows 7 Professional  
®
®
Microsoft Windows 7 Ultimate  
®
®
Microsoft Windows 7 Enterprise  
• The product names of Windows Server 2003 are as follows:  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Server 2003 Standard Edition  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Server 2003 Enterprise Edition  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Server 2003 Web Edition  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Server 2003 Datacenter Edition  
• The product names of Windows Server 2003 R2 are as follows:  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 Standard Edition  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 Enterprise Edition  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 Datacenter Edition  
• The product names of Windows Server 2008 are as follows:  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Server 2008 Foundation  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Server 2008 Standard  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Server 2008 Enterprise  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Server 2008 Datacenter  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Server 2008 for Itanium-based Systems  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Web Server 2008  
®
®
Microsoft Windows HPC Server 2008  
®
®
TM  
TM  
Microsoft Windows Server 2008 Standard without Hyper-V  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Server 2008 Enterprise without Hyper-V  
®
®
TM  
Microsoft Windows Server 2008 Datacenter without Hyper-V  
• The product names of Windows Server 2008 R2 are as follows:  
12  
Introduction  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Server 2008 R2 Foundation  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Server 2008 R2 Standard  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Server 2008 R2 Enterprise  
®
®
1
Microsoft Windows Server 2008 R2 Datacenter  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Server 2008 R2 for Itanium-based Systems  
®
®
Microsoft Windows Web Server R2 2008  
®
®
Microsoft Windows HPC Server R2 2008  
®
• PostScript 3 in this manual stands for “Adobe PostScript 3 Emulation”.  
Disclaimer  
In no event will the company be liable for direct, indirect, special, incidental, or consequential damages  
as a result of handling or operating the machine.  
This manual may not be reproduced in whole or in part, modified, quoted, or reprinted without  
permission.  
13  
   
1. Guide to the Machine  
Manuals for This Machine  
Several manuals are provided with this machine. Select the manual that contains the information you  
require.  
1
• Media differ according to manual.  
• The printed and electronic versions of a manual have the same contents.  
• Adobe Acrobat Reader/Adobe Reader must be installed in order to view the manuals as PDF files.  
• A Web browser must be installed in order to view the HTML manuals.  
Safety Information  
Provides information on safe usage of this machine.  
To avoid injury and prevent damage to the machine, be sure to read this.  
Quick Installation Guide  
Contains procedures for removing the machine from its box and connecting it to a computer.  
Initial Guide for Scanner and Fax  
Provides installation and operation procedures for the machine's scanner and fax functions. Details  
about these functions that are not included in this manual are provided in User Guide.  
User Guide  
Provides information about general operation and covers the topics listed below.  
• Installing options  
• Suitable paper types  
• Procedures to use the printer, copier, scanner, and fax functions  
• Configuring the machine  
• Troubleshooting problems and fixing paper jams  
• Replacing consumables  
• Checking the status of the machine using Web Image Monitor  
• Information about maintenance  
This manual is stored in the manual CD-ROM supplied with the machine.  
Quick Guide  
Provides information about troubleshooting and basic operations for making photocopies,  
scanning, and sending faxes.  
This manual is stored in the manual CD-ROM supplied with the machine.  
14  
   
Model-Specific Information  
Model-Specific Information  
This section explains how you can identify the model type and region of your machine.  
1
This machine comes in two models which vary in printer drivers they support. Check the label of the  
printer driver CD-ROM for the supported printer driver.  
When describing procedures that are model-specific, this manual refers to the different machine models  
as Type 1 or Type 2. The following table describes the model types.  
Model types  
Model type  
Supported printer driver  
Type 1  
Type 2  
DDST driver  
PCL and PostScript 3 drivers  
Furthermore, there is a label on the rear of the machine, located in the position shown below. The label  
contains details that identify the region your machine belongs to. Read the label.  
CES130  
The following information is region-specific. Read the information under the symbol that corresponds to  
the region of your machine.  
(mainly Europe and Asia)  
If the label contains the following, your machine is a region A model:  
• CODE XXXX -22, -27  
• 220-240V  
(mainly North America)  
If the label contains the following, your machine is a region B model:  
• CODE XXXX -17  
• 120 V  
15  
   
1. Guide to the Machine  
• Dimensions in this manual are given in two units of measure: metric and inch. If your machine is a  
Region A model, refer to the metric units. If your machine is a Region B model, refer to the inch  
units.  
1
16  
List of Option  
List of Option  
This section provides a list of option for this machine, and how it is referred to as in this manual.  
1
Option List  
Paper Feed Unit TK1010  
Referred to as  
Paper feed unit  
17  
   
1. Guide to the Machine  
How to Read This Manual  
Symbols  
1
This manual uses the following symbols:  
Indicates points to pay attention to when using the machine, and explanations of likely causes of paper  
misfeeds, damage to originals, or loss of data. Be sure to read these explanations.  
Indicates supplementary explanations of the machine's functions, and instructions on resolving user  
errors.  
This symbol is located at the end of sections. It indicates where you can find further relevant information.  
[ ]  
Indicates the names of keys on the machine's display or control panels.  
Notes  
Contents of this manual are subject to change without prior notice.  
Some illustrations in this manual might be slightly different from the machine.  
Certain options might not be available in some countries. For details, please contact your local dealer.  
About IP Address  
In this manual, "IP address" covers both IPv4 and IPv6 environments. Read the instructions that are  
relevant to the environment you are using.  
18  
               
Using Manuals  
Using Manuals  
Be sure to read this section before any other part of this manual.  
1
• This manual uses procedures based on Windows XP as an example, unless otherwise specified.  
Procedures and screens might vary depending on the operating system you are using.  
Installing Manuals on Your Computer  
The manual CD-ROM provided with the machine contains manuals in HTML format and PDF. Follow the  
instructions below to install it.  
• System requirements for installing the HTML manual:  
• Operating system: Windows XP/Vista/7, Windows Server 2003/2003 R2/2008/2008  
R2  
• Minimum display resolution: 800 × 600 pixels  
• Recommended browsers for viewing the HTML manual:  
• Internet Explorer 6 or later  
• Firefox 3.5 or later  
• Safari 4.0 or later  
• Applications for viewing the PDF manuals:  
®
®
®
• Adobe Acrobat Reader or Adobe Reader  
• The following procedure is based on Windows XP as an example. If you are using another  
operating system, the procedure might vary slightly.  
1. Quit all applications currently running.  
2. Insert the manual CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
If you are using a computer running a Macintosh operating system, open “Manuals.htm” from the  
CD-ROM root directory.  
3. Select a language for the interface and a product, and then click [OK].  
4. Click [Install manuals].  
5. Follow the instructions on the screen to complete the installation.  
6. Click [Finish] when the installation is completed.  
7. Click [Exit].  
19  
     
1. Guide to the Machine  
• If you are using a computer running a Windows operating system, the CD-ROM opens  
automatically. However, AutoRun may not work under certain operating system settings. If this is  
the case, launch “setup.exe” from the CD-ROM root directory.  
1
Opening Manuals  
This section describes how to open the manuals. There are three ways to view the manuals.  
Opening from the desktop icon  
Follow the procedure below to open the manuals from the desktop icon.  
1. Double-click the manual icon on your desktop.  
The manual opens.  
Opening from the [Start] menu  
Follow the procedure below to open the manual from the [Start] menu.  
• The following procedure is based on Windows XP as an example. If you are using another  
operating system, the procedure might vary slightly.  
1. On the [Start] menu, point to [All Programs], point to [Product Name], and then click  
[Manual Name].  
The manual opens.  
• The menu options may appear differently, depending on the options chosen during installation.  
Opening from the CD-ROM  
Follow the procedure below to open the manual from the CD-ROM.  
• The following procedure is based on Windows XP as an example. If you are using another  
operating system, the procedure might vary slightly.  
20  
   
Using Manuals  
1. Insert the manual CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.  
If you are using a computer running a Macintosh operating system, open "Manuals.htm" from the  
CD-ROM root directory.  
2. Select a language for the interface and a product, and then click [OK].  
1
3. Click [Read HTML manuals] or [Read PDF manuals], and then select the manual you want  
to read.  
The manual opens.  
• If you are using a computer running a Windows operating system, the CD-ROM opens  
automatically. However, AutoRun may not work under certain operating system settings. If this is  
the case, launch “setup.exe” from the CD-ROM root directory.  
Removing Manuals from Your Computer  
Follow the procedure below to remove manuals from your computer.  
• The following procedure is based on Windows XP as an example. If you are using another  
operating system, the procedure might vary slightly.  
1. On the [Start] menu, point to [All Programs], point to [Product Name], and then click  
[Uninstall].  
2. Follow the instructions to remove the manual.  
3. Click [Finish].  
• The menu options may appear differently, depending on the options chosen during installation.  
21  
   
1. Guide to the Machine  
Feature Highlights  
This section provides information about basic usage and some useful functions of the machine.  
1
• Certain functions require special machine configuration.  
• The Type 2 model is compatible with certain other network environments and operating systems in  
addition to Windows and Mac OS X. For details, contact your sales or service representative, or  
visit the product Web site.  
Using the Machine as a Printer  
To use this machine as a printer, two types of connection methods are available:  
• USB connection  
• Network connection  
Connecting via USB  
You can connect this machine directly to a computer using a USB cable.  
CES131  
Preparation for printing via USB  
To use this machine as a printer via USB connection:  
1. Connect the machine to a computer using a USB cable, and install the printer driver on the  
computer.  
provided on the driver CD-ROM.  
Connecting via a network  
You can connect this machine to a network and use it as a network printer.  
22  
           
Feature Highlights  
1
CES132  
Preparation for printing via a network  
To use this machine as a printer via network connection:  
1. Connect the machine to a network.  
2. Specify the network settings, such as the machine's IP address.  
3. Install the printer driver on a computer.  
For details, see the instructions provided on the driver CD-ROM.  
Printing confidential documents  
If you use the Locked Print function, you can password protect your print job.  
This means that your job is printed only after you enter the password using the machine's control panel.  
This function prevents unauthorized users seeing sensitive documents at the printer.  
• This function is available for the Type 2 model only.  
• This function is only available when using the PCL printer driver, and printing from a computer  
running a Windows operating system.  
CES157  
23  
 
1. Guide to the Machine  
Printing confidential documents  
1. Use the printer driver to send a print job as a Locked Print file from a computer.  
1
2. Enter the password using the control panel to print the file.  
Printing directly from a Digital Camera (PictBridge)  
You can connect a PictBridge-compatible digital camera to this machine using a USB cable. This allows  
you to directly print photographs taken using the digital camera by operating the digital camera.  
CES254  
Printing directly from a digital camera  
1. Connect the machine with a digital camera using a USB cable.  
2. Operate your digital camera and print using the machine.  
Using the Machine as a Copier  
This section describes some useful functions of this machine when used as a copier.  
Making enlarged or reduced copies  
This machine has preset ratios for scaling originals, to make it easy to convert documents between  
different standard sizes.  
24  
       
Feature Highlights  
1
CES103  
Preparation for making enlarged or reduced copies  
To always enlarge or reduce copies:  
1. Configure the machine's default [Reduce/Enlarge] setting.  
To use this function for the current job only:  
1. Configure the setting using the [Reduce/Enlarge] key before starting the current job.  
Copying multiple pages onto a single sheet of paper  
You can copy multiple pages of an original onto a single sheet of paper.  
• This function is only available when the original is set in the ADF, not when it is set on the exposure  
glass.  
CES092  
You can either set this machine to always make photocopies in 2-in-1 or 4-in-1 mode, or use this  
function only when necessary.  
Preparation for copying multiple images  
To always make photocopies in 2-in-1 or 4-in-1 mode:  
25  
 
1. Guide to the Machine  
1. Configure the machine's default [Reduce/Enlarge] setting.  
To use this function for the current job only:  
1
1. Configure the setting using the [Reduce/Enlarge] key before starting the current job.  
Copying both sides of an ID card onto one side of paper  
You can copy the front and back sides of an ID card, or other small document, onto one side of a sheet  
of paper.  
• This function is only available when the original is set on the exposure glass, not when it is set in the  
ADF.  
CES165  
You can either set this machine to always make photocopies in ID card copy mode, or use this function  
only when necessary.  
Preparation for copying an ID card  
To always make photocopies in ID card copy mode:  
1. Configure the machine's default [Reduce/Enlarge] setting.  
To use this function for the current job only:  
1. Press the [ID Card Copy] key before starting the current job.  
Making 2-sided copies  
You can make 2-sided copies by copying single-sided documents onto the front and back sides of the  
paper.  
• This function is only available when the original is set in the ADF, not when it is set on the exposure  
glass.  
26  
   
Feature Highlights  
1
CES124  
Change the machine's default setting to apply 2-sided copying.  
Preparation for making 2-sided copies  
1. Configure the [2 Sided Copy] setting under copy settings  
Sorting the output paper  
When making multiple copies of multiple pages, you can configure the machine to sort the output pages  
into sets.  
• This function is only available when the original is set in the ADF, not when it is set on the exposure  
glass.  
CES104  
Preparation for sorting the output paper  
1. Enable the [Sort] setting under copy settings.  
Using the Machine as a Scanner  
There are two scanning methods: scanning from the computer (TWAIN scanning) and scanning using  
the control panel.  
Scanning from the computer  
TWAIN scanning allows you to operate the machine from your computer and scan originals into  
your computer directly.  
TWAIN scanning can be performed using a TWAIN-compliant application, such as Presto!  
PageManager.  
27  
     
1. Guide to the Machine  
TWAIN scanning is available with both USB and network connections.  
Scanning using the control panel  
Scanning using the control panel allows you to send scanned files via e-mail (Scan to E-mail), to an  
FTP server (Scan to FTP), or to the shared folder of a computer on a network (Scan to Folder), or to  
a USB flash disk (Scan to USB).  
1
The Scan to E-mail, Scan to FTP, and Scan to Folder functions are available only through a network  
connection. No network connection is required for the Scan to USB function; you can send  
scanned files directly to a USB flash disk inserted into the front of the machine.  
• The machine supports WIA scanning, an additional method of scanning originals from your  
computer, for USB connection. WIA scanning is possible if your computer is running Windows  
operating system and a WIA-compatible application. For more information, see the manual for  
your application.  
Scanning from a computer  
You can operate the machine from your computer and scan originals into your computer directly.  
CES185  
Preparation for scanning from a computer with USB connection  
1. Connect the machine to the computer using a USB cable, and install the scanner driver on the  
computer.  
provided on the driver CD-ROM.  
2. If a TWAIN-compliant application is not installed on the computer, install Presto!  
PageManager.  
For details, see the instructions provided on the driver CD-ROM.  
Preparation for scanning from a computer with network connection  
1. Connect the machine to the network.  
28  
 
Feature Highlights  
2. Specify the network settings, such as the machine's IP address.  
3. Install the scanner driver on the computer.  
1
For details, see the instructions provided on the driver CD-ROM.  
4. If a TWAIN-compliant application is not installed on the computer, install Presto!  
PageManager.  
For details, see the instructions provided on the driver CD-ROM.  
Sending scanned files via e-mail  
You can send scanned files via e-mail using the control panel.  
CES186  
Preparation for sending scanned files via e-mail  
1. Connect the machine to the network.  
2. Specify the network settings, such as the machine's IP address.  
3. Configure the DNS and SMTP settings using Web Image Monitor.  
4. Register the destinations to the Address Book using Web Image Monitor.  
Sending scanned files to an FTP server  
You can send scanned files to an FTP server using the control panel.  
29  
   
1. Guide to the Machine  
1
CES187  
Preparation for sending scanned files to an FTP server  
1. Connect the machine to the network.  
2. Specify the network settings, such as the machine's IP address.  
3. Register the destinations to the Address Book using Web Image Monitor.  
Sending scanned files to a computer's shared folder  
You can send scanned files to the shared folder of a computer on a network using the control panel.  
CES190  
Preparation for sending scanned files to a computer's shared folder  
1. Connect the machine to the network.  
2. Specify the network settings, such as the machine's IP address.  
3. Create a destination folder on the computer's hard disk drive, and configure it as a shared  
folder.  
For details, see your operating system's documentation.  
30  
 
Feature Highlights  
4. Register the destinations to the Address Book using Web Image Monitor.  
1
Sending scanned files to a USB flash disk  
You can send and store scanned files on a USB flash disk using the control panel.  
CES198  
Preparation for sending scanned files to a USB flash disk  
1. Insert a USB flash disk in the machine.  
Using the Machine as a Fax Machine  
This section describes basic procedures for using this machine as a fax machine.  
Using as a fax machine  
CES188  
Preparation for using as a fax machine  
1. Connect the machine to the telephone line.  
2. Configure the telephone network settings.  
31  
     
1. Guide to the Machine  
3. Configure the time and date.  
4. Register the destinations to the Address Book using the control panel or Web Image Monitor.  
1
Using the machine with an external telephone  
You can use this machine as a fax machine and also use the same telephone line for voice calls.  
CES189  
Preparation for using the machine with an external telephone  
1. Connect an external telephone to the machine.  
2. Select the fax reception mode.  
Sending faxes from a computer (LAN-Fax)  
You can send a document directly from a computer through this machine to another fax machine,  
without printing the document.  
• This function is supported by Windows XP/Vista/7, and Windows Server 2003/2003  
R2/2008/2008 R2. Mac OS X does not support this function.  
32  
   
Feature Highlights  
1
CES191  
Preparation for sending faxes from a computer connected via USB  
1. Connect the machine to a computer using a USB cable.  
2. Install the LAN-Fax driver on the computer.  
For details, see the instructions provided on the driver CD-ROM.  
3. Register LAN-Fax destinations in the LAN-Fax Address Book.  
Preparation for sending faxes from a computer connected via network  
1. Connect the machine to the network.  
2. Specify the network settings, such as the machine’s IP address.  
3. Install the LAN-Fax driver on the computer.  
For details, see the instructions provided on the driver CD-ROM.  
4. Register LAN-Fax destinations in the LAN-Fax Address Book.  
33  
1. Guide to the Machine  
Guide to Components  
This section lists the names and functions of the parts of this machine.  
1
Exterior: Front View  
CES151  
1. ADF (Auto document feeder) Cover  
Open this cover to remove originals jammed in the ADF.  
2. Input Tray for the ADF  
Place stacks of originals here. They will feed in automatically. This tray can hold up to 35 sheets of plain  
paper.  
3. Output Tray for the ADF  
Originals scanned with the ADF are output here.  
4. Extender for the ADF Trays  
Extend these when placing paper longer than A4 in the input tray for ADF.  
5. Output Tray/Top Cover  
Printed paper is output here. Up to 150 sheets of plain paper can be stacked here.  
Open here to replace the print cartridges.  
6. Front Cover  
Open this cover to replace the waste toner bottle or remove jammed paper.  
7. Tray 1  
This tray can hold up to 250 sheets of plain paper.  
34  
       
Guide to Components  
8. Tray 2 (option)  
This tray can hold up to 500 sheets of plain paper.  
9. Bypass Tray  
Load paper here sheet by sheet.  
10. Control Panel  
1
Contains a screen and keys for machine control.  
11. USB Flash Disk Port  
Insert a USB flash disk for using the Scan to USB function or connect a digital camera using a USB cable for  
PictBridge printing.  
12. Exposure Glass  
Place originals here sheet by sheet.  
13. Cover for the Exposure Glass  
Open this cover to place originals on the exposure glass.  
Exterior: Rear View  
LINE  
TEL  
CES105  
1. Button for Sliding the ADF  
Press to slide the ADF towards the rear of the machine and hold it in that position, if paper output to the output  
tray is difficult to retrieve.  
2. Power Switch  
Use this switch to turn the power on or off.  
3. Power Socket  
For connecting the power cord to the machine.  
4. Rear Cover  
Remove this cover when loading paper longer than A4 in tray 1.  
5. Cable Cover  
Remove this cover when connecting cables to the machine.  
35  
   
1. Guide to the Machine  
6. External Telephone Connector  
For connecting an external telephone.  
7. USB Port  
For connecting the machine to a computer using a USB cable.  
8. Ethernet Port  
1
For connecting the machine to the network using a network interface cable.  
9. G3 (analog) Line Interface Connector  
For connecting a telephone line.  
10. Stop Fences  
Pull up this fence to prevent paper falling off when printing a large amount of paper at a time. The fence can  
be adjusted at the A4/Letter or Legal size position  
• Slide the ADF as shown below. Slide the ADF only when the ADF is closed. Be careful not to trap  
your fingers when sliding.  
CES099  
• Pull up the fence as shown below to prevent A4- or Letter-size prints from falling off.  
CES117  
• Pull up the fence as shown below to prevent Legal-size prints from falling off.  
36  
Guide to Components  
1
CES118  
Interior  
CES133  
1. Print Cartridges  
Load from the machine rear, in the order of cyan (C), magenta (M), yellow (Y), and black (K). Messages  
appear on the screen when print cartridges need to be replaced, or new ones need to be prepared.  
2. Waste Toner Bottle  
Collects excess toner during printing.  
Messages appear on the screen when the waste toner bottle needs to be replaced, or a new one needs to be  
prepared.  
3. Transfer Unit  
Remove this unit when replacing the waste toner bottle.  
• For details about the messages that appear on the screen when consumables need to be replaced,  
37  
   
1. Guide to the Machine  
Control Panel  
This section describes the names and usage of the parts of the control panel.  
1
• The actual control panel may look different from the illustration below, depending on the country of  
use.  
• If the machine remains turned off for a certain period of time (for example, when the power switch  
is turned off or when there is a power failure), all documents stored in memory will be lost. If the  
Fax Received indicator is lit or flashing, make sure to print out the stored documents before turning  
off the power (for example, prior to relocating the machine).  
CES167  
1. Fax Received indicator  
Lights up when received faxes that have not been printed out exist in the machine's memory. Flashes when the  
machine is unable to print out the faxes due to machine errors such as an empty paper tray or a paper jam.  
2. [Pause/Redial] key  
• Pause  
Press to insert a pause in a fax number. The pause is indicated by “P”.  
• Redial  
Press to display the last used scan or fax destination.  
3. [On Hook Dial] key  
Press to use on-hook dialing to check the destination's status when sending a fax.  
4. [Address Book] key  
Press to select a scan or fax destination from the Address Book.  
5. [Image Quality] key  
Press to select scan quality for the current job.  
• Copier mode: select Text, Photo, or Mixed.  
• Scanner mode: select the resolution.  
38  
   
Guide to Components  
• Fax mode: select Standard, Detail, or Photo.  
6. [User Tools] key  
Press to display the menu for configuring the machine's system settings.  
7. [Copy] key  
1
Press to switch to copier mode. The key stays lit while the machine is in copier mode.  
8. [ID Card Copy] key  
Press to enter ID card copy mode for the current job.  
9. Screen  
Displays current status and messages.  
10. Scroll keys  
Press to move the cursor in the directions indicated by each scroll key.  
Pressing the [ ][ ] keys while the machine is in standby mode will display the menu for configuring the settings  
of the machine's current operation mode (copier, scanner, or fax).  
11. Number keys  
Use to enter numerical values when specifying settings such as fax numbers and copy quantities, or enter  
letters when specifying names.  
12. [Clear/Stop] key  
• While the machine is processing a job: press to cancel the current job.  
• While configuring the machine: press to cancel the current setting and return to standby mode.  
• While in standby mode: press to cancel temporary settings such as image density or resolution.  
13. [B&W Start] key  
Press to scan or copy in black and white, or start sending a fax.  
14. [Color Start] key  
Press to scan or copy in color.  
15. [OK] key  
Press to confirm settings or enter the next level of the menu tree.  
16. [Escape] key  
Press to cancel the last operation or exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
17. Selection keys  
Press the key that corresponds to an item shown on the bottom line of the screen to select it.  
18. [Facsimile] key  
Press to switch to fax mode. The key stays lit while the machine is in fax mode.  
19. [Scanner] key  
Press to switch to scanner mode. The key stays lit while the machine is in scanner mode.  
20. [Density] key  
Press to adjust image density for the current job.  
• Copier mode: select from 5 levels of density.  
39  
1. Guide to the Machine  
• Scanner mode: select from 5 levels of density.  
• Fax mode: select from 3 levels of density.  
21. [Reduce/Enlarge] key  
• Copier mode: press to specify the reduction or enlargement ratio for the current job.  
• Scanner mode: press to specify the scanning size according to the current original.  
1
22. [Shift] key  
Press to switch between Quick Dial numbers 1 to 10 and 11 to 20 when specifying a scan or fax destination  
using the One Touch buttons.  
23. Alert indicator  
Flashes yellow when the machine will require maintenance soon (such as replacing consumables), or lights up  
red when a machine error occurs.  
When an alert is issued, check the messages on the screen and follow the instructions as provided in "Error  
and Status Messages on the Screen".  
24. Power indicator  
Remains lit while the power is on. It is unlit when the power is off.  
25. One Touch buttons  
Press to select a scan or fax Quick Dial destination.  
• The backlight of the screen is turned off when the machine is in Energy Saver mode.  
• When the machine is processing a job, you cannot display the menu for configuring the machine.  
You can confirm the machine's status by checking messages on the screen. If you see messages  
such as "Printing...", "B&W Copying...", "Colour Copying...", or "Processing...", wait until the current  
job is finished.  
• A sticker for control panel keys and a name sheet for One Touch buttons may be included,  
depending on the country of use. If included, apply the stickers appropriate for your language to  
the control panel. Note that if the control panel is covered with a protective sheet, be sure to  
remove it before applying the stickers.  
CES152  
40  
1. Guide to the Machine  
1
42  
2. Getting Started  
This chapter describes procedures for installing and configuring the machine, connecting options to the  
machine, and handling paper.  
Installing the Machine  
This section describes steps required to install the machine and prepare it for use.  
2
Where to Put the Machine  
The machine’s location should be carefully chosen because environmental conditions greatly affect its  
performance.  
• Do not use flammable sprays or solvents in the vicinity of this machine. Doing so could result in  
fire or electric shock.  
• Do not place vases, plant pots, cups, toiletries, medicines, small metal objects, or containers  
holding water or any other liquids, on or close to this machine. Fire or electric shock could result  
from spillage or if such objects or substances fall inside this machine.  
• Keep the machine away from humidity and dust. Otherwise a fire or an electric shock might  
occur.  
• Do not place the machine on an unstable or tilted surface. If it topples over, an injury might  
occur.  
• Do not place heavy objects on the machine. Doing so can cause the machine to topple over,  
possibly resulting in injury.  
43  
         
2. Getting Started  
• Keep the machine in an area that is within optimum environmental conditions. Operating the  
machine in an environment that is outside the recommended ranges of humidity and  
temperature can cause an electrical fire hazard. Keep the area around the socket free of dust.  
Accumulated dust can become an electrical fire hazard.  
2
• Make sure the room where you are using the machine is well ventilated and spacious. Good  
ventilation is especially important when the machine is used heavily.  
• Do not obstruct the machine's vents. Doing so risks fire caused by overheated internal  
components.  
• Machine sound levels exceeding [Sound Power Level (Black and White)] > 63dB (A) are not  
suitable for desk work environments, so place the machine in another room.  
• Keep the machine away from salt-bearing air and corrosive gases. Also, do not install the  
machine in places where chemical reactions are likely (laboratories, etc.), as doing so will  
cause the machine to malfunction.  
Space Required for Installation  
The recommended (minimum) space requirements are as follows:  
44  
Installing the Machine  
2
CES195  
Optimum Environmental Conditions  
Permissible and recommended temperature and humidity ranges are as follows:  
CER119  
• White area: Permissible Range  
• Blue area: Recommended Range  
Environments to Avoid  
• Areas exposed to direct sunlight or strong light  
• Dusty areas  
• Areas with corrosive gases  
• Areas that are excessively cold, hot, or humid  
• Areas directly exposed to currents of hot, cold, or room-temperature air from air conditioners  
45  
2. Getting Started  
• Areas directly exposed to radiant heat from heaters  
• Locations near air conditioners, heaters, or humidifiers  
• Locations near other electronic equipment  
• Locations subject to frequent strong vibration  
Ventilation  
When you use this machine in a confined space without good ventilation for a long time or print  
large quantities, you might detect an odd smell.  
2
This might cause the output paper to also have an odd smell.  
When you detect an odd smell, regularly ventilate in order to keep the workplace comfortable.  
• Set up the machine so that it does not directly ventilate towards people.  
3
• Ventilation should be more than 30 m /hr/person.  
New machine smell  
When a machine is new, it might have a unique smell. This smell will subside in about one week.  
When you detect an odd smell, sufficiently ventilate and circulate the air in the room.  
Power Source  
: 220-240 V, 6 A, 50/60 Hz (when fully equipped)  
: 120 V, 11 A, 60 Hz (when fully equipped)  
Please be sure to connect the power cord to a power source as above.  
Unpacking  
To protect it from shock and vibration during transit, this machine comes packaged in cushioning foam  
and secured with tape. Remove these protective materials after bringing the machine to where it will be  
installed.  
• Be sure to locate the machine as close as possible to a wall outlet. This will allow easy  
disconnection of the power cord in the event of an emergency.  
• If the machine emits smoke or odours, or if it behaves unusually, you must turn off its power  
immediately. After turning off the power, be sure to disconnect the power cord plug from the  
wall outlet. Then contact your service representative and report the problem. Do not use the  
machine. Doing so could result in fire or electric shock.  
46  
   
Installing the Machine  
• If metal objects, or water or other fluids fall inside this machine, you must turn off its power  
immediately. After turning off the power, be sure to disconnect the power cord plug from the  
wall outlet. Then contact your service representative and report the problem. Do not use the  
machine. Doing so could result in fire or electric shock.  
2
• Do not touch this machine if a lightning strike occurs in the immediate vicinity. Doing so could  
result in electric shock.  
• Keep the polythene materials (bags, gloves, etc.) supplied with this machine away from babies  
and small children at all times. Suffocation can result if polythene materials are brought into  
contact with the mouth or nose.  
• Do not incinerate toner (new or used) or toner containers. Doing so risks burns. Toner will ignite  
on contact with naked flame.  
• Do not store toner (new or used) or toner containers anywhere near naked flames. Doing so  
risks fire and burns. Toner will ignite on contact with naked flame.  
• Do not crush or squeeze toner containers. Doing so can cause toner spillage, possibly resulting  
in dirtying of skin, clothing, and floor, and accidental ingestion.  
• Store toner (new or used), toner containers, and components that have been in contact with  
toner out of reach of children.  
• If toner or used toner is inhaled, gargle with plenty of water and move into a fresh air  
environment. Consult a doctor if necessary.  
47  
2. Getting Started  
• If toner or used toner gets into your eyes, flush immediately with large amounts of water. Consult  
a doctor if necessary.  
• If toner or used toner is swallowed, dilute by drinking a large amount of water. Consult a doctor  
if necessary.  
2
• When moving the machine, use the inset grips on both sides. The machine will break or cause  
injury if dropped.  
• Do not look into the lamp. It can damage your eyes.  
• During operation, rollers for transporting the paper and originals revolve. A safety device has  
been installed so that the machine can be operated safety. But take care not to touch the  
machine during operation. Otherwise, an injury might occur.  
• Removed tape is dirty. Be careful not to let it touch your hands or clothes.  
• Leave the protective materials in place while moving the machine.  
• Lower the machine slowly and carefully to prevent trapping your hands.  
• Do not grip on the tray area when lifting the machine.  
• Do not allow paper clips, staples, or other small objects to fall inside the machine.  
• Keep uncovered print cartridges away from direct sunlight.  
• Do not touch the print cartridge's photo conductor unit.  
CER088  
48  
Installing the Machine  
• Do not touch the ID chip on the side of the print cartridge as indicated in the illustration below.  
2
CES032  
1. Remove the plastic bag.  
2. Lift the machine with another person using the inset grips on both sides of the machine.  
CES052  
3. Remove the protective materials attached on the machine's exterior. Do not remove tapes  
going into the inside of the machine.  
CES155  
The actual machine may come with protective materials attached in different positions. Make sure  
to check the machine's exterior for all protective materials, and remove them completely.  
49  
2. Getting Started  
4. Open the ADF cover.  
2
CES048  
5. Move the lever slightly to the machine rear, and then pull it up to unlock the paper feed  
roller.  
CES039  
6. Lift the paper feed roller slightly to remove it.  
CES050  
50  
Installing the Machine  
7. Pull the protective sheet to remove it.  
2
CES047  
8. With the roller part facing downwards, insert the tip of the paper feed roller into the  
opening of the ADF.  
CES042  
9. Return the paper feed roller to its original position.  
CES051  
51  
2. Getting Started  
10. Lower the lever until it clicks into place.  
2
CES116  
11. Close the ADF cover.  
CES049  
12. Pull the opening lever on the front cover, and then carefully lower the front cover.  
CES147  
52  
Installing the Machine  
13. Pull the tapes gently upward and remove them from the machine at the same time.  
2
CES162  
14. Pull up the fusing unit levers.  
CES258  
15. Using both hands, carefully push up the front cover until it closes.  
CES260  
16. Pull up the top cover open lever, and then open the top cover carefully.  
Make sure that the ADF is closed.  
53  
2. Getting Started  
2
CES261  
17. Remove the protection tapes.  
CES149  
18. Lift out print cartridges and shake them from side to side. The black print cartridge comes  
with a protection sheet that you must remove before shaking.  
Carefully lift out the print cartridge vertically, holding its center.  
CES158  
Place the black print cartridge on a flat surface and remove the protection sheet before shaking.  
54  
Installing the Machine  
2
CES031  
Shake each print cartridge from side to side five or six times.  
CER101  
19. Check the toner color and corresponding location, and then carefully insert the print  
cartridge vertically.  
CES159  
55  
2. Getting Started  
20. Using both hands, hold the center of the top cover and close the cover carefully. Be  
careful not to trap your fingers.  
2
CES140  
21. Apply the indicated sticker as in the illustration below.  
CES259  
Turning the Power on  
This section describes how to turn on the machine.  
• Do not use any power sources other than those that match the specifications shown in this  
manual. Doing so could result in fire or electric shock.  
• Do not use any frequencies other than those that match the specifications shown. Doing so could  
result in fire or electric shock.  
• Do not use multi-socket adaptors. Doing so could result in fire or electric shock.  
56  
   
Installing the Machine  
• Do not use extension cords. Doing so could result in fire or electric shock.  
• Do not use power cords that are damaged, broken, or modified. Also, do not use power cords  
that have been trapped under heavy objects, pulled hard, or bent severely. Doing so could  
result in fire or electric shock.  
2
• Touching the prongs of the power cable's plug with anything metallic constitutes a fire and  
electric shock hazard.  
• The supplied power cord is for use with this machine only. Do not use it with other appliances.  
Doing so could result in fire or electric shock.  
• It is dangerous to handle the power cord plug with wet hands. Doing so could result in electric  
shock.  
• Be sure to push the plug of the power cord fully into the wall outlet. Partially inserted plugs  
create an unstable connection that can result in unsafe buildup of heat.  
• If this machine is not going to be used for several days or longer at a time, disconnect its power  
cord from the wall outlet.  
• When performing maintenance on the machine, always disconnect the power cord from the  
wall outlet.  
• Make sure that the power cord is plugged securely into the wall outlet before turning the power on.  
• Make sure that the power is off when plugging or unplugging the power cord.  
• Do not turn off the power switch until initializing is completed. Doing so results in malfunction.  
57  
2. Getting Started  
1. Plug in the power cord.  
2
CES066  
2. Insert the plug of the power cord into the wall socket securely.  
3. Turn the power switch to ” On”.  
CES065  
The Power indicator lights up, and then the [Copy] key on the control panel lights up.  
• Depending on the [Function Priority] setting under [Admin. Tools], the [Facsimile] or [Scanner] key  
may light up instead of the [Copy] key.  
• The machine may make a noise while initializing. This noise does not indicate a malfunction.  
• To turn off the power, turn the power switch to “ Off”.  
CES063  
58  
Installing the Machine  
Initial Setup  
When you turn on the machine for the first time, a menu for configuring the settings described below will  
appear on the display. This section describes how to complete the Initial Setup.  
2
: The fax number code is required by international law. You cannot legally connect a  
fax machine to the telephone system if the fax number code is not programmed. Also, the fax  
header code and the date and time of transmission must be included in the header of all pages  
faxed to, from, or within the United States.  
• Make sure to select the correct code for the country of use. Selecting the wrong country code may  
cause failures in fax transmissions.  
Display language  
The language selected here is used for the display.  
User fax number  
The number entered here is used as the fax number of the machine. The user fax number can  
contain 0 to 9, space, and "+".  
User name  
The name entered here is used as the name of the fax sender.  
Country code  
The country code selected here is used for configuring the time and date display formats, and the  
settings related to fax transmissions with appropriate default values for the country of use.  
1. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select the required language, and then press the [OK] key.  
2. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Number:], and then enter the user fax number (up to 20  
digits).  
3. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Name:], enter the user name (up to 20 characters), and  
then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select the required country code, and then press the [OK] key.  
• You can change the settings configured during the Initial Setup later under [Admin. Tools]. In  
addition, you can set the machine's time and date under [Admin. Tools].  
• When the [Print Fax Header] setting under fax transmission settings is turned on, the registered user  
fax number, user name, and time and date of transmission appear on the header of every fax you  
send.  
59  
   
2. Getting Started  
2
Changing Operation Modes  
You can switch between copier, scanner, and fax modes by pressing the corresponding keys.  
Copier mode  
Press the [Copy] key to activate copier mode. While in copier mode, the [Copy] key lights up.  
CES174  
Scanner mode  
Press the [Scanner] key to activate scanner mode. While in scanner mode, the [Scanner] key lights  
up.  
CES175  
Fax mode  
Press the [Facsimile] key to activate fax mode. While in fax mode, the [Facsimile] key lights up.  
60  
   
Installing the Machine  
2
CES176  
Function Priority  
By default, copy mode is selected when the machine is turned on, or if the preset [System Auto  
Reset Timer] time passes with no operation while the initial screen of the current mode is displayed.  
You can change the selected mode using [Function Priority] under [Admin. Tools].  
Saving Energy  
This machine is equipped with the following Energy Saver modes: Energy Saver mode 1 and Energy  
Saver mode 2. If the machine has been idle for a certain period of time, the machine automatically  
enters Energy Saver mode.  
The machine recovers from Energy Saver mode when it receives a print job, prints a received fax, or  
when the [Copy], [Color Start], or [B&W Start] key is pressed.  
Energy Saver mode 1  
If [EnergySaverMode 1] under [Admin. Tools] is enabled, the machine enters Energy Saver mode  
1 if the machine has been idle for about 30 seconds. When the machine is in Energy Saver mode  
1, "Energy Saver Mode 1" appears on the screen. It takes less time to recover from Energy Saver  
mode 1 than from power-off state or Energy Saver mode 2, but power consumption is higher in  
Energy Saver mode 1 than in Energy Saver mode 2.  
Energy Saver mode 2  
If [EnergySaverMode 2] under [Admin. Tools] is enabled, the machine enters Energy Saver mode  
2 after the period of time specified for this setting is passed. When the machine is in Energy Saver  
mode 2, the screen turns off while the Power indicator remains lit. Power consumption is lower in  
Energy Saver mode 2 than in Energy Saver mode 1, but it takes longer to recover from Energy  
Saver mode 2 than from Energy Saver mode 1.  
61  
   
2. Getting Started  
• If the machine is in Energy Saver mode 2 for 24 hours continuously, the machine automatically  
returns to normal state and performs self-maintenance.  
2
Multi-access  
This machine can perform multiple jobs using different functions, such as copying and faxing, at the  
same time. Performing multiple functions simultaneously is called “Multi-access”.  
The following table shows the functions that can be performed simultaneously.  
Current job  
Job that you want to execute simultaneously  
• Fax memory transmission  
• Fax memory reception  
• Internet Fax reception (no printing)  
• Receiving a LAN-Fax job from a computer  
• LAN-Fax transmission  
Copying  
• Receiving a print job from a computer (the actual printing starts  
after copying is finished)  
*1  
• Printing  
• Fax memory transmission  
• Fax memory reception  
• Fax immediate printing  
Scanning  
• Printing a fax received in the machine's memory  
• Internet Fax reception  
• Receiving a LAN-Fax job from a computer (except when  
TWAIN scanning)  
• LAN-Fax transmission (except when TWAIN scanning)  
62  
   
Installing the Machine  
Current job  
Job that you want to execute simultaneously  
*2  
• Scanning  
• Fax memory reception  
*3  
• Fax memory transmission  
*3  
• Fax immediate transmission  
2
Printing  
• Scanning a fax into the machine's memory before transmission  
• Internet Fax reception (no printing)  
• Internet Fax transmission  
• Receiving a LAN-Fax job from a computer  
• LAN-Fax transmission  
*4  
• Scanning (except for Scan to USB)  
• Fax memory reception  
• Fax memory transmission  
PictBridge printing  
• Fax immediate transmission  
• Scanning a fax into the machine's memory before transmission  
• Internet Fax reception (no printing)  
• Internet Fax transmission  
• Copying  
• Scanning  
*5  
Fax memory transmission  
(sending a fax that has already  
been stored in the machine's  
memory)  
• Printing  
• Printing a fax received in the machine's memory  
• Internet Fax reception  
• Internet Fax transmission  
• Receiving a LAN-Fax job from a computer  
• Copying  
• Scanning  
• Printing  
Fax memory reception (storing  
a received fax into the  
machine's memory)  
• Printing a fax received in the machine's memory  
• Internet Fax reception  
• Internet Fax transmission  
• Receiving a LAN-Fax job from a computer  
63  
2. Getting Started  
Current job  
Job that you want to execute simultaneously  
• Printing  
Scanning a fax into the  
machine's memory before  
transmission  
• Printing a fax received in the machine's memory  
• Internet Fax reception  
*5  
• Printing  
Fax immediate transmission  
(scanning an original and  
sending it simultaneously)  
2
• Printing a fax received in the machine's memory  
• Internet Fax reception  
*6  
• Scanning  
• Fax memory reception  
• Fax memory transmission  
Printing a fax received in the  
machine's memory  
• Fax immediate transmission  
• Scanning a fax into the machine's memory before transmission  
• Internet Fax reception (no printing)  
• Internet Fax transmission  
*6  
• Scanning  
Fax immediate printing  
(receiving a fax and printing it  
simultaneously)  
• Internet Fax reception (no printing)  
• Internet Fax transmission  
• Receiving a LAN-Fax job from a computer  
• Copying (except when printing out the received Internet Fax)  
• Scanning  
• Printing (except when printing out the received Internet Fax)  
• Fax memory reception  
• Fax memory transmission  
• Fax immediate transmission  
• Printing a fax received in the machine's memory (except when  
printing out the received Internet Fax)  
Internet Fax reception  
• Fax immediate printing (except when printing out the received  
Internet Fax)  
• Scanning a fax into the machine's memory before transmission  
*7  
• Internet Fax transmission  
• Receiving a LAN-Fax job from a computer  
• LAN-Fax transmission  
64  
Installing the Machine  
Current job  
Job that you want to execute simultaneously  
*5  
• Printing  
• Fax memory reception  
• Fax memory transmission  
• Fax immediate printing  
Internet Fax transmission  
2
• Printing a fax received in the machine's memory  
*8  
• Internet Fax reception  
• Receiving a LAN-Fax job from a computer  
• LAN-Fax transmission  
• Copying  
• Scanning (except for TWAIN scanning)  
• Printing  
• Fax memory reception  
• Fax memory transmission  
• Fax immediate printing  
• Printing a fax received in the machine's memory  
• Internet Fax reception  
• Internet Fax transmission  
• LAN-Fax transmission  
Receiving a LAN-Fax job from  
a computer  
• Copying  
• Scanning (except for TWAIN scanning)  
• Printing  
LAN-Fax transmission  
• Internet Fax reception  
• Internet Fax transmission  
• Receiving a LAN-Fax job from a computer  
Printing starts after scanning is finished if [Gradation:] is set to [Standard] or [Fine] (PCL/DDST printer driver),  
or when printing from the PostScript 3 printer driver.  
*1  
*2  
*3  
*4  
Scanning is not possible if [Gradation:] is set to [Standard] or [Fine] (PCL/DDST printer driver), or when  
printing from the PostScript 3 printer driver.  
Fax transmission is not possible if [Gradation:] is set to [Fine] (PCL/DDST printer driver), or when printing  
from the PostScript 3 printer driver.  
PictBridge printing might fail if free memory space is low.  
65  
2. Getting Started  
Printing may be canceled if [Gradation:] is set to [Standard] or [Fine] (PCL/DDST printer driver), or when  
printing from the PostScript 3 printer driver.  
*5  
*6  
Fax printing may take longer than normal if you scan using the control panel at the same time, especially  
when scanning multiple pages using the exposure glass.  
Internet Fax transmission will not begin until Internet Fax reception is completed.  
Connection to the POP3 server cannot be performed during Internet Fax transmission.  
*7  
*8  
2
• If you try to use a function that cannot be performed simultaneously, you will hear a beep sound  
from the machine or see a failure message pop up on your computer screen. In this case, try again  
after the current job is finished.  
66  
Connecting the Machine  
Connecting the Machine  
This section describes connecting the machine to a computer and a telephone line.  
Connecting with a Computer Using a USB Cable  
2
• USB 2.0 interface cable is not supplied. Obtain a USB cable that is correct for the computer you  
are using.  
• USB connection with a Macintosh is only possible via the computer’s standard USB port.  
1. Remove the cable cover.  
CES068  
2. Connect the square-shaped connector of the USB 2.0 cable to the USB port.  
CES096  
3. Connect the opposite end's flat connector to your computer's USB interface or USB hub.  
67  
     
2. Getting Started  
4. Attach the cable cover.  
2
CES094  
• For details about installing printer drivers for USB connection, see the instructions provided on the  
driver CD-ROM.  
Connecting with a Digital Camera Using a USB Cable  
This machine supports direct printing, which allows you to print images taken with a digital camera by  
connecting the camera directly to the machine. The following describes how to connect the machine to a  
digital camera.  
• Use the USB cable bundled with your digital camera.  
• Make sure your digital camera supports PictBridge.  
1. Confirm that both the machine and the digital camera are turned on.  
2. Open the cover of the USB flash disk port, connect the USB cable, and then connect the  
other end of the cable to your digital camera.  
CES196  
When the machine recognizes the digital camera as a PictBridge device, "PictBridge  
Connecting...", then "Ready" will appear on the machine’s control panel.  
68  
   
Connecting the Machine  
3. When a digital camera is not connected to the machine, store the USB cable in a location  
where it will not be damaged.  
• Make sure to close the cover of the USB flash disk port after use.  
2
Connecting with a Network Cable  
Follow the procedure below to connect the machine to a computer through a network.  
Prepare the hub and other network devices before connecting the 10BASE-T or 100BASE-TX cable to  
the machine's Ethernet port.  
• Do not connect the Ethernet port of the machine to a network that may supply excess voltage,  
such as a telephone line. Doing so may result in fire or electric shock  
• Use shielded Ethernet cable. Unshielded cables create electromagnetic interference that could  
cause malfunctions.  
• The Ethernet cable is not supplied with this machine. Select your cable according to the network  
environment.  
1. Remove the cable cover.  
CES068  
69  
   
2. Getting Started  
2. Connect the Ethernet cable to the Ethernet port.  
2
CES093  
3. Connect the other end of the cable to the network (e.g., a network hub).  
4. Attach the cable cover.  
CES094  
• For details about installing printer drivers for network connection, see the instructions provided on  
the driver CD-ROM.  
Reading the LED lamps  
1
2
CES095  
1. Yellow: Flashes when 100BASE-TX or 10BASE-T is being used.  
2. Green: Lights up when the machine is properly connected to the network.  
70  
 
Connecting the Machine  
Connecting to a Telephone Line  
You can connect the machine to the public switched telephone network (PSTN) directly or through a  
private branch exchange (PBX).  
Also, you can connect an external telephone to use the same telephone line for voice calls.  
2
• To reduce the risk of fire, use only No. 26 AWG or larger telecommunication line cord.  
• Pour réduire le risque d'incendie, utiliser uniquement des conducteurs de télécommunications 26  
AWG ou de section supérieure.  
: By law in the United States, you must program your phone number identification  
(your fax number) into your machine before you can connect to the public phone system.  
• Make sure the connector is the correct type before you start.  
1. Remove the cable cover.  
CES068  
71  
   
2. Getting Started  
2. Connect a telephone line cord to LINE.  
2
CES041  
3. If using an external telephone, connect the telephone to TEL.  
CES040  
4. Pass the telephone line cord through the opening in the cable cover.  
CES045  
72  
Connecting the Machine  
5. Hook the tabs of the cable cover into the openings of the machine.  
2
CES046  
6. Attach the cable cover in place.  
CES094  
• After connecting the machine to the telephone line, configure the telephone network settings  
and fax reception mode.  
• If your telephone has functions that are not compatible with this machine, those functions will  
not be usable.  
• Confirm that you have registered user fax number and user name during Initial Setup. You can  
check the registered information in [Program Fax Information] under [Admin. Tools].  
73  
2. Getting Started  
Configuring the Machine  
This section describes configuring the settings required to use the machine on a network and as a fax  
machine.  
Configuring the IPv4 Address Settings  
2
The procedure for configuring network settings differs depending on whether IPv4 address information is  
assigned automatically by the network (DHCP), or manually.  
Setting the machine to receive an IPv4 address automatically  
• A DHCP server is required on the network for the machine to receive an IPv4 address  
automatically.  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
CES184  
2. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Network Settings], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. If you are requested to enter a password, enter the password using the number keys,  
and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [IPv4 Configuration], and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [DHCP], and then press the [OK] key.  
6. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Active], and then press the [OK] key.  
7. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
8. If you are requested to restart the machine, turn off the machine, and then turn it back on.  
9. Print the configuration page to confirm the setting.  
The IPv4 address setting will appear under “TCP/IP” on the configuration page.  
74  
       
Configuring the Machine  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• A password for accessing the [Network Settings] menu can be specified in [Admin. Tools Lock].  
• If your network environment requires a specific transmission speed that is not automatically  
detected, set the transmission speed in [Set Ethernet Speed] under [Network Settings].  
• When [DHCP] is activated, manually configured IPv4 address settings are not used.  
2
Assigning the machine's IPv4 address manually  
• The IPv4 address assigned to the machine must not be used by any other device on the same  
network.  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
CES184  
2. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Network Settings], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. If you are requested to enter a password, enter the password using the number keys,  
and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [IPv4 Configuration], and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [DHCP], and then press the [OK] key.  
6. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Inactive], and then press the [OK] key.  
7. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [IP Address], and then press the [OK] key.  
The current IPv4 address is shown.  
75  
 
2. Getting Started  
8. Enter the machine’s IPv4 address using the number keys, and then press the [OK] key.  
Press the [ ] [ ] keys to move between fields.  
9. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Subnet Mask], and then press the [OK] key.  
The current subnet mask is shown.  
10. Enter the subnet mask using the number keys, and then press the [OK] key.  
Press the [ ] [ ] keys to move between fields.  
2
11. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Gateway Address], and then press the [OK] key.  
The current gateway address is shown.  
12. Enter the gateway address using the number keys, and then press the [OK] key.  
Press the [ ] [ ] keys to move between fields.  
13. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
14. If you are requested to restart the machine, turn off the machine, and then turn it back on.  
15. Print the configuration page to confirm the setting.  
The IPv4 address setting will appear under “TCP/IP” on the configuration page.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• A password for accessing the [Network Settings] menu can be specified in [Admin. Tools Lock].  
• If your network environment requires a specific transmission speed that is not automatically  
detected, set the transmission speed in [Set Ethernet Speed] under [Network Settings].  
• When [DHCP] is activated, manually configured IPv4 address settings are not used.  
Configuring the IPv6 Address Settings  
The procedure for configuring network settings differs depending on whether IPv6 address information is  
assigned automatically by the network (DHCP), or manually.  
76  
   
Configuring the Machine  
Setting the machine to receive an IPv6 address automatically  
• A DHCP server is required on the network for the machine to receive an IPv6 address  
automatically.  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
2
CES184  
2. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Network Settings], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. If you are requested to enter a password, enter the password using the number keys,  
and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [IPv6 Configuration], and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [DHCP], and then press the [OK] key.  
6. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Active], and then press the [OK] key.  
7. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
8. If you are requested to reboot the machine, turn off the machine, and then turn it back on.  
9. Print the configuration page to confirm the setting.  
The IPv6 address setting will appear under “IPv6 Configuration” on the configuration page.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• A password for accessing the [Network Settings] menu can be specified in [Admin. Tools Lock].  
• When [DHCP] is activated, manually configured IPv6 address settings are not used.  
77  
 
2. Getting Started  
Assigning the machine's IPv6 address manually  
• The IPv6 address assigned to the machine must not be used by any other device on the same  
network.  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
2
CES184  
2. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Network Settings], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. If you are requested to enter a password, enter the password using the number keys,  
and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [IPv6 Configuration], and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [DHCP], and then press the [OK] key.  
6. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Inactive], and then press the [OK] key.  
7. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Manual Config. Address], and then press the [OK] key.  
8. Enter the machine’s IPv6 address using the number keys, and then press the [OK] key.  
9. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Prefix Length], and then press the [OK] key.  
10. Enter the prefix length using the number keys, and then press the [OK] key.  
11. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Gateway Address], and then press the [OK] key.  
12. Enter the gateway address using the number keys, and then press the [OK] key.  
13. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
14. If you are requested to reboot the machine, turn off the machine, and then turn it back on.  
15. Print the configuration page to confirm the setting.  
The IPv6 address setting will appear under “IPv6 Configuration” on the configuration page.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• A password for accessing the [Network Settings] menu can be specified in [Admin. Tools Lock].  
• When [DHCP] is activated, manually configured IPv6 address settings are not used.  
78  
 
Configuring the Machine  
2
Configuring Telephone Network Settings  
Selecting the telephone line type  
Select the telephone line type according to your telephone line service. There are two types: tone and  
pulse dial.  
This function is not available in some regions.  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
CES184  
2. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Admin. Tools], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. If you are requested to enter a password, enter the password using the number keys,  
and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Dial/Push Phone], and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select the telephone line type appropriate for your telephone  
service, and then press the [OK] key.  
6. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• A password for accessing the [Admin. Tools] menu can be specified in [Admin. Tools Lock].  
79  
   
2. Getting Started  
Selecting the telephone network connection type  
Select the type of connection to the telephone network.  
There are two types: public switched telephone network (PSTN) and private branch exchange (PBX).  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
2
CES184  
2. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Admin. Tools], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. If you are requested to enter a password, enter the password using the number keys,  
and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [PSTN / PBX], and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [PSTN] or [PBX], and then press the [OK] key.  
6. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• A password for accessing the [Admin. Tools] menu can be specified in [Admin. Tools Lock].  
Setting the outside line access number  
If the machine is connected to the telephone network through a PBX, set the dial number to access the  
outside line.  
• Make sure to set the outside line access number that matches the setting of your PBX. Otherwise,  
you may not be able to send faxes to outside destinations.  
80  
   
Configuring the Machine  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
2
CES184  
2. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Admin. Tools], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. If you are requested to enter a password, enter the password using the number keys,  
and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [PBX Access Number], and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Enter the outside line access number using the number keys, and then press the [OK] key.  
6. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• A password for accessing the [Admin. Tools] menu can be specified in [Admin. Tools Lock].  
81  
2. Getting Started  
Sharing the Printer on a Network  
This section describes how to configure this machine as a Windows network printer.  
The network printer is configured to enable network clients to use it.  
• To change printer properties, you must have Manage Printers permission (Full Control access  
authentication under Windows Vista/7). Log on to the file server as an Administrator to acquire this  
permission.  
2
• The following procedure is based on Windows XP as an example. If you are using another  
operating system, the procedure might vary slightly.  
1. On the [Start] menu, click [Printers and Faxes].  
2. Click the icon of the printer you want to use.  
3. On the [File] menu, click [Properties].  
4. On the [Sharing] tab, click [Share this printer].  
5. To share the printer with users using a different version of Windows, click [Additional  
Drivers...].  
Omit this step if you have installed an alternative driver by selecting [Share this printer] during the  
printer driver installation.  
6. On the [Advanced] tab, click the [Printing Defaults...] button. Specify the default values  
for the printer driver that will be distributed to client computers, and then click [OK].  
7. Click [OK].  
82  
   
Installing Option  
Installing Option  
This section describes how to install the optional paper feed unit.  
Installing the Paper Feed Unit (Tray 2)  
2
• Touching the prongs of the power cable's plug with anything metallic constitutes a fire and  
electric shock hazard.  
• It is dangerous to handle the power cord plug with wet hands. Doing so could result in electric  
shock.  
• Before installing or removing options, always disconnect the power cord plugs from the wall  
outlet and allow time for the main unit to fully cool. Failing to take these precautions could result  
in burns.  
• The machine weighs approximately 30.0 kg (66.2 lb.). When moving the machine, use the  
inset grips on both sides, and lift slowly in pairs. The machine will break or cause injury if  
dropped.  
• Lifting the paper feed unit carelessly or dropping may cause injury.  
• Before moving the machine, unplug the power cord from the wall outlet. If the cord is  
unplugged abruptly, it could become damaged. Damaged plugs or cords can cause an  
electrical or fire hazard.  
• The machine should always be lifted by two people.  
• Tray 1 is required to print using the optional paper feed unit. Without Tray 1, paper jams will occur.  
• Do not grip the tray areas when moving the machine.  
83  
       
2. Getting Started  
1. Check that the package contains paper feed unit.  
2
CER004  
2. Turn off the power, and then unplug the machine's power cord from the wall outlet.  
3. Remove the adhesive tape from the optional paper feed unit.  
CER023  
4. Lift using the inset grips on both sides of the machine.  
CES052  
84  
Installing Option  
5. There are three upright pins on the optional paper feed unit. Align them with the holes on  
the underside of the machine, and then carefully lower the machine onto them.  
2
CER005  
6. After installing the option, print the configuration page to confirm the installation.  
If it is installed properly, “Tray 2” will appear under “Paper Input” on the configuration page.  
• After installing the optional paper feed unit, select tray 2 in the printer driver. For details, see the  
printer driver Help.  
• If the optional paper feed unit is not installed properly, reinstall it following this procedure. If you  
cannot install it properly even after attempting reinstallation, contact your sales or service  
representative.  
85  
2. Getting Started  
Paper and Other Media  
This section describes supported and unsupported paper, paper precautions, details of each paper type  
and the printable area.  
• All paper must be set vertically, regardless of the paper size.  
2
Supported Paper for Each Tray  
This section describes the type, size, and weight of paper that can be loaded in each tray. The capacity  
of each paper tray is also provided.  
86  
     
Paper and Other Media  
Tray 1  
Type  
Size  
Weight  
Capacity  
250  
2
Thin paper  
A4  
60 to 160 g/m  
(16 to 43 lb.)  
2
Plain paper  
B5 JIS  
A5  
(80 g/m , 20 lb.)  
Middle thick paper  
Thick paper 1, 2  
Recycled paper  
Color paper  
Preprinted paper  
Prepunched paper  
Letterhead  
2
B6 JIS  
A6  
1
Legal (8 / " × 14 ")  
2
1
Letter (8 / " × 11 ")  
2
1
1
Half Letter (5 / " × 8 / ")  
2
2
1
1
Executive (7 / " × 10 / ")  
4
2
Bond paper  
8 " × 13 "  
1
Cardstock  
8 / " × 13 "  
2
1
Label paper  
Folio (8 / " × 13 ")  
4
Envelope  
16K (195 × 267 mm)  
1
1
Com 10 (4 / " × 9 / ")  
8
2
7
1
Monarch (3 / " × 7 / ")  
8
2
C5 Env (162 × 229 mm)  
C6 Env (114 × 162 mm)  
DL Env (110 × 220 mm)  
Custom size:  
90 to 216 mm in width,  
148 to 356 mm in length  
(3.54 to 8.50 inches in width,  
5.83 to 14.0 inches in length)  
87  
2. Getting Started  
Tray 2 (option)  
Type  
Size  
Weight  
Capacity  
2
Thin paper  
A4  
Letter (8 / " × 11 ")  
60 to 105 g/m  
(16 to 28 lb.)  
500  
1
2
Plain paper  
(80 g/m , 20 lb.)  
2
Middle thick paper  
Thick paper 1  
Recycled paper  
Color paper  
2
Preprinted paper  
Prepunched paper  
Letterhead  
88  
Paper and Other Media  
Bypass tray  
Type  
Size  
Weight  
Capacity  
2
Thin paper  
A4  
60 to 160 g/m  
(16 to 43 lb.)  
1
Plain paper  
B5 JIS  
A5  
Middle thick paper  
Thick paper 1, 2  
Recycled paper  
Color paper  
Prepunched paper  
Letterhead  
2
B6 JIS  
A6  
1
Legal (8 / " × 14 ")  
2
1
Letter (8 / " × 11 ")  
2
1
1
Half Letter (5 / " × 8 / ")  
2
2
1
1
Bond paper  
Executive (7 / " × 10 / ")  
4
2
Cardstock  
8 " × 13 "  
1
Label paper  
Envelope  
8 / " × 13 "  
2
1
Folio (8 / " × 13 ")  
4
16K (195 mm × 267 mm)  
1
1
Com 10 (4 / " × 9 / ")  
8
2
7
1
Monarch (3 / " × 7 / ")  
8
2
C5 Env (162 × 229 mm)  
C6 Env (114 × 162 mm)  
DL Env (110 × 220 mm)  
Custom size:  
90 to 216 mm in width,  
148 to 356 mm in length  
(3.54 to 8.50 inches in width,  
5.83 to 14.0 inches in length)  
• You cannot print on Legal size paper in the following cases:  
• PCL/DDST printer driver  
When [Gradation:] in [Print Quality] is set to [Fine]  
• PostScript 3 printer driver  
When [Print Quality:] in [Printer Features] is set to [Best Quality]  
89  
2. Getting Started  
Specifications of Paper Types  
The following tables describe the types of paper that can be used with this machine.  
• Depending on the paper type, the toner may take a while to dry. Before handling, make sure  
printed sheets have fully dried. Otherwise, the toner may smudge.  
2
• Print quality can be guaranteed only if recommended paper is used. For more information about  
recommended paper, contact your sales or service representative.  
Middle thick paper  
Item  
Description  
2
Paper thickness  
75 to 90 g/m (20 to 24 lb.)  
Supported paper tray  
Any input tray can be used.  
1
1
1
Duplex supported size A4, B5 JIS, Legal (8 / " × 14 "), Letter (8 / " × 11 "), Executive (7 / "  
2
2
1
4
1
1
× 10 / "), 8 " × 13 ", 8 / " × 13 ", Folio (8 / " × 13 "), 16K (195 mm  
2
2
4
× 267 mm)  
Thick paper 1  
Item  
Description  
2
Paper thickness  
91 to 105 g/m (24 to 28 lb.)  
Supported paper tray  
Any input tray can be used.  
Duplex supported size None  
Notes  
The number of sheets that can be printed in one minute is approximately  
half that of middle thick paper.  
Thick paper 2  
Item  
Description  
2
Paper thickness  
106 to 160 g/m (28 to 43 lb.)  
Supported paper tray  
Tray 1 and bypass tray  
Duplex supported size None  
Notes The number of sheets that can be printed in one minute is approximately  
half that of middle thick paper.  
90  
   
Paper and Other Media  
Thin paper  
Item  
Description  
Paper thickness  
60 to 65g/m2 (16 to 17 lb.)  
Supported paper tray  
Any input tray can be used.  
1
1
1
Duplex supported size A4, B5 JIS, Legal (8 / " × 14 "), Letter (8 / " × 11 "), Executive (7 / "  
2
2
1
4
2
1
1
× 10 / "), 8 " × 13 ", 8 / " × 13 ", Folio (8 / " × 13 "), 16K (195 mm  
2
2
4
× 267 mm)  
Plain paper  
Item  
Description  
Paper thickness  
66 to 74 g/m2 (18 to 20 lb.)  
Supported paper tray  
Any input tray can be used.  
1
1
1
Duplex supported size A4, B5 JIS, Legal (8 / " × 14 "), Letter (8 / " × 11 "), Executive (7 / "  
2
2
1
4
1
1
× 10 / "), 8 " × 13 ", 8 / " × 13 ", Folio (8 / " × 13 "), 16K (195 mm  
2
2
4
× 267 mm)  
Recycled paper  
Item  
Description  
2
Paper thickness  
75 to 90 g/m (20 to 24 lb.)  
Supported paper tray  
Any input tray can be used.  
1
1
1
Duplex supported size A4, B5 JIS, Legal (8 / " × 14 "), Letter (8 / " × 11 "), Executive (7 / "  
2
2
1
4
1
1
× 10 / "), 8 " × 13 ", 8 / " × 13 ", Folio (8 / " × 13 "), 16K (195 mm  
2
2
4
× 267 mm)  
Notes  
If the paper thickness is outside the specified range, select [Thin Paper],  
[Plain Paper], [Thick Paper 1], or [Thick Paper 2].  
Color paper  
Item  
Description  
2
Paper thickness  
75 to 90 g/m (20 to 24 lb.)  
Supported paper tray  
Any input tray can be used.  
91  
2. Getting Started  
Item  
Description  
1
1
1
Duplex supported size A4, B5 JIS, Legal (8 / " × 14 "), Letter (8 / " × 11 "), Executive (7 / "  
2
2
1
4
1
1
× 10 / "), 8 " × 13 ", 8 / " × 13 ", Folio (8 / " × 13 "), 16K (195 mm  
2
2
4
× 267 mm)  
Notes  
If the paper thickness is outside the specified range, select [Thin Paper],  
[Plain Paper], [Thick Paper 1], or [Thick Paper 2].  
2
Preprinted paper  
Item  
Description  
2
Paper thickness  
75 to 90 g/m (20 to 24 lb.)  
Supported paper tray  
Tray 1 and tray 2  
1
1
1
Duplex supported size A4, B5 JIS, Legal (8 / " × 14 "), Letter (8 / " × 11 "), Executive (7 / "  
2
2
1
4
1
1
× 10 / "), 8 " × 13 ", 8 / " × 13 ", Folio (8 / " × 13 "), 16K (195 mm  
2
2
4
× 267 mm)  
Notes  
If the paper thickness is outside the specified range, select [Thin Paper],  
[Plain Paper], [Thick Paper 1], or [Thick Paper 2].  
Prepunched paper  
Item  
Description  
2
Paper thickness  
75 to 90 g/m (20 to 24 lb.)  
Supported paper tray  
Any input tray can be used.  
1
1
1
Duplex supported size A4, B5 JIS, Legal (8 / " × 14 "), Letter (8 / " × 11 "), Executive (7 / "  
2
2
1
4
1
1
× 10 / "), 8 " × 13 ", 8 / " × 13 ", Folio (8 / " × 13 "), 16K (195 mm  
2
2
4
× 267 mm)  
Notes  
If the paper thickness is outside the specified range, select [Thin Paper],  
[Plain Paper], [Thick Paper 1], or [Thick Paper 2].  
Letterhead  
Item  
Description  
2
Paper thickness  
75 to 90 g/m (20 to 24 lb.)  
Supported paper tray  
Any input tray can be used.  
92  
Paper and Other Media  
Item  
Description  
1
1
1
Duplex supported size A4, B5 JIS, Legal (8 / " × 14 "), Letter (8 / " × 11 "), Executive (7 / "  
2
2
1
4
1
1
× 10 / "), 8 " × 13 ", 8 / " × 13 ", Folio (8 / " × 13 "), 16K (195 mm  
2
2
4
× 267 mm)  
Notes  
Paper that has a thickness outside the specified range cannot be printed  
onto.  
2
Bond paper  
Item  
Description  
2
Paper thickness  
106 to 160 g/m (28 to 43 lb.)  
Supported paper tray  
Tray 1 and bypass tray  
Duplex supported size None  
Notes  
• The number of sheets that can be printed in one minute is  
approximately half that of middle thick paper.  
• If the paper thickness is outside the specified range, select [Thick Paper  
1].  
Cardstock  
Item  
Description  
2
Paper thickness  
106 to 160 g/m (28 to 43 lb.)  
Supported paper tray  
Tray 1 and bypass tray  
Duplex supported size None  
Notes  
• The number of sheets that can be printed in one minute is  
approximately half that of middle thick paper.  
2
• Paper thicker than 160 g/m cannot be printed onto.  
Label paper  
Item  
Supported paper tray  
Description  
Tray 1 and bypass tray  
Duplex supported size None  
93  
2. Getting Started  
Item  
Description  
Notes  
• The number of sheets that can be printed in one minute is  
approximately half that of middle thick paper.  
• Avoid using adhesive label paper on which glue is exposed. Glue  
may stick to the inner parts of the machine, which can cause paper  
feed problems, deterioration in print quality, or premature wear of the  
print cartridge's photo conductor unit.  
2
Envelope  
Item  
Description  
Supported paper tray  
Tray 1 and bypass tray  
Duplex supported size None  
Notes  
• Avoid using self-adhesive envelopes. They may cause machine malfunctions.  
• The number of envelopes that can be printed in one minute is approximately half that of middle  
thick paper.  
• Paper can be loaded only up to the lower of the two paper limit marks of the tray.  
• If printed envelopes come out badly creased, load the envelopes in the opposite direction. Also,  
configure the printer driver to rotate the print object 180 degrees. For details about changing the  
loading orientation, see the printer driver Help.  
• Environmental factors can degrade the print quality on both recommended and non-recommended  
envelopes.  
• If envelopes are severely curled after printing, flatten them by bending them back against the curl.  
• After printing, envelopes sometimes have creases along their long edges and toner smear on their  
unprinted sides. Their print images might also be blurred. When printing large, black-solid areas,  
striping can occur as a result of the envelopes overlapping.  
• To correctly specify the length of an envelope whose flap opens along its short edge, be sure to  
include the open flap when measuring.  
CER112  
94  
Paper and Other Media  
• Fan envelopes, and then align their edges before loading.  
2
CER108  
• When fanning envelopes, make sure they are not stuck together. If they are stuck together,  
separate them.  
• When fanning envelopes, make sure the envelope flaps are not stuck together. If they are stuck  
together, separate them.  
• Before loading envelopes, flatten them out so that their curl does not exceed that shown in the  
illustration below.  
CER109  
• If the curl is severe, flatten out the envelopes using your fingers, as shown in the illustration below.  
CER110  
95  
2. Getting Started  
1
1
• You may not be able to perform duplex printing on 8 " × 13 ", 8 / " × 13 ", Folio (8 / " × 13 "),  
2
4
or 16K (195 mm × 267 mm) size paper in the following cases:  
• PCL/DDST printer driver  
When [Gradation:] in [Print Quality] is set to [Fine]  
• PostScript 3 printer driver  
2
When [Print Quality:] in [Printer Features] is set to [Best Quality]  
Unsupported Types of Paper  
Avoid using the following paper as they are not supported by this machine.  
• Paper meant for an ink-jet printer  
• Bent, folded, or creased paper  
• Curled or twisted paper  
• Torn paper  
• Wrinkled paper  
• Damp paper  
• Dirty or damaged paper  
• Paper that is dry enough to emit static electricity  
• Paper that has already been printed onto, except a preprinted letterhead.  
Malfunctions are especially likely when using paper printed on by other than a laser printer (e.g.  
monochrome and color copiers, ink-jet printers, etc.)  
• Special paper, such as thermal paper, aluminum foil, carbon paper and conductive paper  
• Paper that is heavier or lighter than the specified limitations  
• Paper with windows, holes, perforations, cutouts, or embossing  
• Adhesive label paper on which the adhesive under-layer or base paper is exposed  
• Paper with clips or staples  
• Do not use ink-jet printer paper because it may stick to the fusing unit and cause a paper jam.  
• Do not load OHP transparencies. Load translucent media only.  
• Do not use paper that has already been printed onto by other printers.  
• When loading paper, take care not to touch the surface of the paper.  
• Even supported types of paper may cause paper jams or malfunctions if the paper is not in good  
condition.  
96  
   
Paper and Other Media  
Paper Storage Precautions  
Paper should always be stored properly. Improperly stored paper might result in poor print quality,  
paper jams, or printer damage.  
Recommendations are as follows:  
• Avoid storing paper in areas that are excessively cold, hot, humid, or dry.  
• Avoid exposing paper to direct sunlight.  
• Store on a flat surface.  
2
• Keep paper in its original packaging.  
Printable Area  
The following diagrams show the areas of paper that the machine can print onto.  
Be sure to set the print margins correctly using the settings of the application in which it was created.  
Paper  
2
4
4
3
1
3
CER001  
1. Print area  
2. Feed direction  
3. Approximately 4.2 mm (0.17 inches)  
4. Approximately 4.2 mm (0.17 inches)  
97  
       
2. Getting Started  
Envelope  
4
3
3
3
1
2
2
CER117  
1. Print area  
2. Feed direction  
3. Approximately 10 mm (0.39 inches)  
4. Approximately 15 mm (0.59 inches)  
• The print area may vary depending on the paper size, printer language and printer driver settings.  
• For better envelope printing, we recommend you set the right, left, top, and bottom print margins to  
at least 15 mm (0.59 inches) each.  
98  
Loading Paper  
Loading Paper  
This describes how to load paper into the paper tray and bypass tray.  
• Do not pull out the paper tray forcefully. If you do, the tray might fall and cause an injury.  
• When loading paper, take care not to trap or injure your fingers.  
2
Loading Paper in Tray 1  
The following example explains loading procedure for the standard paper tray (Tray 1).  
• Before printing on paper other than envelopes, make sure that the fusing unit levers inside the front  
cover are pulled up. Leaving the levers lowered can cause print quality problems when printing on  
paper other than envelopes.  
• Make sure paper is not stacked above the limit mark inside the tray. Misfeeds might occur.  
• After loading paper in the tray, specify the paper type and size using the control panel to avoid  
printing problems. This machine does not detect the paper size automatically.  
• Do not mix different types of paper in the same paper tray.  
• Do not move the side paper guides forcefully. Doing so can damage the tray.  
• Do not move the end paper guide forcefully. Doing so can damage the tray.  
• When inserting the tray, make sure it is not slanted. Inserting it at a slant can damage the machine.  
• Curled paper may jam. Straighten curled paper before loading.  
1. Pull out tray 1 carefully with both hands.  
CES059  
99  
       
2. Getting Started  
Place the tray on a flat surface.  
2. Push the metal plate down until it clicks into place to lock.  
2
CER031  
3. Pinch the clip on the side paper guide and slide it to match the standard size.  
CER032  
CER082  
When loading custom size paper, position the paper guide slightly wider than the actual paper  
size.  
100  
Loading Paper  
4. Pinch the front end paper guide and slide it inward to match the standard size.  
2
CER034  
CER113  
When loading custom size paper, position the paper guide slightly wider than the actual paper  
size.  
5. Load the new paper stack print side up.  
Make sure paper is not stacked higher than the upper limit (upper line) marked inside the tray.  
CER033  
Slide the guides inward, until they are flush against the paper's sides.  
Make sure the paper is not stacked higher than the projection on the side paper guides.  
101  
2. Getting Started  
2
CER083  
6. Check there are no gaps between the paper and the paper guides; both side and front  
end paper guides.  
CER076  
If there is a gap between the paper and the front end paper guide, as in the example below, the  
paper might not feed in correctly.  
CER077  
102  
Loading Paper  
7. Carefully push tray 1 straight into the machine.  
2
CES062  
To avoid paper jams, make sure the tray is securely inserted.  
• The upper limit differs depending on paper type; thin paper or thick paper. Check the label inside  
the tray to confirm the upper limit.  
• The remaining paper indicator on the right front side of the paper tray shows approximately how  
much paper is remaining.  
Loading paper longer than A4  
This section explains how to load paper longer than A4 (297 mm) into the machine.  
• Before printing on paper other than envelopes, make sure that the fusing unit levers inside the front  
cover are pulled up. Leaving the levers lowered can cause print quality problems when printing on  
paper other than envelopes.  
• Make sure paper is not stacked above the limit mark inside the tray. Misfeeds might occur.  
• After loading paper in the tray, specify the paper type and size using the control panel to avoid  
printing problems. This machine does not detect the paper size automatically.  
• Do not mix different types of paper in the same paper tray.  
• Do not move the side paper guides forcefully. Doing so can damage the tray.  
• Do not move the end paper guide forcefully. Doing so can damage the tray.  
• When inserting the tray, make sure it is not slanted. Inserting it at a slant can damage the machine.  
103  
 
2. Getting Started  
1. Remove the rear cover using a coin.  
2
CES123  
2. Pull out tray 1 carefully with both hands.  
CES059  
Place the tray on a flat surface.  
3. Push the metal plate down until it clicks into place to lock.  
CER031  
104  
Loading Paper  
4. Pinch the extender in the "PUSH" direction, and then pull out the extender until it stops  
(you will hear a click).  
2
CER084  
After extension, make sure the arrows on the extender and tray are aligned.  
CER085  
5. Pinch the clip on the side paper guide, and then slide it to match the paper size.  
CER102  
105  
2. Getting Started  
2
CER082  
6. Pinch the front end paper guide and slide it inward to match the Legal paper size.  
CER104  
CER235  
7. Load the new paper stack print side up.  
Make sure paper is not stacked higher than the upper limit (upper line) marked inside the tray.  
106  
Loading Paper  
2
CER103  
Slide the guides inward until they are flush against the paper's sides.  
Make sure the paper is not stacked higher than the projection on the side paper guides.  
CER083  
8. Check there are no gaps between the paper and the paper guides; both side and front  
end paper guides.  
CER105  
If there is a gap between the paper and the front end paper guide, as in the example below, the  
paper might not feed in correctly.  
107  
2. Getting Started  
2
CER106  
9. Carefully push tray 1 straight into the machine.  
CES062  
To avoid paper jams, make sure the tray is securely inserted.  
• To reinsert the extender, you might have to push it with moderate force.  
• The upper limit differs depending on paper type; thin paper or thick paper. Check the label inside  
the tray to confirm the upper limit.  
• The remaining paper indicator on the right front side of the paper tray shows approximately how  
much paper is remaining.  
Loading Paper in Tray 2  
The following example explains the loading procedure for Tray 2.  
108  
   
Loading Paper  
• Before printing on paper other than envelopes, make sure that the fusing unit levers inside the front  
cover are pulled up. Leaving the levers lowered can cause print quality problems when printing on  
paper other than envelopes.  
• Make sure paper is not stacked above the limit mark inside the tray. Misfeeds might occur.  
• After loading paper in the tray, specify the paper type and size using the control panel to avoid  
printing problems. This machine does not detect the paper size automatically.  
2
• Do not mix different types of paper in the same paper tray.  
• Do not move the side paper guides forcefully. Doing so can damage the tray.  
• Do not move the end paper guide forcefully. Doing so can damage the tray.  
• When inserting the tray, make sure it is not slanted. Inserting it at a slant can damage the machine.  
1. Lift and pull Tray 2 carefully, and then pull it out with both hands.  
CER070  
Place the tray on a flat surface.  
2. Press down on the bottom plate until it clicks.  
CER071  
109  
2. Getting Started  
3. Pinch the clips on the side paper guide, and then adjust the guide to the paper size.  
2
CER072  
4. Pinch the clip on the end paper guide and align the arrow with the paper size.  
CER086  
5. Load the new paper stack print side up.  
Make sure paper is not stacked higher than the upper limit (upper line) marked inside the tray.  
CER073  
110  
Loading Paper  
6. Lift and slide the tray, then push it all the way in.  
2
CER074  
To avoid paper jams, make sure the tray is securely inserted.  
• The upper limit differs depending on paper type; thin paper or thick paper. Check the engraved  
line inside the tray to confirm the upper limit.  
• The remaining paper indicator on the right front side of the paper tray shows approximately how  
much paper is remaining.  
Loading Paper in the Bypass Tray  
• Before printing on paper other than envelopes, make sure that the fusing unit levers inside the front  
cover are pulled up. Leaving the levers lowered can cause print quality problems when printing on  
paper other than envelopes.  
• Set the size of the loaded paper using the control panel or the printer driver. Make sure the settings  
do not conflict. Otherwise, the paper may jam or the print quality may be affected.  
• Load paper with the print side down and in the short-edge feed direction.  
• Duplex printing is not possible.  
• You cannot use the bypass tray to feed in paper that requires a specified printing position (such as  
preprinted paper). Use tray 1 for such paper.  
• If paper is curled, straighten it before loading, by bending the paper in the opposite direction to the  
curl, for example.  
• Do not load paper while the machine is printing.  
• Tray 1 and 2 are unavailable while paper is being loaded in the bypass tray.  
111  
   
2. Getting Started  
• You cannot load paper into the bypass tray while the machine is in Energy Saver mode. If the  
machine is in Energy Saver mode, press the [Copy] key to recover from Energy Saver mode.  
1. Insert the top edge of the paper into the machine.  
2
CES134  
2. Adjust the paper guides to the paper size.  
CES135  
3. Support the paper with both hands, and insert it carefully until it stops.  
CES136  
After the paper is inserted until it stops, the paper will be automatically fed into the machine a little.  
• After loading paper in the tray, specify the paper type and size using the control panel or the  
printer driver.  
112  
Loading Paper  
Loading Envelopes  
2
• The inside of this machine becomes very hot. Do not touch the parts labeled " " (indicating a  
hot surface).  
• Before printing on envelopes, make sure to lower the fusing unit levers inside the front cover to  
avoid envelopes coming out creased. Also, pull up the levers back to their original positions after  
printing. Leaving the levers lowered can cause print quality problems when printing on paper other  
than envelopes.  
• Since the temperature around the guide is high, wait for it to cool before touching the fusing unit  
levers.  
Lowering the fusing unit levers  
1. Pull the opening lever on the front cover, and then carefully lower the front cover.  
CES141  
113  
   
2. Getting Started  
2. Lower the fusing unit levers.  
2
CES257  
3. Using both hands, carefully push up the front cover until it closes.  
CES142  
Loading envelopes in tray 1  
• Avoid using self-adhesive envelopes. They may cause machine malfunctions.  
• Check there is no air in the envelopes before loading.  
• Load only one size and type of envelope at a time.  
• Before loading envelopes, flatten their leading edges (the edge going into the machine) by running  
a pencil or ruler across them.  
• Some kinds of envelope might cause misfeeds, wrinkles or print poorly.  
• Print quality on envelopes may be uneven if parts of an envelope have different thicknesses. Print  
one or two envelopes to check print quality.  
• In a hot and humid environment, the envelope might be output creased or improper printing  
quality.  
114  
 
Loading Paper  
1. Pull out tray 1 carefully with both hands.  
2
CES059  
Place the tray on a flat surface.  
2. Take out paper from Tray 1.  
3. Push the metal plate down until it clicks into place to lock.  
CER031  
4. Pinch the clip on the side paper guide, and then adjust the guides to the envelope.  
CER032  
5. Pinch the clip on the front end paper guide to match the envelope size.  
115  
2. Getting Started  
6. Set the envelopes in Tray 1 with the printing side facing up.  
2
CER111  
Make sure envelopes are not stacked higher than the upper limit (lower line) mark inside the tray.  
CER050  
7. Carefully push Tray 1 straight into the machine.  
CER051  
To avoid paper jams, make sure the tray is securely inserted.  
• Be sure to load envelopes so that their flaps are on the right. If you do not, the envelopes will  
become creased.  
• If printed envelopes come out badly creased, load the envelopes in the opposite direction, and  
then rotate the print object by 180 degrees using the printer driver before printing. For details, see  
the printer driver Help.  
116  
Loading Paper  
Loading envelopes in the bypass tray  
2
• Avoid using self-adhesive envelopes. They may cause machine malfunctions.  
• Check there is no air in the envelopes before loading.  
• Load only one size and type of envelope at a time.  
• Before loading envelopes, flatten their leading edges (the edge going into the machine) by running  
a pencil or ruler across them.  
• Some kinds of envelope might cause misfeeds, wrinkles or print poorly.  
• Print quality on envelopes may be uneven if parts of an envelope have different thicknesses. Print  
one or two envelopes to check print quality.  
• In a hot and humid environment, the envelope might be output creased or improper printing  
quality.  
1. Insert the edge of the envelope into the machine.  
CES202  
117  
 
2. Getting Started  
2. Adjust the paper guides to the envelope size.  
2
CES203  
3. Support the envelope with both hands, and insert it carefully until it stops.  
CES204  
After the envelope is inserted until it stops, the envelope will be automatically fed into the machine  
a little.  
• Be sure to load envelopes so that their flaps are on the right. If you do not, the envelopes will  
become creased.  
• If printed envelopes come out badly creased, load the envelopes in the opposite direction, and  
then rotate the print object by 180 degrees using the printer driver before printing. For details, see  
the printer driver Help.  
Specifying Paper Type and Paper Size  
This section describes how to specify the paper size and paper type using the control panel.  
118  
   
Loading Paper  
• Paper type and size can also be specified using the printer driver. For details, see the printer driver  
Help.  
• For prints from the bypass tray, you can select to print according to either the printer driver settings  
or the control panel settings with [Bypass Tray Priority] under system settings.  
• If [Auto Continue] under system settings is enabled, printing stops temporarily if a paper type/size  
error is detected. The printing restarts automatically with the settings made with the control panel  
after about ten seconds.  
2
Specifying the paper type  
This section describes how to specify the paper type.  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
CES184  
2. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [System Settings], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Tray Paper Settings], and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select the paper type setting for the desired tray, and then press  
the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select the desired paper type, and then press the [OK] key.  
6. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
119  
 
2. Getting Started  
Specifying the standard paper size  
This section describes how to specify the standard paper size.  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
2
CES184  
2. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [System Settings], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Tray Paper Settings], and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select the paper size setting for the desired tray, and then press  
the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [ ] [ ] [ ] [ ] keys to select the desired paper size, and then press the [OK] key.  
6. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
Specifying a custom paper size  
This section describes how to specify a custom paper size.  
• Custom size paper cannot be loaded in tray 2.  
• When you perform printing, make sure that the paper size specified with the printer driver matches  
the paper size specified with the control panel. If a paper size mismatch occurs, a message  
appears on the display. To ignore the error and print using mismatched paper, see "If a Paper  
Mismatch Occurs".  
120  
 
Loading Paper  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
2
CES184  
2. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [System Settings], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [Tray Paper Settings], and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select the paper size setting for the desired tray, and then press  
the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [ ] [ ] [ ] [ ] keys to select [Custom Size], and then press the [OK] key.  
6. Press the [ ] [ ] keys to select [mm] or [inch], and then press the [OK] key.  
7. Enter the width using number keys, and then press the [OK] key.  
To enter a decimal point, press [ ].  
8. Enter the length using number keys, and then press the [OK] key.  
To enter a decimal point, press [ ].  
9. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
121  
2. Getting Started  
Placing Originals  
This section describes the types of originals you can set and how to place them.  
About Originals  
2
This section describes the types of originals that can be placed and the parts of the original that are  
unscannable.  
Recommended size of originals  
This section describes the recommended size of the original.  
Exposure glass  
Up to 216 mm (8.5") in width, up to 297 mm (11.7") in length  
ADF  
1
1
1
• Paper size: 140 to 216 mm (5 / " to 8 / ") in width, 140 to 356 mm (5 / " to 14") in  
2
2
2
length  
2
• Paper weight: 64 to 90 g/m (17 to 24 lb.)  
• Only 1 sheet of an original can be placed on the exposure glass at a time.  
• Up to 35 sheets of an original can be placed in the ADF at once (when using paper weighing 80  
2
g/m , 20 lb.).  
Types of originals not supported by the Auto Document Feeder  
If placed in the ADF, the following types of original might be damaged or become jammed, or result in  
gray or black lines appearing on prints:  
• Originals larger or heavier than recommended  
• Stapled or clipped originals  
• Perforated or torn originals  
• Curled, folded, or creased originals  
• Pasted originals  
• Originals with any kind of coating, such as thermal fax paper, art paper, aluminum foil, carbon  
paper, or conductive paper  
• Originals with perforated lines  
• Originals with indexes, tags, or other projecting parts  
122  
           
Placing Originals  
• Sticky originals such as translucent paper  
• Thin, highly flexible originals  
• Thick originals such as postcards  
• Bound originals such as books  
• Transparent originals such as OHP transparencies or translucent paper  
• Originals that are wet with toner or white out  
2
Unscannable image area  
Even if you correctly place originals in the ADF or on the exposure glass, margins of a few millimeters on  
all four sides of the original might not be scanned.  
CES107  
Margins when using exposure glass  
In copier mode  
3 mm  
In scanner mode  
0 mm  
In fax mode  
Top  
1 mm  
1 mm  
1 mm  
2 mm  
Right  
Left  
3 mm  
3 mm  
3 mm  
0 mm  
0 mm  
0 mm  
Bottom  
Margins when using ADF  
In copier mode  
3 mm  
3 mm  
In scanner mode  
In fax mode  
Top  
0 mm  
0 mm  
0 mm  
Right  
1 mm (Letter, Legal)  
0 mm (other sizes)  
123  
 
2. Getting Started  
In copier mode  
3 mm  
In scanner mode  
0 mm  
In fax mode  
Left  
1 mm (Letter, Legal)  
0 mm (other sizes)  
Bottom  
3 mm  
2 mm  
2 mm  
2
Placing Originals  
This section describes the procedure for placing originals on the exposure glass and in the ADF.  
• Do not place originals before any correction fluid and toner has completely dried. Doing so may  
make marks on the exposure glass that will appear on copies.  
• The original in the ADF takes precedence over the original on the exposure glass if you place  
originals both in the ADF and on the exposure glass.  
• Because colors made by marker or highlighter pen on originals are difficult to reproduce, they  
might not appear on copies, or might appear as different colors.  
Placing originals on the exposure glass  
The exposure glass enables you to scan and send documents that cannot be fed into the ADF.  
• Do not lift the ADF forcefully. Otherwise, the cover of the ADF might open or be damaged.  
1. Lift the ADF.  
Be careful not to hold the input tray when lifting the ADF, for the tray might be damaged.  
124  
     
Placing Originals  
2. Place the original face down on the exposure glass. The original should be aligned to the  
rear left corner.  
2
CES070  
3. Lower the ADF.  
Hold down the ADF with your hands when using thick, folded, or bound originals and the ADF  
cannot be lowered completely.  
Placing originals in the Auto Document Feeder  
By using the ADF, you can scan multiple pages at once.  
• Do not place different size originals in the ADF at once.  
• Straighten curls in the originals before placing them in the ADF.  
• To prevent multiple sheets from being fed at once, fan the pages of your original before placing  
them in the ADF.  
• Place the original squarely.  
1. Adjust the guides according to the size of the original.  
CES108  
125  
 
2. Getting Started  
2. Place the aligned originals face up in the ADF. The last page should be on the bottom.  
2
CES200  
• When placing originals longer than A4, pull out the ADF tray's extenders.  
126  
Entering Characters  
Entering Characters  
This section describes how to enter characters using the control panel when configuring the machine's  
settings.  
Use the keys as follows to enter characters.  
To enter a digit  
2
Press a number key.  
To delete a character  
Press the [ ] key.  
To enter a fax number  
• To enter a number  
Use the number keys.  
• To enter characters other than digits  
"
"
": Press [ ].  
": Press [ ].  
Pause: Press the [Pause/Redial] key. "P" appears on the screen.  
Space: Press the [ ] key.  
To enter a name  
Letters, numbers, and symbols can be entered using the number keys.  
To enter two characters that use the same number key successively, wait briefly after entering the  
first character.  
CES164  
• Characters you can enter depend on the setting you are configuring.  
127  
   
2. Getting Started  
• If the number you entered is too large or too small for the setting, it will not be accepted. If you  
press the [OK] key, the machine will increase or decrease the number to the minimum or maximum  
value for the setting.  
2
128  
Restricting Machine Functions According to User  
Restricting Machine Functions According to  
User  
You can set the machine to require a user code when someone tries to use certain machine functions.  
2
• This function is available for the Type 2 model only.  
• When print jobs are restricted, you can only authenticate through the PCL printer driver. Printing  
from the PostScript 3 printer driver will not be possible.  
Use of the following functions can be restricted:  
• Copying (both color and black-and-white)  
• Color copying  
• Sending faxes  
• Scan to E-mail/FTP/Folder  
• Scan to USB  
• PictBridge printing  
• Printing (both color and black-and-white)  
• Color printing  
• Sending faxes via LAN-Fax  
To enable this setting, you must first configure the machine via Web Image Monitor.  
Enabling the User Restriction Settings  
This section describes how to set the machine to permit only authorized users to use certain machine  
functions.  
Using Web Image Monitor, enable user restriction for all or some of the functions listed below, and then  
register users who can use those functions.  
• Copying (both color and black-and-white)  
• Color copying  
• Sending faxes  
• Scan to E-mail/FTP/Folder  
• Scan to USB  
• PictBridge printing  
• Printing (both color and black-and-white)  
• Color printing  
129  
     
2. Getting Started  
• Sending faxes via LAN-Fax  
For each user, you can specify which functions are available upon authentication. A maximum of 30  
users can be registered.  
1. Start the Web browser, and access the machine by entering its IP address.  
2. Click [Restrict Available Functions].  
3. Enter the administrator password if required.  
4. Click [Apply].  
2
5. Under "Available Functions", select [Restrict] for the functions you want to restrict, and  
then click [Apply].  
Select [Do not Restrict] for the functions you do not want to restrict.  
The user restriction setting is enabled for the selected function. Proceed to the following steps to  
register users.  
6. Click [Available Functions per User].  
A list of currently registered user entries appears.  
130  
Restricting Machine Functions According to User  
7. Select a user entry, and then click [Change].  
2
8. Type a unique user name in [User Name] using up to 16 alphanumeric characters.  
9. Type a unique user code in [User Code] using up to 8 digits.  
The user code will be used to authenticate users when they try to use a restricted function.  
10. Select the functions you want to make available for the user upon authentication.  
Unselected functions will be unavailable to users authenticated under this user code.  
11. Click [Apply].  
12. Close the Web browser.  
• You must enter both a user name and user code to register a user entry.  
• No two user entries can have the same user name or user code.  
Modifying user entries  
This section describes how to modify user entries.  
1. Start the Web browser, and access the machine by entering its IP address.  
2. Click [Restrict Available Functions].  
3. Enter the administrator password if required.  
4. Click [Apply].  
5. Click [Available Functions per User].  
A list of currently registered user entries appears.  
6. Select the entry to modify, and then click [Change].  
7. Modify settings as necessary.  
8. Click [Apply].  
131  
 
2. Getting Started  
9. Close the Web browser.  
Deleting user entries  
2
This section describes how to delete user entries.  
1. Start the Web browser, and access the machine by entering its IP address.  
2. Click [Restrict Available Functions].  
3. Enter the administrator password if required.  
4. Click [Apply].  
5. Click [Available Functions per User].  
A list of currently registered user entries appears.  
6. Select the entry to delete, and then click [Delete].  
7. Confirm that the entry you have selected is the entry that you want to delete.  
8. Click [Apply].  
9. Close the Web browser.  
132  
 
When Machine Functions are Restricted  
When Machine Functions are Restricted  
When a machine function is restricted, only authorized users are able to use that function.  
Depending on the restricted function, users will be authenticated from the machine's control panel or in  
the printer/LAN-Fax driver.  
2
• This function is available for the Type 2 model only.  
• When print jobs are restricted, you can only authenticate through the PCL printer driver. Printing  
from the PostScript 3 printer driver will not be possible.  
The table below shows the functions that can be restricted, and how users can be authenticated to use  
those functions.  
Restricted Function  
Authentication method  
• Copying (both color and  
black-and-white)  
The machine requests for a user code when a user presses the  
[B&W Start] or [Color Start] key.  
• Color copying  
• Sending faxes  
The user must enter a valid user code from the control panel.  
• Scan to E-mail/FTP/Folder  
• Scan to USB  
• PictBridge printing  
The machine requests for a user code when a digital camera is  
connected to the machine.  
The user must enter a valid user code from the control panel.  
• Printing (both color and  
black-and-white)  
The user must enter a valid user code in the printer or LAN-Fax  
driver before executing a print command.  
• Color printing  
• Sending faxes via LAN-Fax  
Authenticating through the control panel  
1. When the machine requests for a user code, enter a user code using the number keys.  
If you enter a wrong user code 3 times, the machine beeps and denies the authentication.  
2. Press the [OK] key.  
Authenticating through the printer or LAN-Fax driver  
1. Open the file you want to print on your computer.  
2. Open the printer driver's properties.  
133  
   
2. Getting Started  
3. Click the [Valid Access] tab (PCL printer driver) or check the [User Code] check box. (LAN-  
Fax driver).  
4. Type the user code using 1 to 8 digits, and then click [OK].  
5. Execute a print command.  
If an incorrect user code is entered, the job will be canceled automatically (there will be no error  
message).  
2
134  
3. Using the Printer Function  
This chapter describes the printer functions.  
Configuring Option and Paper Settings  
Configure the printer driver according to the machine's option and paper settings.  
• Manage Printers permission is required to change the printer properties. Log on as an  
Administrators group member to acquire this permission.  
3
• We recommend that bidirectional communication between the machine and the computer be  
enabled whenever possible. Bidirectional communication allows the computer to retrieve the  
machine's paper settings, current status, and other information.  
Conditions for Bidirectional Communication  
To establish bidirectional communication, the following conditions must be met:  
• Operating system of the computer: Windows XP/Vista/7, and Windows Server 2003/2003  
R2/2008/2008 R2  
• When connected via a network  
The machine is connected via a standard TCP/IP port, and the default port name must not be  
changed.  
[Enable bidirectional support] in the [Port] tab of the printer properties is selected.  
• When connected via USB  
The machine is connected to the computer's USB port using a USB interface.  
[Enable bidirectional support] in the [Port] tab of the printer properties is selected.  
Windows  
The following procedure is based on Windows XP as an example.  
1. On the [Start] menu, click [Printers and Faxes].  
2. Click the printer icon you want to use.  
3. On the [File] menu, click [Properties].  
4. Click the [Accessories] tab.  
5. Click [Update Now] under the [Options] area.  
If bidirectional communication is not established, select the installed option manually.  
135  
       
3. Using the Printer Function  
6. Under [Paper Size Settings], select the tray you want to use, then select the paper size,  
and then click [Update Now].  
If bidirectional communication is not established, select the tray and paper size manually.  
7. Click [OK] to close the printer properties dialog box.  
Mac OS X 10.3  
1. From the Apple menu, select [System Preferences…].  
3
2. Under "Hardware", click [Print & Fax].  
3. Click the [Set Up Printers…].  
4. Select the machine from "Printer List", and then click [Show Info].  
5. In the [Printer Info] dialog box, select [Installable Options] from the list.  
6. Check the tray 2 configuration, and then click [Apply Changes].  
7. Click the close button at the upper left corner to close the [Printer Info] dialog box.  
8. Click the close button at the upper left corner to close the [Printer List] dialog box.  
9. From the [System Preferences] menu, click [Quit System Preferences].  
Mac OS X 10.4  
1. From the Apple menu, select [System Preferences…].  
2. Under "Hardware", click [Print & Fax].  
3. Select the machine from "Printer", and then click [Printer Setup...].  
4. In the [Printer Info] dialog box, select [Installable Options] from the list.  
5. Check the tray 2 configuration, and then click [Apply Changes].  
6. Click the close button at the upper left corner to close the [Printer Info] dialog box.  
7. From the [System Preferences] menu, click [Quit System Preferences].  
Mac OS X 10.5/10.6  
1. From the Apple menu, select [System Preferences…].  
2. Under "Hardware", click [Print & Fax].  
3. Select the machine from "Printers", and then click [Options & Supplies...].  
4. Click the [Driver] tab.  
5. Check the tray 2 configuration, and then click [OK].  
136  
       
Configuring Option and Paper Settings  
6. From the [System Preferences] menu, click [Quit System Preferences].  
3
137  
3. Using the Printer Function  
Accessing the Printer Properties  
This section describes accessing the printer properties. For details about settings, see the printer driver  
Help.  
Accessing the Printer Properties from the [Printers and Faxes] Window  
3
• To change the printer default settings including option configuration settings, log on using an  
account that has Manage Printers permission. Members of the Administrators group have Manage  
Printers permission by default.  
• You cannot change the printer default settings for each user. Settings configured in the printer  
properties dialog box are applied to all users. Procedures and screens might vary depending on  
the operating system you are using.  
• The following procedure is based on Windows XP as an example. If you are using another  
operating system, the procedure might vary slightly.  
1. On the [Start] menu, click [Printers and Faxes].  
The [Printers and Faxes] window appears.  
2. Click the printer icon you want to use.  
3. On the [File] menu, click [Properties].  
The printer properties dialog box appears.  
• The settings you configure here are used as the default settings for all applications.  
• When accessing the PostScript3 printer properties, do not change settings for [Form to Tray  
Assignment].  
Accessing the Printer Properties from an Application  
Windows  
You can configure printer settings for a specific application.  
To configure printer settings for a specific application, open the [Printing Preferences] dialog box in that  
application.  
The following procedure explains how to configure settings for the WordPad application provided with  
Windows XP.  
138  
         
Accessing the Printer Properties  
1. On the [File] menu, click [Print...].  
The [Print] dialog box appears.  
2. Select the printer you want to use in the [Select Printer] list, and then click [Preferences].  
• The procedure to open the [Printing Preferences] dialog box may vary depending on the  
application. For details, see the manuals provided with the application.  
• Any settings you configure in the procedure above are valid for the current application only.  
• General users can change the properties displayed in the [Print] dialog box of an application. The  
settings configured here are used as defaults when printing from that application.  
3
Mac OS X  
1. Open the file you want to print.  
2. On the [File] menu, click [Print...].  
3. In the [Printer:] list, select the printer you want to use.  
139  
3. Using the Printer Function  
Basic Operation in Printer Mode  
The following procedure explains how to perform basic printing.  
1. Open the printer properties dialog box in your document's application.  
2. Set printing options as necessary, and then click [OK].  
The printer properties dialog box closes.  
3. Click [OK].  
3
• If printing (both color and black-and-white or only color) is restricted, you must enter a user code in  
the printer driver's properties before sending a print job to the machine.  
• If tray 2 is installed and automatic tray selection is specified for the print job, you can select the tray  
the machine uses first in [Paper Tray Priority] under system settings.  
• If a paper jam occurs, printing stops after the current page has been printed out. After the jammed  
paper is removed, printing restarts from the jammed page automatically.  
• After printing on envelopes, make sure to pull up the fusing unit levers back to their original  
positions. Leaving the levers lowered can cause print quality problems when printing on paper  
other than envelopes.  
If a Paper Mismatch Occurs  
If the paper size or type does not match the print job's settings, the machine reports an error. There are  
two ways to resolve this error:  
Continue printing using mismatched paper  
Use the form-feed function to ignore the error and print using mismatched paper.  
Reset the print job  
Cancel printing.  
140  
       
Basic Operation in Printer Mode  
• If [Auto Continue] under system settings is enabled, the machine ignores the paper type and size  
settings and prints on whatever paper is loaded. Printing stops temporarily when the error is  
detected, and restarts automatically after about ten seconds using the settings made on the control  
panel.  
3
Continuing printing using mismatched paper  
1. While the error message is displayed, press [FormFeed].  
Printing resumes on whatever paper is loaded.  
• If the paper is too small for the print job, the printed image will be cropped.  
Resetting the print job  
1. When the error message is displayed, press [JobReset].  
2. Press [Yes].  
Printing is canceled.  
Canceling a Print Job  
You can cancel print jobs using either the machine’s control panel or your computer, depending on the  
status of the job.  
Canceling a print job before printing has started  
Cancel the print job from the computer.  
Windows  
1. Double-click the printer icon on the task bar of your computer.  
2. Select the print job you want to cancel, click the [Document] menu, and then click  
[Cancel].  
Mac OS X 10.3  
1. From the Apple menu, select [System Preferences...].  
141  
     
3. Using the Printer Function  
2. Under "Hardware", click [Print & Fax].  
3. Click [Set Up Printers…].  
4. Double-click the machine from "Printer List".  
5. Select the print job you want to cancel, and then click [Delete].  
Mac OS X 10.4  
1. From the Apple menu, select [System Preferences...].  
2. Under "Hardware", click [Print & Fax].  
3
3. Double-click the machine from "Printer".  
4. Select the print job you want to cancel, and then click [Delete].  
Mac OS X 10.5/10.6  
1. From the Apple menu, select [System Preferences...].  
2. Under "Hardware", click [Print & Fax].  
3. Double-click the machine from "Printers".  
4. Select the print job you want to cancel, and then click [Delete].  
• If the printer is shared by multiple computers, be careful not to cancel the print job of another user.  
• If you cancel a print job that has already been processed, printing may continue for a few pages  
before being canceled.  
• In Windows Vista/7 and Windows Server 2008/2008 R2, click [Cancel Printing] on the  
[Document] menu.  
• You can also open the print job queue window by double-clicking the printer icon in the [Printers  
and Faxes] window (the [Printers] window under Vista/7 and Windows Server 2008/2008 R2).  
• If you cancel a Locked Print job, the machine might have already stored some pages of the job as  
a Locked Print file. If this happens, use the control panel to delete the Locked Print file.  
• It may take a while to cancel a large print job.  
Canceling a print job while printing  
Cancel the print job using the control panel.  
1. Press the [Clear/Stop] key.  
2. Press [Yes].  
142  
 
Printing Confidential Documents  
Printing Confidential Documents  
If you use the Locked Print function, you can password protect your print job.  
This means that your job is printed only after you enter the password using the machine's control panel.  
This function prevents unauthorized users seeing sensitive documents at the machine.  
• This function is available for the Type 2 model only.  
• This function is only available when using the PCL printer driver, and printing from a computer  
running a Windows operating system.  
3
Storing a Locked Print file  
This section describes how to store a Locked Print file in the machine using the printer driver.  
1. Open the file you want to print on your computer.  
2. Open the printer driver's properties.  
3. Click the [Setup] tab, and then select [Locked Print].  
The [Password:] and [User ID:] text boxes become available.  
The [User ID:] text box contains the login user name of your computer account or the user code that  
you used for the previous Locked Print job.  
4. Type the password (containing 4 to 8 digits) and user ID (containing 1 to 9 alphanumeric  
characters), and then click [OK].  
The user code will be used to identify your Locked Print file on the machine's control panel.  
5. Execute a print command.  
The print job is stored in the machine as a Locked Print file. You can print the file by entering the  
password using the control panel.  
• The Locked Print file is automatically erased from the machine's memory when it is printed out, or  
when the machine's power is turned off.  
• The machine can store a maximum of 5 jobs or 5 MB of Locked Print data at a time.  
• Even if the machine cannot store any more Locked Print files, the machine holds a new Locked Print  
file for the period of time specified in [Locked Print] under system settings before canceling the job.  
Within this time, you can print or delete the new Locked Print file. You can also print or delete an  
existing Locked Print file so that the new Locked Print file can be stored in the machine.  
• When a Locked Print job is canceled, the machine automatically records the cancellation in a log.  
You can use this log to identify which Locked Print jobs have been canceled.  
143  
     
3. Using the Printer Function  
Printing a Locked Print file  
When there is a Locked Print file stored in the machine, “Locked Print Job Press User Tools key” appears  
on the machine's control panel display when the machine is in the copier mode.  
3
Use the following procedure to unlock and print the Locked Print file.  
1. When the Locked Print message is displayed, press the [User Tools] key.  
CES184  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the file you want to print, and then press the [OK] key.  
Identify the Locked Print file by checking its time stamp and user ID.  
3. Press [Print].  
144  
   
Printing Confidential Documents  
4. Enter the password using the number keys, and then press the [OK] key.  
The Locked Print file is printed.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• To enter the menu for changing the machine's settings, press the [Scanner] key or the [Facsimile]  
key, and then press the [User Tools] key. To print a Locked Print file, press the [Copy] key to return  
to the copier mode.  
• If the machine is currently printing, you cannot print a Locked Print file. The machine beeps if you try  
to do so.  
3
• While entering a password using the control panel, the machine cannot begin other print jobs.  
• The Locked Print file is automatically erased from the machine's memory when it is printed out, or  
when the machine's power is turned off.  
Deleting a Locked Print file  
When there is a Locked Print file stored in the machine, “Locked Print Job Press User Tools key” appears  
on the machine's control panel display when the machine is in the copier mode.  
Use the following procedure to delete a Locked Print file. You do not need to enter a password to delete  
a Locked Print file.  
145  
   
3. Using the Printer Function  
1. When the Locked Print message is displayed, press the [User Tools] key.  
3
CES184  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the file you want to delete, and then press the [OK] key.  
Identify the Locked Print file by checking its time stamp and user ID.  
3. Press [Delete].  
The Locked Print file is deleted.  
If there are Locked Print files/logs remaining in the machine, the display returns to the list of Locked  
Print files/logs. If there are none remaining, the display returns to the initial screen.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• To enter the menu for changing the machine's settings, press the [Scanner] key or the [Facsimile]  
key, and then press the [User Tools] key. To delete a Locked Print file, press the [Copy] key to  
return to the copier mode.  
Checking which Locked Print File Jobs Have Been Canceled  
When a Locked Print job is canceled, the machine automatically records the cancellation in a log. If the  
machine has created a cancellation log, “Locked Print Job Deleted Press User Tools key” will appear on  
the control panel display when the machine is in the copier mode.  
146  
   
Printing Confidential Documents  
Use the following procedure to check which Locked Print file jobs have been canceled.  
1. When the Locked Print message is displayed, press the [User Tools] key.  
3
CES184  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to find a file whose name starts with an "!" mark.  
The "!" mark indicates that the job has been canceled.  
Identify the Locked Print file by checking its time stamp and user ID.  
To delete the log entry, proceed to the following steps.  
3. Press the [OK] key.  
4. Press [Delete].  
The log is deleted.  
If there are Locked Print logs/files remaining in the machine, the display returns to the list of Locked  
Print logs/files. If there are none remaining, the display returns to the initial screen.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• To enter the menu for changing the machine's settings, press the [Scanner] key or the [Facsimile]  
key, and then press the [User Tools] key. To check the Locked Print log, press the [Copy] key to  
return to the copier mode.  
147  
3. Using the Printer Function  
• The machine keeps a log of the 10 most recent canceled jobs. If a Locked Print file is canceled  
when the machine's log is already full, the oldest log will be deleted automatically.  
• The message “Locked Print Job Deleted Press User Tools key” disappears when all log entries are  
cleared.  
• The log will be cleared when the machine is turned off.  
3
148  
Direct Printing from a Digital Camera (PictBridge)  
Direct Printing from a Digital Camera  
(PictBridge)  
What Is PictBridge?  
You can connect a PictBridge-compatible digital camera to this machine using a USB cable. This allows  
you to directly print photographs taken using the digital camera by operating the digital camera.  
3
• Check your digital camera is PictBridge-compatible.  
• Up to 999 images can be sent from the digital camera to the machine during one print transaction.  
If an attempt is made to send more images, an error message is sent to the camera and printing  
fails.  
• Since printing conditions are specified on the digital camera, specifiable parameters depend on  
the digital camera. For details, see the manuals provided with the digital camera.  
• This function is compatible with USB 2.0.  
PictBridge Printing  
Use the following procedure to start PictBridge printing on this machine.  
• Memory overflow errors can occur when printing a high-resolution image. If this happens, reduce  
the size of the data,, and then try the operation again.  
• Do not disconnect the USB cable while data is being sent. If you do, printing will fail.  
1. Connect the machine with a digital camera using a USB cable.  
For details, see "Connecting with a Digital Camera Using a USB Cable".  
2. On your digital camera, select the images you want to print, and then specify the printing  
conditions.  
3. The machine receives settings from the digital camera and starts printing.  
• Some digital cameras require settings for manual PictBridge operation. For details, see the manual  
provided with the digital camera.  
• Some digital cameras require turning the power switch off for a manual PictBridge operation. For  
details, see the manual provided with the digital camera.  
149  
       
3. Using the Printer Function  
• Some digital cameras need to be switched off when connecting to the printer. For details, see the  
manual provided with the digital camera.  
What Can Be Done on this Machine  
3
This machine can perform the following functions using its PictBridge feature.  
The settings available for these functions are as follows:  
• Single image printing  
• Selected image printing  
• All image printing  
• Index printing  
• Copies  
• Paper size  
• N-up layout  
• The setting parameters and their names may vary depending on the digital camera. For details, see  
the manuals provided with the digital camera.  
Index printing  
Use this function to print all images at a reduced size.  
The settings available for these functions are as follows:  
• A4 (210 × 297 mm, 8.3 × 11.7 in)  
Horizontal images × vertical images: 8 × 13  
1
• Letter (215.9 × 279.4 mm, 8 / × 11 in)  
2
Horizontal images × vertical images: 8 × 12  
• Depending on the digital camera, a form feed may be inserted after one set of images belonging  
to one type ends.  
• The number of images for each size of paper is fixed.  
150  
   
Direct Printing from a Digital Camera (PictBridge)  
Paper size  
Use this function to print on paper with the size specified on the digital camera.  
Paper size name Actual size  
A4  
210 × 297 mm (8.3 × 11.7 in)  
1
1
Letter (8 / ” × 11”)  
215.9 × 279.4 mm (8 / × 11 in)  
2
2
3
N-up layout  
Use this function to print 2 or 4 images on the specified paper.  
• Depending on the digital camera, a form feed may be inserted after one set of images belonging  
to one type ends.  
Exiting PictBridge  
Use the following procedure to quit the PictBridge mode.  
• Do not disconnect the USB cable while data is being sent to the machine. If you do, printing will  
fail.  
1. Check that "Ready" is shown on the screen.  
2. Disconnect the USB cable from the machine.  
Make sure to close the cover of the USB flash disk port after use.  
When PictBridge Printing Does Not Work  
This section explains likely causes and possible solutions for problems that can occur when PictBridge  
printing.  
151  
       
3. Using the Printer Function  
Problem  
Cause  
Solution  
PictBridge is not available.  
There is a problem with the USB Use the following procedure to  
connection or the PictBridge  
settings.  
check the connection and  
settings:  
1. Disconnect and then  
reconnect the USB cable.  
2. Check the PictBridge  
settings are enabled.  
3
3. Disconnect the USB cable,  
and then turn off the  
machine. Turn the machine  
back on. When the  
machine has fully booted  
up, reconnect the USB  
cable.  
When two or more digital  
cameras are connected, the  
second and subsequent  
You have connected multiple  
digital cameras.  
Connect one digital camera  
only.  
Do not connect multiple  
cameras.  
cameras are not recognized.  
Printing is disabled.  
The specified number exceeds  
the maximum number that can  
be printed at a time.  
The maximum specifiable print  
quantity at a time is 999.  
Respecify the quantity to 999 or  
less, and then retry printing.  
Printing is disabled.  
There is no paper of the  
specified size remaining.  
There is no paper of the  
specified size remaining.  
If you have to use paper that is  
not of the specified size,  
perform continue printing using  
mismatched paper or cancel the  
Printing is disabled.  
The paper size setting for this  
tray cannot be printed on the  
machine.  
Select the paper size setting that  
can be printed on the machine.  
152  
Using Various Print Functions  
Using Various Print Functions  
This section briefly describes various print functions that you can configure with the printer driver to make  
printouts appropriate for your purposes.  
Print Quality Functions  
Print quality and color tone can be adjusted to suit the print data. Some of the print quality settings you  
can configure are described below.  
3
Printing color documents in black and white  
The black produced in black and white printing is a more distinct black than that produced in color  
printing.  
Separating the print data into CMYK and printing in designated color only  
Normally, all four colors (CMYK) are used for color printing. If you do not want to use certain  
colors, you can disable the use of those colors and print using other colors only.  
Saving toner when printing (Economy Color printing)  
You can save toner by printing with lower toner consumption. The amount of toner that will be used  
depends on the object, such as text, line, or image.  
Changing the image printing method  
You can select to print with priority on print quality or print speed. When printing images, the higher  
the resolution of images, the longer the time required for printing.  
Changing the dither pattern  
A dither pattern is a pattern of dots used to simulate a color or shade of an image. If the pattern is  
changed, the characteristics of the image will also change. You can select a pattern suitable for the  
image to be printed.  
Changing the color profiling pattern  
You can select a color profiling pattern to adjust the tone of colors according to the colors  
displayed on the computer screen.  
Because colors on the computer screen are created using the three RGB colors while colors for  
printing are composed of the four CMYK colors, colors need to be converted during the printing  
process. Therefore, images on the printed paper may look different from those on the computer  
screen if adjustment is not performed.  
Printing grayscale images using black or CMYK  
You can print black or gray sections of an image using black toner only, instead of using all CMYK  
toners. Compared to the black printed with CMYK toner, this results in a black that is flatter and  
purer.  
153  
       
3. Using the Printer Function  
Using ICM (Image Color Matching)  
You can use Windows ICM function to reproduce colors that appear on the computer screen as  
close as they are on printed paper.  
To use this function, the color profile must be added to the computer. You can find the color profile  
in the ICM folder stored on the provided printer driver CD-ROM. For information about adding a  
color profile, search Windows Help for “color profile”, and then see the appropriate topic.  
Changing the method of downloading TrueType fonts to the machine  
When you print documents that contain characters in TrueType fonts, garbled or distorted  
characters may be printed. Changing the method of downloading TrueType fonts may help to solve  
the problem.  
3
• Some of the functions described above might not be available depending on the printer driver or  
operating system. For details, see the printer driver Help.  
Print Output Functions  
You can specify the form of print outputs according to your purposes. This section briefly describes some  
of the settings that you can specify.  
Printing multiple sets of a document  
You can print multiple sets of the same document.  
Collating the output in document batches  
You can print complete sets of a multiple-page document one set at a time (P1, P2, P1, P2 ...). If this  
function is not used when printing multiple sets, prints will be output in page batches (P1, P1, P2,  
P2 ...). This function is useful when, for example, making presentation materials.  
Changing orientation or rotating the image  
You can change the orientation of an image to portrait or landscape. You can also rotate the  
image by 180 degrees. Use rotation to prevent an image from being printed upside down when  
using paper that a predefined top and bottom (such as letterhead paper).  
Printing multiple pages per sheet  
You can print multiple pages onto one sheet of paper.  
When using this function, a suitable reduction ratio is selected automatically based on the paper  
size and the number of pages you want to fit on each sheet.  
Printing on both sides of paper (duplex printing)  
You can print on both sides of paper, and available binding options include booklet.  
154  
   
Using Various Print Functions  
Reducing or enlarging the document  
You can reduce or enlarge documents by a specific ratio, from 25% to 400% in 1% increments.  
You can also reduce or enlarge documents automatically to fit a specific paper size. This function is  
useful, for example, when printing Web pages.  
If the [Enable Large Papers] option is selected, A3/11” × 17”/B4/8K documents can be scaled  
to a size that the machine supports, so it can then be printed out.  
Suppressing printing of blank pages  
If a print job contains blank pages, they can be prevented from being printed.  
With the Type 2 model, this function can be set using the control panel instead of the printer driver.  
Printing with a cover page  
3
You can add a cover page to the print job.  
You can select to leave the cover page blank, or print the first page of the document on the cover  
page. If a cover page is inserted into a duplex job, you can print on its back side also.  
Paper for the cover page can either be the same as or different from the remaining pages.  
Printing on custom size paper  
You can print using non-standard size paper by specifying the size of the paper as custom size.  
Superimposing text on prints (watermark)  
You can superimpose watermark text on prints. Various predefined watermarks are provided. You  
can also create your own watermarks.  
• Some of the functions described above might not be available depending on the printer driver or  
operating system. For details, see the printer driver Help.  
155  
3. Using the Printer Function  
3
156  
4. Using the Copier Function  
This chapter describes the copier functions.  
The Screen in Copier Mode  
This section provides information about the screen when the machine is in copier mode.  
By default, the display shows the copier screen when the machine is turned on.  
If the scanner or fax screen is shown on the display, press the [Copy] key on the control panel to switch  
to the copier screen.  
4
CES174  
Screen in standby mode  
1
2
3
4
1
[
]
CES250  
1. Current status or messages  
Displays the current status or messages.  
2. Current settings  
Displays the current tray, reproduction ratio, and scan settings.  
3. Selection key items  
If function names appear on the bottom, you can use them by pressing the corresponding selection keys.  
4. Copy quantity  
Displays the current copy quantity. You can change the copy quantity using the number keys.  
• The start-up mode can be specified in the [Function Priority] setting under [Admin. Tools].  
157  
     
Basic Operation in Copier Mode  
Basic Operation in Copier Mode  
This section describes the basic procedure for making photocopies.  
• The original in the ADF takes precedence over the original on the exposure glass if you place  
originals both in the ADF and on the exposure glass.  
1. Press the [Copy] key.  
4
CES174  
2. Place the original on the exposure glass or in the ADF.  
If necessary, configure advanced photocopy settings.  
3. To make multiple copies, enter the number of copies using the number keys.  
4. Press the [B&W Start] key or [Color Start] key.  
CES169  
To make black-and-white photocopies, press the [B&W Start] key.  
To make color photocopies, press the [Color Start] key.  
• The maximum number of copies is 99.  
• You can change the paper tray for the current job by pressing the [ ][ ] keys. If tray 2 is installed,  
you can select to change the paper tray automatically according to the paper size (A4 or Letter).  
159  
 
4. Using the Copier Function  
• You can select the paper tray for printing out copies in [Select Paper] under copy settings. If you set  
the machine to switch between tray 1 and 2 automatically depending on the paper size in this  
setting, you can also specify the tray the machine uses first in [Paper Tray Priority] under system  
settings.  
• When making multiple copies of a multi-page document, you can select whether copies are output  
in collated sets, or in page batches in the [Sort] setting under copy settings.  
• If a paper jam occurs, printing stops after the current page has been printed out. After the jammed  
paper is removed, printing restarts from the jammed page automatically.  
• If a scanning jam occurs in the ADF, copying is canceled immediately. In this case, copy the  
originals again starting from the jammed page.  
4
Canceling a Copy  
Follow the procedure below to cancel copying.  
While scanning the original  
If copying is canceled while the machine is scanning the original, copying is cancelled immediately  
and there is no printout.  
When the original is set in the ADF, scanning stops after the current page has been fed.  
While printing  
If copying is canceled during printing, the photocopy process is canceled after the current page  
has been printed out.  
160  
 
Basic Operation in Copier Mode  
1. Press the [Copy] key.  
2. Press the [Clear/Stop] key.  
3. Press [Yes].  
CES174  
4
CES173  
161  
4. Using the Copier Function  
Making Enlarged or Reduced Copies  
This section describes how to specify the reduction or enlargement ratio for the current job.  
Scaling  
There are two ways to set the scaling ratio: using a preset ratio or manually specifying a  
customized ratio.  
• Preset ratio  
4
CES103  
50%, 71%, 82%, 93%, 122%, 141%, 200%, 400%  
50%, 65%, 78%, 93%, 129%, 155%, 200%, 400%  
• Custom ratio  
CES106  
25% to 400% in 1% increments.  
Use this procedure to specify the reduction or enlargement ratio for the current job.  
162  
   
Making Enlarged or Reduced Copies  
1. Press the [Reduce/Enlarge] key.  
CES177  
2. Press [Reduce] or [Enlarge], press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] keys to select the desired ratio, and  
then press the [OK] key.  
4
3. If [Zoom] has been selected, specify the desired ratio using the number keys, and then  
press the [OK] key.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• You can change the machine's default [Reduce/Enlarge] setting to always make photocopies in  
the specified ratio.  
• Temporary job settings are cleared in the following cases:  
• When no input is received for the period of time specified in [System Auto Reset Timer] while  
the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the [Clear/Stop] key is pressed while the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the machine's mode is changed.  
• When the power is turned off.  
• When the machine's default for the same setting is changed.  
163  
4. Using the Copier Function  
Combining Multiple Pages  
This section describes how to set the machine to combine multiple pages of an original onto a single  
sheet of paper.  
There are two ways to combine multiple pages: 2-in-1/4-in-1 copy and ID card copy.  
2-in-1/4-in-1 copy  
You can copy two or four pages of an original onto a single sheet of paper.  
ID card copy  
You can copy the front and back sides of an ID card, or other small document, onto one side of a  
sheet of paper.  
4
Copying Two or Four Pages onto One Sheet  
This section describes how to set 2-in-1/4-in-1 copy mode for the current job.  
• This function is only available when the original is set in the ADF, not when it is set on the exposure  
glass.  
• To use this function, the paper size used for printing copies must be set to A4, Letter, or Legal.  
2-in-1 mode  
You can copy two pages of an original onto a single sheet of photocopied paper. Depending on  
the orientation of the original, the printout format can be selected from the following:  
• Portrait  
CES033  
• Landscape  
CES034  
Scaling is preset according to the paper size: 70% for A4 size, 64% for Letter size, and 60% for  
Legal size.  
164  
       
Combining Multiple Pages  
4-in-1 mode  
You can copy four pages of an original onto a single sheet of photocopied paper. Depending on  
the orientation of the original, the printout format can be selected from the following:  
• Portrait: L to R (Left to Right)  
CES035  
• Portrait: T to B (Top to Bottom)  
4
CES036  
• Landscape: L to R (Left to Right)  
CES037  
• Landscape: T to B (Top to Bottom)  
CES038  
Scaling is preset to 50%, regardless of the printout paper size.  
Use this procedure to set 2-in-1/4-in-1 copy mode for the current job.  
165  
4. Using the Copier Function  
1. Press the [Reduce/Enlarge] key.  
CES177  
2. Press [Reduce], press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] keys to select [Comb. 2 on 1] or [Comb. 4 on 1],  
and then press the [OK] key.  
4
3. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the desired printout format, and then press the [OK] key.  
• If [Comb. 2 on 1] has been selected, select [Portrait] or [Landscape].  
• If [Comb. 4 on 1] has been selected, select [Portrait: L to R], [Portrait: T to B], [Landscape: L to  
R], or [Landscape: T to B].  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• You can change the machine's default [Reduce/Enlarge] setting to always make photocopies in 2-  
in-1 or 4-in-1 mode.  
• Temporary job settings are cleared in the following cases:  
• When no input is received for the period of time specified in [System Auto Reset Timer] while  
the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the [Clear/Stop] key is pressed while the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the machine's mode is changed.  
• When the power is turned off.  
• When the machine's default for the same setting is changed.  
Copying Both Sides of an ID Card onto One Side of Paper  
This section describes how to copy the front and back sides of an ID card, or other small document, onto  
one side of a sheet of paper.  
166  
   
Combining Multiple Pages  
When copying onto A4 size paper, you can copy documents that are smaller than A5 size. Likewise,  
when copying onto a Letter size paper, you can copy documents that are smaller than Half Letter size.  
• This function is only available when the original is set on the exposure glass, not when it is set in the  
ADF.  
• To use this function, the paper size used for printing copies must be set to A4 or Letter.  
4
CES165  
To use this function, first switch to ID card copy mode for the current job, and then perform ID card copy.  
1. Press the [ID Card Copy] key.  
CES201  
The machine is now in ID card copy mode. Proceed to the following steps to perform the ID card  
copy.  
2. Place the original front side down and top to the machine rear on the exposure glass.  
Place the original in the center of the A5/Half Letter scan area.  
CES166  
167  
4. Using the Copier Function  
3. Press the [B&W Start] key or [Color Start] key.  
A message prompting you to place the original back side down on the exposure glass appears on  
the display.  
4. Within 30 seconds, place the original back side down and top to the machine rear on the  
exposure glass, and then press the [B&W Start] key or [Color Start] key again.  
Use the same mode (color or black-and-white) for both sides.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• Regardless of the machine's reduction or enlargement ratio setting, an ID card copy will always be  
made at 100%.  
• You can change the machine's default [Reduce/Enlarge] setting to always make photocopies in ID  
card copy mode.  
4
• Setting this function for the current job temporarily disables the [2 Sided Copy] setting  
automatically. However, after the temporary job setting is cleared, the 2-sided copy function will  
be enabled again automatically.  
• Temporary job settings are cleared in the following cases:  
• When no input is received for the period of time specified in [System Auto Reset Timer] while  
the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the [Clear/Stop] key is pressed while the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the machine's mode is changed.  
• When the power is turned off.  
• When the machine's default for the same setting is changed.  
168  
Making 2-sided Copies  
Making 2-sided Copies  
This section describes how to set the machine to make 2-sided copies by copying single-sided  
documents onto the front and back sides of each sheet.  
• This function is only available when the original is set in the ADF, not when it is set on the exposure  
glass.  
• Paper must be fed from tray 1 or tray 2, not from the bypass tray.  
1
• The paper size must be A4, B5, Letter, Legal, Executive, 8" x 13", 8 / " x 13", Folio, or 16K.  
2
• The paper type must be thin, plain, middle thick, recycled, color, preprinted or prepunched.  
4
You can select top-to-top or top-to-bottom binding, in either portrait or landscape orientation.  
Top to Top  
• Top to Top  
CES125  
• Top to Top  
CES126  
Top to Bottom  
• Top to Bottom  
CES127  
• Top to Bottom  
169  
   
4. Using the Copier Function  
CES128  
Use this procedure to set the machine to make 2-sided copies.  
1. Press the [Copy] key.  
4
CES174  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys.  
CES168  
3. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [2 Sided Copy], and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the binding method and orientation, and then press the  
[OK] key.  
5. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
"2 Sided Copy" appears on the display, indicating that the machine is now in 2-sided copy mode.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• After this function is set, all subsequent copies will be 2-sided, unless you cancel the setting by  
selecting [Off] for [2 Sided Copy].  
170  
Making 2-sided Copies  
• Setting this function automatically disables the [ID Card Copy] setting.  
4
171  
4. Using the Copier Function  
Specifying Scan Settings  
This section describes how to specify image density and quality for the current job.  
Adjusting Image Density  
This section describes how to adjust image density for the current job.  
There are five image density levels. The higher the density level, the darker the printout.  
1. Press the [Density] key.  
4
CES178  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the desired density level, and then press the [OK] key.  
• Press the [Escape] key to discard the current change and return to the initial screen.  
• You can change the machine's default [Density] setting to always make copies with a specific  
density level.  
• Temporary job settings are cleared in the following cases:  
• When no input is received for the period of time specified in [System Auto Reset Timer] while  
the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the [Clear/Stop] key is pressed while the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the machine's mode is changed.  
• When the power is turned off.  
• When the machine's default for the same setting is changed.  
172  
       
Specifying Scan Settings  
Selecting the Document Type According to Original  
This section describes how to select the best document type for the original that you are scanning.  
There are three document types:  
Text  
Select this when the original contains only text and no photographs or pictures.  
Photo  
Select this when the original contains only photographs or pictures. Use this mode for the following  
types of original:  
• Photographs  
4
• Pages that are entirely or mainly photographs or pictures, such as magazine pages.  
Mixed  
Select this when the original contains both text and photographs or pictures.  
1. Press the [Image Quality] key.  
CES179  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the desired document type, and then press the [OK] key.  
• Press the [Escape] key to discard the current change and return to the initial screen.  
• You can change the machine's default [Original Type] setting to always make copies with a  
specific document type.  
• Temporary job settings are cleared in the following cases:  
• When no input is received for the period of time specified in [System Auto Reset Timer] while  
the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the [Clear/Stop] key is pressed while the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the machine's mode is changed.  
• When the power is turned off.  
• When the machine's default for the same setting is changed.  
173  
   
5. Using the Scanner Function  
This chapter describes the scanner functions.  
There are two scanning methods: scanning using the control panel and scanning from the computer  
(TWAIN scanning).  
The Screen in Scanner Mode  
This section provides information about the screen in scanner mode.  
By default, the display shows the copier screen when the machine is turned on. If the copier or fax  
screen is shown on the display, press the [Scanner] key on the control panel to switch to the scanner  
screen.  
5
CES175  
Screen in standby mode  
1
2
3
CES251  
1. Current status or messages  
Displays the current status or messages.  
2. Current settings  
Displays the current scanning mode and scan settings.  
• When "Specify Dest." is displayed:  
Scan to E-mail, Scan to FTP, or Scan to Folder functions can be used.  
• When "Save Scn Data to USB" is displayed:  
A USB flash disk is inserted in the machine, and the Scan to USB function can be used.  
3. Selection key items  
Displays the functions you can use by pressing the corresponding selection keys.  
175  
     
5. Using the Scanner Function  
• The machine's default mode at power on can be specified in the [Function Priority] setting under  
[Admin. Tools].  
5
176  
Registering Scan Destinations  
Registering Scan Destinations  
This section describes how to register scan destinations in the Address Book. To send scanned files to an  
e-mail address (Scan to E-mail), FTP server (Scan to FTP), or a shared folder on a network computer  
(Scan to Folder), you must first register the destination in the Address Book using Web Image Monitor.  
• The Address Book data could be damaged or lost unexpectedly. The manufacturer shall not be  
responsible for any damages resulting from such data loss. Be sure to create backup files of the  
Address Book data periodically.  
• Depending on your network environment, the Scan to FTP and Scan to Folder functions may  
require a user name and password to be correctly entered in the destination information. In such  
cases, after registering destinations, check that the user name and password are correctly entered  
by sending test documents to those destinations.  
The Address Book can contain up to 100 entries, including 20 Quick Dial entries.  
5
Destinations registered as Quick Dial entries can be selected by pressing the corresponding One Touch  
button.  
1. Start the Web browser, and access the machine by entering its IP address.  
2. Click [Quick Dial Destination] or [Scan Destination].  
3. From the [Destination Type] list, select [E-mail Address], [FTP] or [Folder].  
4. Register information as necessary.  
The information you must register varies depending on the destination type. For details, see the  
tables below.  
5. Enter the administrator password if required.  
6. Click [Apply].  
7. Close the Web browser.  
177  
   
5. Using the Scanner Function  
Scan to E-mail Settings  
5
Item  
Setting  
Description  
Select when setting the destination as a Quick Dial  
entry.  
Quick Dial Number  
Optional  
Name of the destination. The name specified here will  
be shown on the screen when selecting a scan  
destination. Can contain up to 16 characters.  
Name  
Required  
Required  
E-mail address of the destination. Can contain up to  
64 characters.  
Destination E-mail Address  
E-mail address to which a notification is sent after  
transmission. Can contain up to 64 characters.  
Notification E-mail Address  
Subject  
Optional  
Required  
Subject of the e-mail. Can contain up to 64 characters.  
Name of e-mail sender. The name specified here will  
be shown under "From" or a similar field of the  
recipient's email application. Can contain up to 32  
characters.  
Sender's Name  
Optional  
File format of the scanned file when scanning in color.  
PDF or JPEG can be selected. PDF supports multiple  
pages in a document, but JPEG does not.  
File Format (Color/Gray  
Scale)  
Required  
Required  
File format of the scanned file when scanning in black  
and white. PDF or TIFF can be selected. Both formats  
support multiple pages in a document.  
File Format (Black & White)  
178  
Registering Scan Destinations  
Item  
Setting  
Description  
Select the scanning size for the original from A5, B5,  
A4, Executive, Half Letter, Letter, Legal, or custom size.  
Scan Size  
Optional  
If you select custom size, select [mm] or [Inch], and  
then specify the width and length.  
Select the scan resolution from 100×100, 150×150,  
200×200, 300×300, 400×400, or 600×600 dpi.  
Resolution  
Density  
Optional  
Optional  
Specify the image density by clicking the right or left  
buttons.  
is the lightest, and  
is the darkest.  
Scan to FTP Settings  
5
Item  
Setting  
Description  
Select when setting the destination as a Quick Dial  
entry.  
Quick Dial Number  
Optional  
Name of the destination. The name specified here will  
be shown on the screen when selecting a scan  
destination. Can contain up to 16 characters.  
Name  
Required  
Required  
Required  
Name or IP address of the FTP server. Can contain up  
to 64 characters.  
Hostname or IP Address  
File format of the scanned file when scanning in color.  
PDF or JPEG can be selected. PDF supports multiple  
pages in a document, but JPEG does not.  
File Format (Color/Gray  
Scale)  
179  
5. Using the Scanner Function  
Item  
Setting  
Description  
File format of the scanned file when scanning in black  
and white. PDF or TIFF can be selected. Both formats  
support multiple pages in a document.  
File Format (Black & White)  
Required  
User name for logging in to the FTP server. Can  
contain up to 32 characters.  
FTP User Name  
FTP Password  
Optional  
Optional  
Optional  
Optional  
Password for logging in to the FTP server. Can contain  
up to 32 characters.  
Name of the FTP server directory where scanned files  
are stored. Can contain up to 64 characters.  
Directory  
E-mail address to which a notification is sent after  
transmission. Can contain up to 64 characters.  
Notification E-mail Address  
5
Select the scanning size for the original from A5, B5,  
A4, Executive, Half Letter, Letter, Legal, or custom size.  
Scan Size  
Optional  
If you select custom size, select [mm] or [Inch], and  
then specify the width and length.  
Select the scan resolution from 100×100, 150×150,  
200×200, 300×300, 400×400, or 600×600 dpi.  
Resolution  
Optional  
Optional  
Specify the image density by clicking the right or left  
Density  
buttons.  
is the lightest, and  
is the darkest.  
Scan to Folder Settings  
180  
Registering Scan Destinations  
Item  
Setting  
Description  
Select when setting the destination as a Quick Dial  
entry.  
Quick Dial Number  
Optional  
Name of the destination. The name specified here will  
be shown on the screen when selecting a scan  
destination. Can contain up to 16 characters.  
Name  
Required  
Required  
Optional  
Path to the directory where scanned files will be stored.  
Consists of the IP address or name of the destination  
computer (can contain up to 64 characters), and name  
of the shared folder (can contain up to 32 characters).  
Service Name  
Domain  
If the destination computer is a member of an Active  
Directory domain, specify that domain name. Can  
contain up to 15 characters.  
5
User name for logging in to the destination computer.  
Can contain up to 32 characters.  
Login User Name  
Login Password  
Optional  
Optional  
Optional  
Optional  
Password for logging in to the destination computer.  
Can contain up to 32 characters.  
Directory within the shared folder for storing scanned  
files. Can contain up to 64 characters.  
Directory  
E-mail address to which a notification is sent after  
transmission. Can contain up to 64 characters.  
Notification E-mail Address  
File format of the scanned file when scanning in color.  
PDF or JPEG can be selected. PDF supports multiple  
pages in a document, but JPEG does not.  
File Format (Color/Gray  
Scale)  
Required  
Required  
File format of the scanned file when scanning in black  
and white. PDF or TIFF can be selected. Both formats  
support multiple pages in a document.  
File Format (B&W)  
Select the scanning size for the original from A5, B5,  
A4, Executive, Half Letter, Letter, Legal, or custom size.  
Scan Size  
Resolution  
Optional  
Optional  
If you select custom size, select [mm] or [Inch], and  
then specify the width and length.  
Select the scan resolution from 100×100, 150×150,  
200×200, 300×300, 400×400, or 600×600 dpi.  
181  
5. Using the Scanner Function  
Item  
Setting  
Description  
Specify the image density by clicking the right or left  
Density  
Optional  
buttons.  
is the lightest, and  
is the darkest.  
• To send files via e-mail, SMTP and DNS settings must be configured properly.  
• If you are using the Scan to E-mail function, select a time zone according to your geographic  
location to send email with correct transmission date and time.  
• To send files to an FTP server or computer, the user name, password, and directory must be  
configured properly.  
• On a network that uses a DNS server, specify a computer name in [Service Name] and the name  
of the domain to which the computer belongs in [Domain]. In this case, also configure the DNS  
related settings using Web Image Monitor.  
5
• The Scan to Folder destination must operate on one of the following operating systems: Windows  
XP/Vista/7, Windows Server 2003/2003 R2/2008/2008 R2, or Mac OS X.  
• Scan destinations cannot be registered using the control panel.  
• The Scan to USB function does not require destinations registered in the Address Book.  
Modifying Scan Destinations  
This section describes how to modify the information of registered destinations.  
1. Start the Web browser, and access the machine by entering its IP address.  
2. Click [Scan Destination].  
3. Click the [E-mail Address], [FTP], or [Folder] tab.  
4. Select the entry to modify, and then click [Change].  
5. Modify settings as necessary.  
182  
   
Registering Scan Destinations  
6. Enter the administrator password if required.  
7. Click [Apply].  
8. Close the Web browser.  
• You can unassign a Quick Dial entry from a One-touch button from the [Quick Dial Destination]  
page. To do this, select the desired entry, click [Delete], and then click [Apply] again on a  
confirmation page.  
• The machine will notify you if the destination you want to modify is set as a forwarding destination  
of received faxes.  
5
Deleting Scan Destinations  
This section describes how to delete registered destinations.  
1. Start the Web browser, and access the machine by entering its IP address.  
2. Click [Scan Destination].  
3. Click the [E-mail Address], [FTP], or [Folder] tab.  
4. Select the entry to delete, and then click [Delete].  
5. Confirm that the entry you have selected is the entry that you want to delete.  
6. Enter the administrator password if required.  
7. Click [Apply].  
8. Close the Web browser.  
• The machine will notify you if the destination you want to delete is set as a forwarding destination of  
received faxes. If you delete the destination anyway, reconfigure the fax forwarding setting.  
183  
   
5. Using the Scanner Function  
Scanning Using the Control Panel  
Scanning using the control panel allows you to send scanned files via e-mail (Scan to E-mail), to an FTP  
server (Scan to FTP), or to the shared folder of a computer on a network (Scan to Folder), or to a USB  
flash disk (Scan to USB).  
The Scan to E-mail, Scan to FTP, and Scan to Folder functions are available only through a network  
connection. No network connection is required for the Scan to USB function; you can send scanned files  
directly to a USB flash disk inserted into the front of the machine.  
Basic Operation for Scan to E-mail/FTP/Folder  
This section describes the basic operation for sending scanned files via E-mail, to an FTP server, or to a  
computer. The scanned file is sent via E-mail, to an FTP server, or a computer, depending on the  
specified destination.  
5
• The original in the ADF takes precedence over the original on the exposure glass if you place  
originals both in the ADF and on the exposure glass.  
• When using the Scan to E-mail, Scan to FTP or Scan to Folder function, you must first register the  
destination in the Address Book using Web Image Monitor.  
• If a USB flash disk is inserted in the machine, scanning functions other than Scan to USB are not  
possible from the control panel. Make sure there is no USB flash disk inserted in the machine.  
1. Press the [Scanner] key.  
CES175  
Confirm that "Specify Dest." is shown on the screen.  
2. Place the original on the exposure glass or in the ADF.  
If necessary, configure advanced scan settings.  
184  
       
Scanning Using the Control Panel  
3. Press the [Address Book] key.  
CES180  
4. Search for the desired destination by pressing the [ ][ ] keys to scroll the Address Book,  
and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [B&W Start] key or the [Color Start] key.  
5
CES169  
To scan in black and white, press the [B&W Start] key.  
To scan in color, press the [Color Start] key.  
Depending on the machine's settings, you may see the following screen on the display when  
scanning from the exposure glass.  
If you see this screen, proceed to the next step.  
6. If you have more originals to scan, place the next original on the exposure glass, and  
then press [Yes]. Repeat this step until all originals are scanned.  
7. When all originals have been scanned, press [No] to start sending the scanned file.  
185  
5. Using the Scanner Function  
• To cancel scanning, press the [Scanner] key, and then press the [Clear/Stop] key. The scan files  
are discarded.  
• When you specify a scan destination, the machine's scan settings change automatically according  
to the information registered for that destination in the Address Book. If necessary, you can change  
the scan settings using the control panel.  
• You can also specify a destination using the One Touch buttons or [Pause/Redial] key.  
• If the [Limitless Scan] setting under scanner settings is enabled, you can place originals on the  
exposure glass repeatedly in a single scan procedure.  
• If [File Type] under scanner settings is set to [Multi-page], you can scan multiple pages to create a  
single PDF or TIFF file containing all pages. However, if the file format is JPEG, a single-page file  
will be created for every page scanned.  
• If paper is jammed in the ADF, the scan job will be put on hold. To resume the current job, remove  
the jammed paper and scan the originals again starting from the jammed page.  
5
Specifying the scan destination  
This section describes how to specify a destination using the following keys:  
• One Touch buttons  
Use these to specify destinations registered as Quick Dial entries.  
• [Pause/Redial] key  
Press this to specify the last used destination as the destination for the current job.  
Using the One Touch buttons  
Press the One Touch button to which the desired Quick Dial entry is registered.  
Press the [Shift] key to toggle the One Touch buttons between Quick Dial entries Nos.1 to 10 and  
Nos. 11 to 20.  
186  
   
Scanning Using the Control Panel  
CES183  
Using the [Pause/Redial] key  
Press the [Pause/Redial] key to select the last used destination.  
5
CES171  
• When you specify a scan destination, the machine's scan settings change automatically according  
to the information registered for that destination in the Address Book. If necessary, you can change  
the scan settings using the control panel.  
• The [Pause/Redial] key is not effective for the first scan job after the machine is turned on.  
• To select destinations not registered as Quick Dial entries, use the [Address Book] key.  
Basic Operation for Scan to USB  
This section describes the basic operation for sending scanned files to a USB flash disk.  
• The original in the ADF takes precedence over the original on the exposure glass if you place  
originals both in the ADF and on the exposure glass.  
187  
   
5. Using the Scanner Function  
• This machine does not support the use of USB flash disks connected to external USB hubs. Insert  
your USB flash disk directly into the USB flash disk port located at the top left corner of the  
machine.  
• Certain types of USB flash disks cannot be used.  
1. Insert your USB flash disk into the USB flash disk port.  
5
CES199  
2. Press the [Scanner] key.  
CES175  
"Loading..." appears on the display. Wait until the display changes to show "Save Scn Data to  
USB" (the duration depends on your USB flash disk).  
3. Place the original on the exposure glass or in the ADF.  
If necessary, configure advanced scan settings.  
188  
Scanning Using the Control Panel  
4. Press the [B&W Start] key or the [Color Start] key.  
CES169  
To scan in black and white, press the [B&W Start] key.  
To scan in color, press the [Color Start] key.  
Depending on the machine's setting, you will see the following screen on the display.  
• When in halftone black-and-white scanning mode:  
5
• When in color or gray scale black-and-white scanning mode:  
5. Press the appropriate selection key according to the desired file format.  
Depending on the machine's settings, you may see the following screen on the display when  
scanning from the exposure glass.  
If you see this screen, proceed to the next step. If not, proceed to step 8.  
6. If you have more originals to scan, place the next original on the exposure glass, and  
then press [Yes]. Repeat this step until all originals are scanned.  
7. When all originals have been scanned, press [No] to start sending the scanned file.  
189  
5. Using the Scanner Function  
8. Confirm that "Ready" appears on the display.  
The scanned file is created in the root directory of the USB flash disk.  
9. Remove the USB flash disk from the machine.  
Make sure to close the cover of the USB flash disk port after use.  
• To cancel scanning, press the [Scanner] key, and then press the [Clear/Stop] key. The scan files  
are discarded.  
• You can configure the machine to perform black-and-white scanning in halftone or grayscale by  
changing [B&W Scanning Mode] setting under scanner settings.  
• If the [Limitless Scan] setting under scanner settings is enabled, you can place originals on the  
exposure glass repeatedly in a single scan procedure.  
• If the [File Type] setting under scanner settings is enabled, you can scan multiple pages to create a  
single PDF or TIFF file containing all pages. However, if the file format is JPEG, a single-page file  
will be created for every page scanned.  
5
• If paper is jammed in the ADF, the scan job will be put on hold. To resume the current job, remove  
the jammed paper and scan the originals again starting from the jammed page.  
Specifying the Scan Settings  
This section describes how to specify the scanning size, image density, and resolution for the current job.  
When a scan destination is specified  
When you specify a scan destination, the machine's scan settings change automatically according  
to the information registered for that destination in the Address Book.  
This allows you to send scanned files without having to reconfigure the scan settings according to  
each destination. If necessary, you can change the scan settings using the control panel.  
• The machine maintains the preset scan settings for the current destination until the machine returns  
to standby mode.  
190  
   
Scanning Using the Control Panel  
• Changing the preset scan settings for the current destination does not change the information  
registered in the Address Book.  
• If you specify the last used destination, the preset scan settings become effective again, even if you  
have changed the settings for the previous job.  
Specifying the scanning size according to the size of the original  
This section describes how to specify the scanning size according to the size of the current original.  
1. Press the [Reduce/Enlarge] key or [Scn Size].  
5
CES177  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the size of the original, and then press the [OK] key.  
If you selected anything other than [Custom Size], you do not need to perform the remaining steps  
of the procedure.  
3. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [mm] or [inch], and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Enter the width using the number keys, and then press the [OK] key.  
To enter a decimal point, press [ ].  
5. Enter the length using the number keys, and then press the [OK] key.  
To enter a decimal point, press [ ].  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• You can change the machine's default [Scan Size] setting to always scan originals with a specific  
scanning size.  
• Temporary job settings are cleared in the following cases:  
• When no input is received for the period of time specified in [System Auto Reset Timer] while  
the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the [Clear/Stop] key is pressed while the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the machine's mode is changed.  
• When the power is turned off.  
191  
 
5. Using the Scanner Function  
• When the machine's default for the same setting is changed.  
Adjusting image density  
This section describes how to adjust image density for the current job.  
There are five image density levels. The higher the density level, the darker the scanned image.  
1. Press the [Density] key.  
5
CES178  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the desired density level, and then press the [OK] key.  
• Press the [Escape] key to discard the current change and return to the initial screen.  
• You can change the machine's default [Density] setting to always scan with a specific density level.  
• Temporary job settings are cleared in the following cases:  
• When no input is received for the period of time specified in [System Auto Reset Timer] while  
the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the [Clear/Stop] key is pressed while the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the machine's mode is changed.  
• When the power is turned off.  
• When the machine's default for the same setting is changed.  
192  
   
Scanning Using the Control Panel  
Specifying resolution  
This section describes how to specify the scan resolution for the current job.  
There are six resolution settings. The higher the resolution, the higher the quality but greater the file size.  
1. Press the [Image Quality] key.  
CES179  
5
2. Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] keys to select the desired resolution, and then press the [OK] key.  
• Press the [Escape] key to discard the current change and return to the initial screen.  
• You can change the machine's default [Resolution] setting to always scan with a specific resolution  
level.  
• Temporary job settings are cleared in the following cases:  
• When no input is received for the period of time specified in [System Auto Reset Timer] while  
the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the [Clear/Stop] key is pressed while the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the machine's mode is changed.  
• When the power is turned off.  
• When the machine's default for the same setting is changed.  
193  
 
5. Using the Scanner Function  
Scanning from a Computer  
Scanning from a computer (TWAIN scanning) allows you to operate the machine from your computer  
and scan originals into your computer directly.  
TWAIN scanning is available with both USB and network connections.  
Basic Operation for TWAIN Scanning  
This section describes the basic TWAIN scanning operation.  
TWAIN scanning is possible if your computer is running a TWAIN-compatible application. Presto!  
PageManager, which is provided on the driver CD-ROM, can be used for TWAIN scanning.  
Listed below are some of the useful features of Presto! PageManager. Note that the Presto!  
PageManager features are subject to change depending on its version.  
5
• Easily create electronic files by scanning originals using Scan Buttons.  
• Create, edit, share, and backup files in various formats, including PDF, XPS, and many more.  
• Display and sort files in thumbnail, list, and tile views.  
• Stack related image and document files in different file formats.  
• Extract text out of images using the OCR (Optical Character Recognition) function.  
• Search for files with specific annotations, title, author, and memo information.  
• Add annotations without affecting the original file with handy annotation tools, such as text, stamp,  
highlighter, freehand line, straight line, sticky note, and bookmark.  
• Enhance images with a set of image tools such as crop, rotate, mirror, flip, invert, auto-  
enhancement, brightness/contrast adjustment, color adjustment, and remove noise.  
• For more details about Presto! PageManager's features and its contact information, see the manual  
for Presto! PageManager.  
Scanning from a computer (Windows)  
The following procedure uses Windows XP and Presto! PageManager as an example.  
The procedure may vary depending on Presto! PageManager's version. For details, see the manual for  
Presto! PageManager.  
1. Place the original on the exposure glass or in the ADF.  
2. On the [Start] menu, point to [All Programs], point to [Presto! PageManager X.XX], and  
then click [Presto! PageManager X.XX].  
"X.XX" indicates the version of Presto! PageManager.  
194  
         
Scanning from a Computer  
3. On the [File] menu, click [Select Source...].  
4. In the [Select Source] dialog box, select the scanner, and then click [OK].  
5. On the [Tools] menu, click [Scan Central Settings...].  
6. Configure the scan settings as required, and then click [OK].  
For details, see the TWAIN driver Help or the manual for Presto! PageManager.  
7. On the [File] menu, click [Acquire Image Data...].  
8. For [Original], select [Reflective] (when using the exposure glass) or [Automatic  
Document Feeder] (when using the ADF).  
9. Click [Scan].  
10. On the [File] menu, click [Exit].  
• If there are two or more scanners on the network, make sure you have selected the correct scanner.  
If you have not, click [Select Source...] on the [File] menu, and select the scanner again.  
5
• You can use the launcher installed with Presto! PageManager to perform the following scan  
operations easily. For more details, see the manual for Presto! PageManager.  
• Scanning originals into another application.  
• Passing the scanned files to an OCR application.  
• Passing the scanned files to an email application to send as attachments.  
• Saving the scanned files in a preset folder.  
• The machine supports WIA scanning, an additional method of scanning originals from your  
computer, for USB connection. WIA scanning is possible if your computer is running a WIA-  
compatible application. For more information, see the manual for your application.  
• If paper is jammed in the ADF, the scan job will be put on hold. To resume the current job, remove  
the jammed paper and scan the originals again starting from the jammed page.  
Scanning from a computer (Mac OS X)  
The following procedure uses Mac OS X and Presto! PageManager as an example.  
The procedure may vary depending on Presto! PageManager's version. For details, see the manual for  
Presto! PageManager.  
1. Place the original on the exposure glass or in the ADF.  
2. On the [Go] menu, click [Applications].  
195  
 
5. Using the Scanner Function  
3. Click [Presto! PageManager X.XX], and then double-click [Presto! PageManager X].  
"X" indicates the version of Presto! PageManager.  
4. On the [File] menu, click [Select Source...].  
5. In the [Select Source] dialog box, select the scanner, and then click [OK].  
6. On the [File] menu, select [Scan Settings...].  
For details, see the TWAIN driver Help or the manual for Presto! PageManager.  
7. Configure the scan settings as required, and then click [OK].  
For details, see the TWAIN driver Help or the manual for Presto! PageManager.  
8. On the [File] menu, click [Acquire Image Data...].  
9. Configure the scan settings as required, and then click [Scan].  
10. On the [Presto! PageManager X] menu, click [Quit Presto! PageManager X].  
5
• If there are two or more scanners on the network, make sure you have selected the correct scanner.  
If you have not, click [Select Source...] on the [File] menu, and select the scanner again.  
• You can use the launcher installed with Presto! PageManager to perform the following scan  
operations easily. For more details, see the manual for Presto! PageManager.  
• Scanning originals into another application.  
• Passing the scanned files to an OCR application.  
• Passing the scanned files to an email application to send as attachments.  
• Saving the scanned files in a preset folder.  
• If paper is jammed in the ADF, the scan job will be put on hold. To resume the current job, remove  
the jammed paper and scan the originals again starting from the jammed page.  
Settings you can configure in the TWAIN dialog box  
This section describes the settings you can configure in the TWAIN dialog box.  
196  
 
Scanning from a Computer  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
5
CES194  
1. Scanner:  
Select the scanner you want to use. The scanner you select becomes the default scanner. Click [Refresh] to  
discover all available scanners connected via USB or the network.  
2. Original:  
Select [Reflective] to scan from the exposure glass, or [Automatic Document Feeder] to scan from the ADF.  
3. Original type  
According to your original, select a setting from the list of options detailed below, or select [Custom...] to  
configure your own scan settings.  
• When using the exposure glass:  
[Editing Text (OCR)]  
Select this to scan business letters, contracts, memos, or other documents in editable form.  
[Faxing, Filing or Copying]  
Select this to scan newspaper and magazine articles, receipts, forms, or other printed text material.  
[Black and White Photo]  
Select this to scan black and white photographs as grayscale images.  
[Color Document - fast]  
Select this to scan originals with many graphics, originals with both text and graphics, line art, or color  
photographs in fast scan mode.  
[Color Document - Better Quality]  
Select this to scan originals with many graphics, originals with both text and graphics, line art, or color  
photographs in high-resolution scan mode.  
[Custom...]  
197  
5. Using the Scanner Function  
Select this to configure your own scan settings. You can save or delete your custom scan settings by  
clicking [Save As] or [Delete], respectively.  
• When using the ADF:  
[ADF-Faster]  
Select this to scan originals with many graphics, originals with both text and graphics, line art, or color  
photographs in fast scan mode.  
[ADF-Better]  
Select this to scan originals with many graphics, originals with both text and graphics, line art, or color  
photographs in high-resolution scan mode.  
[ADF-gray]  
Select this to scan originals with many graphics, originals with both text and graphics, line art, or color  
photographs as grayscale images.  
[Custom...]  
Select this to configure your own scan settings. You can save or delete your custom scan settings by  
clicking [Save As] or [Delete], respectively.  
5
4. Mode:  
Select from color, grayscale, or black-and-white.  
5. Resolution:  
Select a resolution from the list. If you select [User defined], enter a resolution value directly in the edit box.  
Note that increasing the resolution also increases the file size and scanning time.  
Selectable resolutions vary depending on where the original is set.  
• When using the exposure glass:  
75, 100, 150, 200, 300, 400, 500, 600, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200 dpi, User defined  
• When using the ADF:  
75, 100, 150, 200, 300, 400, 500, 600 dpi, User defined  
6. Size:  
Select the scanning size. If you select [User defined], enter the scanning size directly in the edit box. Also, you  
can change the scanning size with your mouse in the preview area. You can select the unit of measure from  
[cm], [inches], or [pixels].  
7. Scan task:  
Displays a maximum of 10 previously used scan areas. To remove a scan task, select the number of the task,  
and then click [Remove]. When scanning from the exposure glass, you can select [AutoCrop] to let the  
scanner automatically detect the size of your original.  
• If the scan data is larger than the memory capacity, an error message appears and scanning is  
canceled. If this happens, specify a lower resolution and scan the original again.  
198  
6. Using the Fax Function  
This chapter describes the fax functions.  
The Screen in Fax Mode  
This section provides information about the screen in fax mode.  
By default, the display shows the copier screen when the machine is turned on.  
If the copy or scanner screen is shown on the display, press the [Facsimile] key on the control panel to  
switch to the fax screen.  
6
CES176  
Screen in standby mode  
1
4
2
3
CES252  
1. Current status or messages  
Displays the current status or messages.  
2. Current settings  
Displays the current density and resolution settings.  
3. Selection key items  
Displays the functions you can use by pressing the corresponding selection keys.  
4. Current date and time  
Shows the current date and time.  
• The machine's default mode at power on can be specified in the [Function Priority] setting under  
[Admin. Tools].  
199  
     
6. Using the Fax Function  
• The display format for time and date can be specified in [Set Date/Time] under [Admin. Tools].  
6
200  
Setting the Date and Time  
Setting the Date and Time  
This section describes how to set the time and date for the machine's internal clock, and how to select the  
display format.  
• Date  
Year, month, date, and date format (Month/Day/Year, Day/Month/Year, or Year/Month/Day)  
• Time  
Hour, minute, time format (12- or 24-hour), and AM/PM stamp (when 12-hour time format is  
selected)  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
6
CES184  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Admin. Tools], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. If you are requested to enter a password, enter the password using the number keys,  
and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Set Date/Time], and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Set Date], and then press the [OK] key.  
6. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the desired date format, and then press the [OK] key.  
7. Enter the current date using the number keys, and then press the [OK] key.  
You can press the [ ][ ] keys to move between fields.  
8. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Set Time], and then press the [OK] key.  
9. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the desired time format, and then press the [OK] key.  
10. Enter the current time using the number keys, and then press the [OK] key.  
If you selected [12-hour Format], press the [ ][ ] keys to select [AM] or [PM].  
You can press the [ ][ ] keys to move between fields.  
11. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
201  
   
6. Using the Fax Function  
• A password for accessing the [Admin. Tools] menu can be specified in [Admin. Tools Lock].  
• If an incorrect time or date is input, the machine automatically corrects it to the nearest valid time or  
date.  
6
202  
Registering Fax Destinations  
Registering Fax Destinations  
This section describes how to register fax destinations in the Address Book using the control panel or  
Web Image Monitor. The Address Book allows you to specify fax destinations quickly and easily.  
• The Address Book data could be damaged or lost unexpectedly. The manufacturer shall not be  
responsible for any damages resulting from such data loss. Be sure to create backup files of the  
Address Book data periodically.  
The Address Book can contain up to 220 entries (20 Quick Dial entries and 200 Speed Dial entries).  
Quick Dial entries  
Destinations registered as Quick Dial entries can be selected by pressing the corresponding One  
Touch button.  
Speed Dial entries  
Destinations registered as Speed Dial entries can be selected by pressing the [Address Book] key,  
and then selecting the desired entry using the [ ][ ] keys.  
6
Registering Fax Destinations Using the Control Panel  
This section describes how to register destinations using the control panel.  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
CES184  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Address Book], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. If you are requested to enter a password, enter the password using the number keys,  
and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Quick Dial Dest.] or [Fax Speed Dial Dest.], and then press  
the [OK] key.  
203  
       
6. Using the Fax Function  
5. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [No.], and then enter the desired Quick Dial number (1 to  
20) or Speed Dial number (1 to 200) using the number keys.  
If a destination is already registered for the input number, the fax number and fax name registered  
for that number appear.  
6. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Fax No.], and then enter the fax number (up to 40  
characters).  
7. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Name], and then enter the fax name (up to 20 characters).  
8. Confirm the setting, and then press the [OK] key.  
9. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• A fax number can contain 0 to 9, pause, " ", " ", and space.  
• If necessary, insert a pause in the fax number. The machine pauses briefly before it dials the digits  
following the pause. You can specify the length of the pause time in the [Pause Time] setting under  
fax transmission settings.  
6
• To use tone services on a pulse-dialing line, insert " " in the fax number. " " switches the dialing  
mode from pulse to tone temporarily.  
• If the machine is connected to the telephone network through a PBX, make sure to enter the outside  
line access number specified in [PBX Access Number] before the fax number.  
• Use Web Image Monitor to register an Internet Fax destination (an e-mail address).  
• A password for accessing the [Address Book] menu can be specified in [Admin. Tools Lock].  
Modifying fax destinations  
This section describes how to modify the information of registered destinations.  
204  
 
Registering Fax Destinations  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
CES184  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Address Book], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. If you are requested to enter a password, enter the password using the number keys,  
and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Quick Dial Dest.] or [Fax Speed Dial Dest.], and then press  
the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [No.], and then enter the desired Quick Dial number (1 to  
20) or Speed Dial number (1 to 200) using the number keys.  
6
The fax number and fax name registered for that number appear.  
6. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Fax No.], and then modify the fax number (up to 40  
characters).  
7. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Name], and then modify the fax name (up to 20  
characters).  
8. Confirm the setting, and then press the [OK] key.  
9. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• A password for accessing the [Address Book] menu can be specified in [Admin. Tools Lock].  
Deleting fax destinations  
This section describes how to delete registered destination.  
205  
 
6. Using the Fax Function  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
CES184  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Address Book], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. If you are requested to enter a password, enter the password using the number keys,  
and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Quick Dial Dest.] or [Fax Speed Dial Dest.], and then press  
the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [No.], and then enter the desired Quick Dial number (1 to  
20) or Speed Dial number (1 to 200) using the number keys.  
6
The fax number and fax name registered for that number appear.  
6. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Fax No.], and then press the [ ] key repeatedly until the  
current number is deleted.  
7. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Name], and then press the [ ] key repeatedly until the  
current name is deleted.  
8. Confirm the setting, and then press the [OK] key.  
9. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• A password for accessing the [Address Book] menu can be specified in [Admin. Tools Lock].  
Registering Fax Destinations Using Web Image Monitor  
This section describes how to register destinations using Web Image Monitor.  
1. Start the Web browser and access the machine by entering its IP address.  
2. Click [Quick Dial Destination] or [Fax Speed Dial Destination].  
206  
   
Registering Fax Destinations  
3. From the [Destination Type] list, select [Fax].  
4. Select [Quick Dial Number] or [Speed Dial Number], and then select the registration  
number from the list.  
5. Register information as necessary.  
6. Enter the administrator password if required.  
7. Click [Apply].  
8. Close the Web browser.  
Fax destination settings  
6
Item  
Setting  
Required  
Description  
Quick Dial Number /  
Speed Dial Number  
Select the number to which you want to register Quick  
Dial or Speed Dial destination.  
Name of the destination. The name specified here will  
be shown on the screen when selecting a fax  
destination. Can contain up to 20 characters.  
Name  
Optional  
Optional  
Fax number of the destination. Can contain up to 40  
characters.  
If the machine is connected to the telephone network  
through a PBX, make sure to enter the outside line  
access number specified in [PBX Access Number]  
before the fax number.  
Fax Number  
E-mail address of the destination of the Internet Fax.  
Can contain up to 64 characters.  
Forwarding  
Destination E-mail  
Address  
Optional  
This setting appears only for the Type 2 model.  
• A fax number can contain 0 to 9, "P" (pause), " ", " ", "-", and space.  
207  
6. Using the Fax Function  
• If necessary, insert a pause in the fax number. The machine pauses briefly before it dials the digits  
following the pause. You can specify the length of the pause time in the [Pause Time] setting under  
fax transmission settings.  
• To use tone services on a pulse-dialing line, insert " " in the fax number. " " switches the dialing  
mode from pulse to tone temporarily.  
Modifying fax destinations  
This section describes how to modify the information of registered destinations.  
1. Start the Web browser and access the machine by entering its IP address.  
2. Click [Quick Dial Destination] or [Fax Speed Dial Destination].  
If you modify the Speed Dial entry, proceed to step 4.  
3. Click [Fax Quick Dial Destination].  
6
4. Select the entry to modify, and then click [Change].  
5. Modify settings as necessary.  
6. Enter the administrator password if required.  
7. Click [Apply].  
8. Close the Web browser.  
Deleting fax destinations  
This section describes how to delete registered destination.  
1. Start the Web browser and access the machine by entering its IP address.  
2. Click [Quick Dial Destination] or [Fax Speed Dial Destination].  
If you delete the Speed Dial entry, proceed to step 4.  
3. Click [Fax Quick Dial Destination].  
4. Select the entry to delete, and then click [Delete].  
5. Confirm that the entry you have selected is the entry that you want to delete.  
6. Enter the administrator password if required.  
7. Click [Apply].  
8. Close the Web browser.  
208  
 
Sending a Fax  
Sending a Fax  
This section describes the transmission modes and the basic operations for sending a fax.  
• It is recommended that you call the receiver and confirm with them when sending important  
documents.  
Selecting Transmission Mode  
This section describes how to select the transmission mode.  
There are two transmission modes: Memory Transmission and Immediate Transmission.  
Memory Transmission  
In this mode, the machine scans several originals into memory and sends them all at once. This is  
convenient when you are in a hurry and want to take the document away from the machine. In this  
mode, you can send a fax to multiple destinations.  
6
Immediate Transmission  
In this mode, the machine scans the original and faxes it simultaneously, without storing it in  
memory. This is convenient when you want to send an original quickly. In this mode, you can only  
specify one destination.  
1. Press the [Facsimile] key.  
CES176  
209  
       
6. Using the Fax Function  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys.  
CES168  
3. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Immediate TX], and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Off], [On], or [Next Fax Only], and then press the [OK]  
key.  
For Memory Transmission, select [Off].  
For Immediate Transmission, select [On] or [Next Fax Only].  
5. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
6
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
Internet Fax Transmission Overview  
You can send faxes over the Internet. When you send faxes to Internet Fax destinations, the machine  
converts scanned images to TIFF-F format files and send them as attachments to e-mail.  
• The level of security for Internet communications is low. It is recommended that you use the  
telephone network for confidential communications.  
• Internet Fax delivery might be delayed due to network congestion. Use a public telephone line if  
the fax needs to be delivered in a timely manner.  
• The Internet Fax function supported by this machine is compliant with ITU-T Recommendation T.37  
(Simple Mode).  
• To use the Internet Fax function, network settings must be configured properly.  
• Internet Fax transmission may take some time before it starts. The machine needs a certain amount  
of time to convert data in memory prior to transmission.  
• Depending on e-mail environment conditions, you may not be able to fax large images.  
210  
   
Sending a Fax  
• The "Photo" resolution is not available for Internet Faxes. Faxes will be sent using "Detail" resolution  
if "Photo" resolution has been specified.  
• If the faxes are received on a computer, a viewer application needs to be installed in order to view  
the documents.  
Basic Operation for Sending a Fax  
This section describes the basic operation for sending a fax.  
• The original in the ADF takes precedence over the original on the exposure glass if you place  
originals both in the ADF and on the exposure glass.  
1. Press the [Facsimile] key.  
6
CES176  
2. Place the original on the exposure glass or in the ADF.  
If necessary, configure the advanced scan settings.  
3. Enter the fax number (up to 40 characters) using the number keys, or specify a  
destination using the One Touch buttons or Speed Dial function.  
• If the machine is connected to the telephone network through a PBX, make sure to enter the  
outside line access number specified in [PBX Access Number] before the fax number.  
• To specify an Internet Fax destination, use the One Touch buttons or Speed Dial function.  
211  
   
6. Using the Fax Function  
4. Press the [B&W Start] key.  
CES172  
• Depending on the machine's settings, you may be prompted to enter the fax number again if  
you manually entered the destination fax number. Enter the fax number within 30 seconds. If  
the fax numbers do not match, go back to step 3.  
• When using the exposure glass in Memory Transmission mode, you will be prompted to place  
another original. In this case, proceed to the next step.  
5. If you have more originals to scan, press [Yes] within 60 seconds, place the next original  
on the exposure glass, and then press [OK]. Repeat this step until all originals are  
scanned.  
6
If you do not press [Yes] within 60 seconds, the machine will start to dial the destination.  
6. When all originals have been scanned, press [No] to start sending the fax.  
• A fax number can contain 0 to 9, pause, " ", " ", and space.  
• If necessary, insert a pause in a fax number. The machine pauses briefly before it dials the digits  
following the pause. You can specify the length of the pause time in the [Pause Time] setting under  
fax transmission settings.  
• To use tone services on a pulse-dialing line, insert " " in a fax number. " " switches the dialing  
mode from pulse to tone temporarily.  
• You can also specify a destination using the [Pause/Redial] key.  
• You can specify multiple destinations and broadcast the fax you are sending.  
• The machine prompts you to enter the fax number twice only when you dial the destination  
manually. Destinations specified using the One Touch buttons, Speed Dial function, or [Pause/  
Redial] key need not be confirmed.  
• When in Memory Transmission mode, you can enable the [Auto Redial] setting under fax  
transmission settings to set the machine to automatically redial the destination if the line is busy or  
an error occurs during transmission.  
212  
Sending a Fax  
• When in Memory Transmission mode, the machine's memory may become full while scanning the  
originals. In this case, the screen prompts you to cancel the transmission or to send only the pages  
that have been scanned successfully.  
• If you specify an Internet Fax destination in Immediate Transmission mode, the mode switches to  
Memory Transmission mode temporarily.  
• If paper is jammed in the ADF, the jammed page has not been scanned properly. When the  
machine is in Immediate Transmission mode, resend the fax starting from the jammed page. When  
in Memory Transmission mode, scan the entire originals again.  
• For details about using the One Touch buttons, Speed Dial function, or [Pause/Redial] key, or  
6
Canceling a fax  
Follow the procedure below to cancel sending a fax.  
When in Immediate Transmission mode  
If you cancel sending a fax while the machine is scanning the original, the fax transmission process  
is canceled immediately. In this case, an error is displayed on the other party's machine.  
When in Memory Transmission mode  
If you cancel sending a fax while the machine is scanning the original, the machine will not send  
the document.  
If you cancel sending a fax during transmission, the fax transmission process is canceled  
immediately. In this case, an error is displayed on the other party's machine.  
213  
 
6. Using the Fax Function  
1. Press the [Facsimile] key.  
CES176  
2. Press the [Clear/Stop] key.  
6
CES173  
• If you cancel sending a fax while broadcasting, only the fax to the current destination is canceled.  
The fax will be sent to the subsequent destinations as normal.  
Specifying the Fax Destination  
This section describes how to specify the destination when sending a fax.  
Other than entering the destination fax number using the number keys, you can specify destinations  
using the following functions:  
• Using the One Touch buttons  
• Using Speed Dial  
• Using the Broadcast function  
• Using the Redial function  
214  
   
Sending a Fax  
Specifying the destination using the One Touch buttons  
This section describes how to select a destination registered as a Quick Dial entry using One Touch  
buttons.  
1. Press the [Facsimile] key.  
CES176  
2. Press the One Touch button to which the desired Quick Dial entry is registered.  
Press the [Shift] key if you want to use Quick Dial entries Nos. 11 to 20 before pressing a One  
Touch button.  
6
CES183  
• You can check the registered names and fax numbers by printing a report.  
Specifying the destination using Speed Dial  
This section describes how to select a destination registered as a Speed Dial entry.  
215  
   
6. Using the Fax Function  
1. Press the [Facsimile] key.  
CES176  
2. Press the [Address Book] key.  
6
CES180  
If you want to search for a specific entry by its registration number or name, use the following  
procedure:  
• Searching by the registration number  
Press the [Address Book] key again, and then enter the number using the number keys.  
• Searching by the name  
Enter the first letters of the name using the number keys. Each time you enter a character, the  
display changes to show the matching name.  
3. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the desired Speed Dial entry, and then press the [OK] key.  
• The Address Book shows only the Speed Dial entries. Use the One Touch buttons to specify Quick  
Dial destinations.  
• You can check the registered names and fax numbers by printing a report.  
216  
Sending a Fax  
Specifying the destination using the broadcast function  
You can send a fax to multiple destinations simultaneously. You can broadcast faxes to a maximum of  
100 destinations (including both normal fax destinations and Internet Fax destinations).  
Faxes are sent to destinations in the order they were specified.  
1. Press the [Facsimile] key.  
CES176  
2. Add a destination by using one of the following methods:  
• To add a Quick Dial destination: press a corresponding One Touch button.  
6
• To add a Speed Dial destination: press the [Address Book] key, select a destination, and then  
press the [OK] key.  
• To add a manually-specified destination: confirm that [No.key] is pressed, and then enter the  
destination fax number using the number keys.  
3. Press the [OK] key.  
Press [List] to see the list of destinations that have been added so far.  
Go back to step 2 to add further destinations.  
• While specifying multiple destinations, you can press the [Clear/Stop] key to clear all destinations.  
• If you specify multiple destinations in Immediate Transmission mode, the mode switches to Memory  
Transmission mode temporarily.  
• If the destinations contain both normal fax destinations and Internet Fax destinations, the fax will be  
sent to the Internet Fax destinations first.  
• While broadcasting, pressing the [Clear/Stop] key cancels the fax to the current destination only.  
Specifying the destination using the redial function  
You can specify the last used destination as the destination for the current job.  
This function saves time when you are sending to the same destination repeatedly, as you do not have to  
enter the destination each time.  
217  
     
6. Using the Fax Function  
1. Press the [Facsimile] key.  
CES176  
2. Press the [Pause/Redial] key.  
6
CES171  
Useful Sending Functions  
This section explains some useful fax functions.  
You can confirm the status of the other party's machine easily before sending a fax by using the On  
Hook Dial function. If you have an extra telephone, you can talk and send a fax in one call.  
• This function is available in Immediate Transmission mode only.  
• This function is not available with Internet Fax.  
Sending a fax using On Hook Dial  
The On Hook Dial function allows you to check the destination's status while listening to the tone from the  
internal speaker. This function is useful when you want to ensure that the fax will be received.  
1. Press the [Facsimile] key.  
2. Place the original.  
218  
   
Sending a Fax  
3. Press the [On Hook Dial] key.  
CES181  
"On Hook" appears on the screen.  
4. Specify the destination using the number keys.  
5. If you hear a high pitched tone, press the [B&W Start] key.  
6
CES172  
6. Press [TX], and then press the [B&W Start] key.  
Sending a fax after a conversation  
An external telephone allows you to send a fax after finishing your conversation, without having to  
disconnect and redial. This function is useful when you want to ensure that the fax will be received.  
1. Place the original.  
2. Pick up the handset of the external telephone.  
3. Specify the destination using the external telephone.  
4. When the other party answers, ask them to press their fax start button.  
219  
 
6. Using the Fax Function  
5. If you hear a high pitched tone, press the [B&W Start] key.  
CES172  
6. Press [TX], and then press the [B&W Start] key.  
7. Replace the handset.  
6
Specifying the Scan Settings  
This section describes how to specify image density and resolution for the current scan job.  
Adjusting image density  
This section describes how to adjust image density for the current job.  
There are three image density levels. The darker the density level, the darker the printout.  
1. Press the [Density] key.  
CES178  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the desired density level, and then press the [OK] key.  
220  
       
Sending a Fax  
• Press the [Escape] key to discard the current change and return to the initial screen.  
• You can change the machine's default [Density] setting to always scan with a specific density level.  
• Temporary job settings are cleared in the following cases:  
• When no input is received for the period of time specified in [System Auto Reset Timer] while  
the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the [Clear/Stop] key is pressed while the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the machine's mode is changed.  
• When the power is turned off.  
• When the machine's default for the same setting is changed.  
6
Specifying the resolution  
This section describes how to specify the scan resolution for the current job.  
There are three resolution settings:  
Standard  
Select this when the original is a printed or typewritten document with normal-sized characters.  
Detail  
Select this when the original is a document with small print.  
Photo  
Select this when the original contains images such as photographs or shaded drawings.  
1. Press the [Image Quality] key.  
CES179  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the desired resolution setting, and then press the [OK] key.  
221  
 
6. Using the Fax Function  
• Press the [Escape] key to discard the current change and return to the initial screen.  
• You can change the machine's default [Resolution] setting to always scan with a specific resolution  
level.  
• The "Photo" resolution is not available for Internet Faxes. Faxes will be sent using "Detail" resolution  
if "Photo" resolution has been specified.  
• Temporary job settings are cleared in the following cases:  
• When no input is received for the period of time specified in [System Auto Reset Timer] while  
the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the [Clear/Stop] key is pressed while the initial screen is displayed.  
• When the machine's mode is changed.  
• When the power is turned off.  
• When the machine's default for the same setting is changed.  
6
222  
Using the Fax Function from a Computer (LAN-Fax)  
Using the Fax Function from a Computer (LAN-  
Fax)  
This section describes how to use the fax function of the machine from a computer.  
You can send a document directly from a computer through this machine to another fax machine,  
without printing the document.  
• This function is supported by Windows XP/Vista/7, and Windows Server 2003/2003  
R2/2008/2008 R2. Mac OS X does not support this function.  
Configuring the LAN-Fax Address Book  
This section describes the LAN-Fax Address Book. Configure the LAN-Fax Address Book on the  
computer. The LAN-Fax Address Book allows you to specify LAN-Fax destinations quickly and easily.  
The LAN-Fax Address Book can contain up to 1000 entries, including individual destinations and  
groups of destinations.  
6
• You can configure separate LAN-Fax Address Books for each user account on your computer.  
• You can import and export the LAN-Fax Address Book as required.  
Opening the LAN-Fax Address Book  
This section describes how to open the LAN-Fax Address Book.  
• The following procedure is based on Windows XP as an example. If you are using another  
operating system, the procedure might vary slightly.  
1. On the [Start] menu, click [Printers and Faxes].  
2. Click the icon of the LAN-Fax driver.  
3. On the [File] menu, click [Printing Preferences...].  
223  
       
6. Using the Fax Function  
4. Click the [Address Book] tab.  
• From the [View:] list, you can select the type of destinations to display.  
• [All]: Displays all destinations.  
6
• [Group]: Displays groups only.  
• [User]: Displays individual destinations only.  
Registering destinations  
This section describes how to register destinations in the LAN-Fax Address Book.  
1. Open the LAN-Fax Address Book, and then click [Add User].  
2. Register the required information and click [OK].  
For details, see the table below.  
224  
 
Using the Fax Function from a Computer (LAN-Fax)  
Setting LAN-Fax destinations  
Item Setting  
Name Required  
Description  
Name of the destination. Can contain up to 32 characters.  
Company name of the destination. Can contain up to 64  
characters. You can select from registered data.  
Company  
Optional  
Optional  
Department name of the destination. Can contain up to 64  
characters. You can select from registered data.  
Department  
Telephone number of the destination. Can contain up to 40  
characters.  
Telephone  
Fax  
Optional  
Required  
Fax number of the destination. Can contain up to 40 characters.  
• A telephone number or fax number can contain 0 to 9, "P" (pause), " ", " ", "-" and space.  
• If necessary, insert a pause in a fax number. The machine pauses briefly before it dials the digits  
following the pause. You can specify the length of the pause time in the [Pause Time] setting under  
fax transmission settings.  
6
• To use tone services on a pulse-dialing line, insert " " in a fax number. " " switches the dialing  
mode from pulse to tone temporarily.  
• A message appears if the name you specified already exists in the LAN-Fax Address Book. To  
register the destination under a different name, click [No] and enter a different name. Clicking [Yes]  
allows you to register it under the same name.  
• You can partly modify an existing destination and register it as a new one with similar information.  
Modifying destinations  
This section describes how to modify registered destinations.  
225  
   
6. Using the Fax Function  
1. Open the LAN-Fax Address Book, select the destination you want to modify from the  
[User List:], and then click [Edit].  
2. Modify information as necessary, and then click [OK].  
Click [Save as new User] if you want to register a new destination with similar information. This is  
useful when you want to register a series of destinations that contain similar information. To close  
the dialog box without modifying the original destination, click [Cancel].  
6
• A message appears if the name you specified already exists in the LAN-Fax Address Book. To  
register the destination under a different name, click [No] and enter a different name. Clicking [Yes]  
allows you to register it under the same name.  
Registering groups  
This section describes how to register groups of destinations.  
A group can contain up to 100 individual destinations.  
1. Open the LAN-Fax Address Book, and then click [Add Group].  
2. Enter the group name in [Group Name].  
226  
 
Using the Fax Function from a Computer (LAN-Fax)  
3. Select the destination you want to include in the group from [User List:], and then click  
[Add].  
To delete a destination from a group, select the destination you want to delete from [List of Group  
Members:], and then click [Delete from List].  
4. Click [OK].  
• A group must contain at least one destination.  
• A group name must be specified for a group. No two groups can have the same group name.  
• A single destination can be included in more than one group.  
Modifying groups  
This section describes how to modify registered groups.  
1. Open the LAN-Fax Address Book, select the group you want to modify from the [User  
List:], and then click [Edit].  
6
2. To add a destination to the group, select the destination you want to add from [User List:]  
and click [Add].  
3. To delete a destination from the group, select the destination you want to delete from [List  
of Group Members:], and then click [Delete from List].  
4. Click [OK].  
• A message appears if the name you specified already exists in the LAN-Fax Address Book. Click  
[OK] and register it under a different name.  
Deleting individual destinations or groups  
This section describes how to delete individual destinations or groups from the LAN-Fax Address Book.  
227  
 
6. Using the Fax Function  
1. Open the LAN-Fax Address Book, select the destination you want to delete from [User  
List:], and then click [Delete].  
A confirmation message appears.  
2. Click [Yes].  
• A destination is automatically deleted from a group if that destination is deleted from the LAN-Fax  
Address Book. If you are deleting the last destination from a group, a message asking you to  
confirm the deletion appears. Click [OK] if you want to delete the group.  
• Deleting a group does not delete the destinations it contains from the LAN-Fax Address Book.  
Exporting/Importing LAN-Fax Address Book data  
This section describes how to export or import LAN-Fax Address Book data.  
• The following procedure is based on Windows XP as an example. If you are using another  
operating system, the procedure might vary slightly.  
6
Exporting LAN-Fax Address Book data  
LAN-Fax Address Book data can be exported to a file in CSV (Comma Separated Values) format.  
Follow this procedure to export LAN-Fax Address Book data.  
1. Open the LAN-Fax Address Book, and then click [Export].  
2. Navigate to the location to save the LAN-Fax Address Book data, specify a name for  
the file, and then click [Save].  
Importing LAN-Fax Address Book data  
LAN-Fax Address Book data can be imported from files in CSV format. You can import address  
book data from other applications if the data is saved as a CSV file.  
Follow this procedure to import LAN-Fax Address Book data. To import address book data from  
other applications, you must select the appropriate items to import.  
1. Open the LAN-Fax Address Book, and then click [Import].  
2. Select the file containing the address book data, and then click [Open].  
A dialog box for selecting the items to import appears.  
228  
 
Using the Fax Function from a Computer (LAN-Fax)  
3. For each field, select an appropriate item from the list.  
Select [*empty*] for fields for which there is no data to import. Note that [*empty*] cannot  
be selected for [Name] or [Fax].  
4. Click [OK].  
If a destination with the same name is found during the import process, select one of the  
following operations:  
6
• [Skip]: Skips the destination, and imports the remaining data.  
• [Save as new User]: Imports the current destination as a separate destination under the  
same name as an existing destination.  
• [Save All as new User]: Imports the current and subsequent destinations as separate  
destinations under the same names as existing destinations.  
• [Overwrite]: Imports the destination, overwriting the data in the LAN-Fax Address Book.  
• [Overwrite All]: Imports the current and subsequent destinations under the same names  
as existing destinations, overwriting the data in the LAN-Fax Address Book.  
• [Cancel]: Cancels the import operation.  
If a destination does not contain a name, or invalid characters are used in the telephone  
number or fax number, select one of the following operations:  
• [Skip]: Skips the destination, and imports the remaining data.  
• [Save]: Imports the destination as is.  
• [Save All]: Imports the current and subsequent destinations as is.  
• [Cancel]: Cancels the import operation.  
• CSV files are exported using Unicode encoding.  
• LAN-Fax Address Book data can be imported from CSV files whose character encoding is Unicode  
or ASCII.  
229  
6. Using the Fax Function  
• Group data cannot be exported or imported.  
• Up to 1000 destinations can be registered in the LAN-Fax Address Book. If this limit is exceeded  
during importing, the remaining destinations will not be imported.  
Basic Operation for Sending Faxes from a Computer  
This section describes the basic operation for sending faxes from a computer.  
You can select the destination from the LAN-Fax Address Book or enter the fax number directly. You can  
send faxes to up to 100 destinations at one time.  
• Before sending a fax, the machine stores all the fax data in memory. If the machine's memory  
becomes full while storing this data, the fax transmission will be canceled. If this happens, lower the  
resolution or reduce the number of pages and try again.  
• The following procedure is based on Windows XP as an example. If you are using another  
operating system, the procedure might vary slightly.  
6
1. Open the file you want to send.  
2. On the [File] menu, click [Print...].  
3. Select the LAN-Fax driver as the printer, and then click [OK].  
If necessary, configure the transmission settings in the LAN-Fax driver's properties before clicking  
[OK].  
4. To specify a destination from the LAN-Fax Address Book, select a destination from [User  
List:], and then click [Add to List].  
Repeat this step to add more destinations.  
5. To directly enter a fax number, click the [Specify Destination] tab, enter a fax number (up  
to 40 digits) in [Fax Number:], and then click [Add to List].  
Repeat this step to add more destinations.  
230  
   
Using the Fax Function from a Computer (LAN-Fax)  
6. If you want to attach a fax cover sheet, click [Edit Cover Sheet] on the [Specify  
Destination] tab, and then select the [Attach a Cover Sheet] check box.  
Edit the cover sheet as necessary, and then click [OK].  
7. Click [Send].  
• A fax number can contain 0 to 9, "P" (pause), " ", " ", "-", and space.  
• If necessary, insert a pause in a fax number. The machine pauses briefly before it dials the digits  
following the pause. You can specify the length of the pause time in the [Pause Time] setting under  
fax transmission settings.  
• To use tone services on a pulse-dialing line, insert " " in a fax number. " " switches the dialing  
mode from pulse to tone temporarily.  
• To delete an entered destination, select the destination in the [Destination List:], and then click  
[Delete from List].  
• You can register the fax number you entered in the [Specify Destination] tab in the LAN-Fax  
Address Book. Click [Save to Address Book] to open the dialog box for registering a destination.  
• From the [View:] list, you can select the types of destinations to display.  
• [All]: Displays all destinations.  
6
• [Group]: Displays groups only.  
• [User]: Displays individual destinations only.  
• If sending faxes via LAN-Fax is restricted, you must enter a user code in the LAN-Fax driver's  
property before sending a fax.  
Canceling a fax  
You can cancel sending a fax using either the machine's control panel or your computer, depending on  
the status of the job.  
Canceling while the machine is receiving a fax from the computer  
Cancel the fax from the computer.  
If the machine is shared by multiple computers, be careful not to cancel the fax of another user.  
1. Double-click the printer icon on the task bar of your computer.  
231  
 
6. Using the Fax Function  
2. Select the print job you want to cancel, click the [Document] menu, and then click  
[Cancel].  
Canceling while sending a fax  
Cancel the fax using the control panel.  
1. Press the [Facsimile] key.  
CES176  
2. Press the [Clear/Stop] key.  
6
CES173  
Editing a Fax Cover Sheet  
This section describes how to edit a fax cover sheet in the LAN-Fax driver's properties.  
1. On the [File] menu, click [Print...].  
2. Select the LAN-Fax driver as the printer, and then click [OK]  
3. Click the [Specify Destination] tab, and then click [Edit Cover Sheet].  
4. Configure settings as necessary, and then click [OK].  
232  
   
Using the Fax Function from a Computer (LAN-Fax)  
Settings you can configure for the fax cover sheets  
This section describes the settings you can configure for the fax cover sheets.  
1
2
8
7
6
3
4
6
5
CES253  
1. Attach a Cover Sheet  
Check this to send a fax with a cover sheet.  
2. From  
Enter the sender information. Items left blank will not appear on the cover sheet.  
• Company:  
Enter your company name. Can contain up to 64 characters.  
• Department:  
Enter your department name. Can contain up to 64 characters.  
• Name:  
Enter your name. Can contain up to 64 characters.  
• Phone:  
Enter your telephone number. Can contain up to 64 characters.  
• FAX:  
Enter your fax number. Can contain up to 64 characters.  
3. Import Bitmap  
Specify a bitmap image you want to show on the cover sheet. The image will be shown in the position as  
follows: Left=180, Right=800, Top=50, Bottom=180 (pixel). If the image is larger than this area, excess part is  
trimmed.  
233  
   
6. Using the Fax Function  
4. User Template  
Select the template for the cover sheet. There are three templates.  
5. Buttons  
• Preview...  
Click to preview the cover sheet before sending the fax.  
• Clear All  
Click to clear all information you entered.  
• OK  
Click to finish editing the fax cover sheet.  
• Cancel  
Click to discard the fax cover sheet.  
6. Comment  
Enter a comment for the fax. Can contain up to 256 characters.  
7. Subject  
Enter the subject of the fax. Can contain up to 64 characters.  
8. To  
Enter the destination information. Items left blank will not appear on the cover sheet.  
6
• Company:  
Enter the destination company name. Can contain up to 64 characters.  
• Department:  
Enter the destination department name. Can contain up to 64 characters.  
• Name:  
Enter the destination name. Can contain up to 64 characters.  
Configuring Transmission Settings  
This section describes how to configure transmission settings in the LAN-Fax driver's properties.  
Properties are set separately for each application.  
1. On the [File] menu, click [Print...].  
2. Select the LAN-Fax driver as the printer, and then click a button such as [Advanced  
Options] or [Properties] to open the driver's properties.  
LAN-Fax driver properties dialog box appears.  
3. Click the [Setup] tab.  
4. Configure settings as necessary, and then click [OK].  
234  
   
Using the Fax Function from a Computer (LAN-Fax)  
Settings you can configure in the LAN-Fax driver's properties  
This section describes the settings you can configure in the LAN-Fax driver's properties.  
1
2
3
6
4
5
6
CES193  
1. Paper Size  
Specifies the paper size.  
• Document Size  
Specifies the paper size of the document you are sending. If a paper size is specified in the application,  
that paper size will be used. Otherwise, the paper size specified here will be used.  
• Sending Size:  
Displays the actual paper size of the fax that is sent. The actual size of the fax will be A4, if the size of  
the document being faxed is A3, B4, or smaller than A4. A3/B4 documents will be reduced to sending  
size automatically.  
2. Orientation  
Specifies the page orientation.  
3. Resolution  
Specifies the resolution.  
• Standard  
Select this for a document with normal-sized characters.  
235  
   
6. Using the Fax Function  
• Fine  
Select this for a document with small print.  
• Photo  
Select this for a document with images such as photographs or shaded drawings.  
4. User Code  
If sending faxes via LAN-Fax is restricted, select this check box and enter a user code before sending a fax.  
5. About...  
Displays the version of the LAN-Fax driver.  
6. Restore Defaults  
Restores the settings to their factory defaults.  
• The settings configured here are applicable for the current application only.  
6
236  
Receiving a Fax  
Receiving a Fax  
This section describes fax reception functions.  
• When receiving an important fax, we recommend you confirm the contents of the received fax with  
the sender.  
• The machine may not be able to receive faxes when the amount of free memory space is low.  
• An external telephone is required to use this machine as a telephone.  
• Only A4, Letter, or Legal size paper can be used for printing faxes.  
6
Selecting Reception Mode  
This section describes how to select the reception mode.  
The reception modes are as follows:  
When using the machine only as a fax machine  
Select the following mode when no external telephone or telephone answering device is  
connected:  
• Fax Only mode (auto reception)  
In this mode, the machine is used only as a fax machine and receives faxes automatically.  
When using the machine with an external device  
Select one of the following modes when an external telephone or telephone answering device is  
connected:  
• FAX/TEL Manual mode (manual reception)  
In this mode, you must answer calls with an external telephone. If a call is a fax call, you have  
to start the fax reception manually.  
• Fax Only mode (auto reception)  
In this mode, the machine automatically answers all incoming calls in fax reception mode.  
• FAX/TEL Automatic mode (auto reception)  
In this mode, you can answer phone calls with an external telephone and receive faxes  
automatically.  
• FAX/TAD mode (auto reception)  
237  
       
6. Using the Fax Function  
In this mode, you can use the machine with an external telephone answering device.  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
CES184  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Fax Features], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Reception Settings], and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Switch Reception Mode], and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the desired reception mode, and then press the [OK] key.  
6. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
6
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• In FAX/TAD mode, the machine automatically starts to receive faxes after the external telephone  
answering device rings the number of times specified in [Overall Ringings w/ TAD] under [Fax  
Features]. Make sure to set the external telephone answering device to answer calls before the  
machine starts to receive faxes.  
Receiving a fax in FAX/TEL Manual mode  
This section describes the basic operation for receiving a fax when the reception mode is set to FAX/TEL  
Manual mode.  
1. Pick up the handset of the external telephone to answer the call.  
A normal telephone call starts.  
2. When you hear a fax calling tone or no sound, press the [Facsimile] key, and then press  
the [B&W Start] key.  
3. Press [RX].  
238  
   
Receiving a Fax  
4. Press the [B&W Start] key.  
5. Replace the handset.  
Receiving a fax in Fax Only mode  
When the reception mode is set to Fax Only mode, the machine automatically answers all incoming  
calls in fax reception mode.  
• You can specify the number of times the machine rings before answering a call in the [Number of  
Rings] setting under [Fax Features].  
• If you answer a call with the external telephone while the machine is ringing, a normal telephone  
call starts. If you hear a fax calling tone or no sound, receive the fax manually.  
6
Receiving a fax in FAX/TEL Automatic mode  
When the reception mode is set to FAX/TEL Automatic mode, the machine receives a fax automatically  
if the incoming call is a fax call and rings when it receives voice calls.  
1. When there is an incoming call, the machine tries to detect a fax calling tone for five seconds.  
If a fax calling tone is detected, the machine starts to receive the fax automatically.  
2. If a fax calling tone is not detected, the machine starts to ring, and continues to try to detect a fax  
calling tone for the period of time specified in [RX Mode Auto Switch Time] under [Fax Features].  
• If a fax calling tone is detected, or if you do not pick up the handset, the machine starts to  
receive the fax automatically.  
• To start a normal telephone call, pick up the handset, press the [Facsimile] key, and then press  
the [Clear/Stop] key. If you hear a fax calling tone or no sound, receive the fax manually.  
• If you pick up the handset but the time specified in [RX Mode Auto Switch Time] passes before  
a normal telephone call starts, the machine starts to receive the fax automatically.  
• After you pick up the handset to answer a call, make sure to press the [Facsimile] key to activate  
fax mode before pressing the [Clear/Stop] key. If the machine is not in fax mode, pressing the  
[Clear/Stop] key will not let you start a normal telephone call.  
239  
   
6. Using the Fax Function  
Receiving a fax in FAX/TAD mode  
When the reception mode is set to FAX/TAD mode, the external telephone answering device answers  
and records messages when the machine receives telephone calls. If the incoming call is a fax call, the  
machine receives the fax automatically.  
1. When there is an incoming call, the external telephone answering device rings the number of times  
specified in [Overall Ringings w/ TAD] under [Fax Features].  
If the external telephone answering device does not answer, the machine starts to receive the fax  
automatically.  
2. If the external telephone answering device answers, the machine monitors silence on the line for 30  
seconds (silence detection).  
• If a fax calling tone or no sound is detected, the machine starts to receive the fax  
automatically.  
• If a voice is detected, a normal telephone call starts. The external telephone answering device  
records messages.  
6
• You can manually receive a fax during silence detection.  
• Silence detection does not terminate for 30 seconds even if the external telephone answering  
device goes on-hook, unless you press the [Clear/Stop] key and disconnect the call.  
Receiving an Internet Fax  
You can set the machine to periodically check for e-mails (Internet Faxes) and receive them  
automatically, or you can manually check and receive them.  
• Specify the e-mail address of this machine for receiving Internet Faxes in [User Account] under  
POP3 settings of Web Image Monitor.  
• This machine may not be able to receive e-mails in HTML format.  
Automatic reception  
When [Automatic POP] under Internet Fax settings of Web Image Monitor is enabled, the machine  
periodically connects to the POP3 server, as specified in [POP Interval (minutes)], to check for new  
e-mails. The machine will download them if there are any.  
240  
     
Receiving a Fax  
Manual reception  
When [Automatic POP] is disabled, use the control panel to manually connect to the POP3 server  
and check for new e-mails.  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
CES184  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Fax Features], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Reception Settings], and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Manual POP], and then press the [OK] key.  
5. In the confirmation screen, press [Yes].  
6
The machine checks for new e-mails and downloads them if there is any.  
• If the e-mail reception fails and [Error Notification E-mail] under Internet Fax settings of Web Image  
Monitor is enabled, an error notification e-mail will be sent to the original sender.  
• If [Error Notification E-mail] is disabled or the error notification e-mail failed, the machine will print  
out an error report.  
Forwarding or Storing Faxes in Memory  
To prevent unauthorized users from seeing sensitive faxes, you can set the machine to forward received  
faxes to a preset destination, or store them in memory without printing them out.  
• This function is available for the Type 2 model only.  
241  
   
6. Using the Fax Function  
Configuring the forwarding conditions  
To specify the forwarding conditions for received faxes, configure the machine as follows:  
1. Select [Forward] for [Reception File Setting] under fax feature settings to forward received faxes.  
2. Configure what to do after forwarding in [Print Forwarded File] under fax feature settings:  
• [On]: Store the faxes in memory for printing.  
• [Off]: Delete the faxes from memory.  
3. Configure the print setting for faxes stored in memory in [Print Received File] under fax feature  
settings.  
• [On]: Automatically print out the received faxes and delete from memory.  
• [Off]: Store the received faxes in memory for later manual printing.  
4. Configure the e-mail notification setting [Notify Forward Status] under fax feature settings:  
• [Active]: Send an e-mail notification after forwarding. E-mail notification destination depends  
on how the forwarding destination is configured.  
• [Inactive]: An e-mail notification is not sent.  
5. Specify the forwarding destination in [Forwarding Destination] under fax settings using Web Image  
Monitor.  
6
• The table below shows what happens after forwarding succeeds or fails depending on the  
machine’s configuration.  
Forwardi  
ng  
[Print  
Forwarded  
File]  
[Print  
Received  
File]  
Results  
Not  
applicable  
The machine deletes the fax from memory.  
Success  
Success  
Success  
Failure  
Failure  
Off  
On  
On  
Off  
On  
The machine prints out the fax and deletes it from  
memory.  
On  
The machine stores the fax in memory for later  
manual printing.  
Off  
Not  
The machine prints out a forwarding failure report  
applicable and deletes the fax from memory.  
The machine prints out a forwarding failure report,  
prints out the fax, and then deletes it from memory.  
On  
242  
 
Receiving a Fax  
Forwardi  
ng  
[Print  
Forwarded  
File]  
[Print  
Received  
File]  
Results  
The machine prints out a forwarding failure report  
and stores the fax in memory for later manual  
printing.  
Failure  
On  
Off  
• If the machine is unable to print out a fax due to machine errors such as an empty paper tray or a  
paper jam, the fax will remain in memory and the Fax Received indicator will flash. The remaining  
pages will start printing as soon as the problem is resolved.  
• The number of forwarding attempts and the attempt interval time can be specified using Web  
Image Monitor.  
6
Configuring the storing conditions  
To specify the storing conditions for received faxes, configure the machine as follows:  
1. Select [Print] for [Reception File Setting] under fax feature settings to store received faxes in  
memory for printing.  
2. Configure the print setting for faxes stored in memory in [Print Received File] under fax feature  
settings.  
• [On]: Automatically print out the received faxes and delete from memory.  
• [Off]: Store the received faxes in memory for later manual printing.  
• When the fax is successfully printed out, it will be deleted from memory.  
• If the machine is unable to print out a fax due to machine errors such as an empty paper tray or a  
paper jam, the fax will remain in memory and the Fax Received indicator will flash. The remaining  
pages will start printing as soon as the problem is resolved.  
243  
 
6. Using the Fax Function  
Printing Out Faxes Stored in Memory  
This section describes how to print out received faxes stored in the machine’s memory.  
• If the machine remains turned off for a certain period of time (for example, when the power switch  
is turned off or when there is a power failure), all documents stored in memory will be lost. If the  
Fax Received indicator is lit or flashing, make sure to print out the stored documents before turning  
off the power (for example, prior to relocating the machine).  
When the Fax Received indicator is lit, there is a fax stored in machine’s memory. Follow the procedure  
below to print the fax.  
1. Press the [Facsimile] key.  
6
CES176  
2. Press [RX File].  
3. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [On], and then press the [OK] key.  
The machine prints out the stored fax and deletes it from memory.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
• Selecting [On] here will enable [Print Received File] under fax feature settings. If you do not want to  
print out subsequent faxes automatically, set it back to [Off].  
• If tray 2 is installed, you can select which tray to feed paper from in [Select Paper Tray] under fax  
feature settings. If you set the machine to switch between tray 1 and 2 automatically in this setting,  
you can also specify the tray the machine uses first in [Paper Tray Priority] under system settings.  
• If the Fax Received indicator is flashing, there is a received fax in the machine's memory that could  
not be printed out due to machine errors such as an empty paper tray or a paper jam. The printing  
will start as soon as the problem is resolved.  
244  
   
Receiving a Fax  
Receiving or Rejecting Faxes from Special Senders  
You can set the machine to receive (or reject) faxes only from the registered Special Senders. This helps  
you screen out unwanted documents, such as junk faxes, and prevents the wasting of fax paper.  
To use this function, you must first register Special Senders using Web Image Monitor, and then select  
whether to accept or reject faxes from them.  
• This function is not available with Internet Fax.  
Registering the Special Senders  
This section describes how to register Special Senders.  
A maximum of 30 Special Senders can be registered.  
6
1. Start the Web browser, and access the machine by entering its IP address.  
2. Click [Special Sender].  
3. From the [Destination Type] list, select [Special Sender].  
4. Select the Special Sender number from the list (1 to 30).  
245  
     
6. Using the Fax Function  
5. Enter the Special Sender’s fax number (up to 20 characters).  
6. Enter the administrator password if required.  
7. Click [Apply].  
8. Close the Web browser.  
• A fax number can contain 0 to 9, “ ”, and space.  
Limiting the incoming faxes  
This section describes how to set the machine to receive (or reject) faxes only from the programmed  
Special Senders.  
1. Start the Web browser, and access the machine by entering its IP address.  
2. Click [System Settings].  
3. Click the [Fax] tab.  
6
4. For [Authorized Reception], click [Active].  
5. For [Receive Conditions], click [Special Sender] or [Other Than Special Sender].  
• Special Sender  
Select this to receive faxes from the Special Senders and reject faxes from all other senders.  
• Other Than Special Sender  
Select this to reject faxes from the Special Senders and receive faxes from all other senders.  
6. Enter the administrator password if required.  
7. Click [OK].  
8. Close the Web browser.  
246  
 
7. Configuring the Machine Using the  
Control Panel  
This chapter describes how to configure and adjust the machine's operational settings using the control  
panel.  
The machine can be operated using its default, but the configuration can be changed depending on the  
needs of the user. Changes to settings are stored even if the machine is turned off.  
Basic Operation Using the Menu Screen  
This section describes the basic procedure for specifying and changing the machine's settings.  
If you want to configure the machine's system settings, press the [User Tools] key. If you want to  
configure the settings of machine's current operation mode, press the [ ][ ] keys.  
The procedure for changing the copy quality setting is provided as an example.  
1. Press the [Copy] key.  
7
CES174  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys.  
CES168  
3. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Original Type], and then press the [OK] key.  
247  
     
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
4. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the document type of the original, and then press the [OK]  
key.  
5. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
7
248  
Menu Chart  
Menu Chart  
This section lists the parameters included in each menu.  
• Some items might not appear depending on the model type or machine's configuration.  
• Some items can also be configured using Web Image Monitor.  
Copy Settings ([ ][ ] key setting)  
Select Paper  
Sort  
Original Type  
Density  
Reduce/Enlarge  
Colour Adjustment  
2 Sided Copy  
7
Scan Settings ([ ][ ] key setting)  
Scan Size  
B&W Scanning Mode  
Max. E-mail Size  
Density  
Resolution  
Compression (Colour)  
Limitless Scan  
File Type  
Fax Transmission Settings ([ ][ ] key setting)  
Immediate TX  
Resolution  
Density  
249  
   
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
Pause Time  
Auto Redial  
Print Fax Header  
Fax Feature Settings ([User Tools] key setting)  
Reception Settings  
Select Paper Tray  
Delete TX Standby File  
Communication Settings  
Report Print Settings  
Fax Address Book Settings ([User Tools] key setting)  
Quick Dial Dest.  
Fax Speed Dial Dest.  
7
System Settings ([User Tools] key setting)  
Adjust Sound Volume  
Tray Paper Settings  
I/O Timeout  
Auto Continue  
Toner Saving  
Supplies Status  
Scanner Carriage  
Anti-Humidity Level  
Colour Registration  
Auto Cleaning  
B&W Print Priority  
Notify: Toner Almost Empty  
250  
Menu Chart  
Network Settings ([User Tools] key setting)  
Ethernet  
IPv4 Configuration  
IPv6 Configuration  
Printing Lists/Reports ([User Tools] key setting)  
Configuration Page  
Fax Journal  
TX/RX Standby File List  
Quick Dial Dest. List  
Fax Speed Dial Dest. List  
Scanner Dest. List  
Scanner Journal  
Maintenance Page  
Special Sender List  
7
Administrator Settings ([User Tools] key setting)  
Set Date/Time  
Program Fax Information  
Dial/Push Phone  
PSTN / PBX  
PBX Access Number  
Function Priority  
System Auto Reset Timer  
Energy Saver Mode  
Language  
Country  
Reset Settings  
251  
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
Admin. Tools Lock  
IPsec  
Fax Number Confirmation  
Printer Feature Settings ([User Tools] key setting)  
List/Test Print  
System  
PCL Menu  
PS Menu  
7
252  
Copy Settings  
Copy Settings  
This section describes how to configure the copy settings.  
Changing Copy Settings  
The procedure for changing the sort copy setting is provided as an example.  
1. Press the [Copy] key.  
CES174  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys.  
7
CES168  
3. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Sort], and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [On] or [Off], and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
253  
     
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
Copy Setting Parameters  
This section describes the copy setting parameters.  
Select Paper  
Specifies the paper size used for printing copies.  
When a tray is selected, the machine prints from that tray only.  
When a paper size is selected, the machine prints from the trays that contain the paper of the  
specified size, except the bypass tray. If tray 1 and tray 2 both contain the paper of the specified  
size, the machine starts to print from the tray specified as the priority tray in [Paper Tray Priority]  
under system settings. If that tray runs out of paper, the machine automatically switches to the other  
tray to continue printing.  
If tray 2 is not installed, only [Tray 1] and [Bypass Tray] appear.  
Default: [Tray 1]  
• Tray 1  
• Tray 2  
• Bypass Tray  
• A4  
• 8 1/2 × 11  
Sort  
7
Configures the machine to sort the output pages into sets when making multiple copies of a multi-  
page document (P1, P2, P1, P2...).  
Default: [Off]  
• On  
• Off  
Original Type  
Specifies the content of originals, to optimize copy quality.  
Default: [Mixed]  
• Text  
Select this when the original contains only text and no photographs or pictures.  
• Photo  
Select this when the original contains photographs or pictures. Use this mode for the following  
types of original:  
• Photographs  
• Pages that are entirely or mainly photographs or pictures, such as magazine pages.  
• Mixed  
254  
   
Copy Settings  
Select this when the original contains both text and photographs or pictures.  
Density  
Specifies the image density for photocopying.  
Default:  
(Lightest)  
(Darkest)  
Reduce/Enlarge  
Specifies a combined copy, or the percentage by which copies are enlarged or reduced.  
Default: [100%]  
• 50%  
• 65% (  
model only)  
model only)  
model only)  
model only)  
• 71% (  
• 78% (  
• 82% (  
7
• 93%  
• 100%  
• Comb. 2 on 1  
Select this to photocopy two pages of an original onto a single sheet of paper.  
When selecting this option, also select the orientation.  
• Portrait  
CES033  
• Landscape  
CES034  
• Comb. 4 on 1  
255  
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
Select this to photocopy four pages of an original onto a single sheet of paper.  
When selecting this option, also select the orientation and layout.  
• Portrait: L to R  
CES035  
• Portrait: T to B  
CES036  
• Landscape: L to R  
7
CES037  
• Landscape: T to B  
CES038  
• 122% (  
• 129% (  
• 141% (  
• 155% (  
• 200%  
model only)  
model only)  
model only)  
model only)  
• 400%  
• ID Card Copy  
256  
Copy Settings  
Sets the machine to copy the front and back sides of an ID card, or other small document,  
onto the front of a single sheet of paper.  
Note that enabling this setting automatically disables the [2 Sided Copy] setting.  
• Zoom 25-400%  
Colour Adjustment  
Specify the color balance of red, green and blue.  
Default for all colors:  
• Red  
(Darkest)  
(Lightest)  
(Darkest)  
• Green  
7
(Lightest)  
(Darkest)  
• Blue  
(Lightest)  
2 Sided Copy  
Sets the machine to make 2-sided copies by copying single-sided documents onto the front and  
back sides of each sheet. You can select top-to-top or top-to-bottom binding, in either portrait or  
landscape orientation.  
Note that enabling this setting automatically disables the [ID Card Copy] setting.  
Default: [Off]  
• Off  
• Top to Top  
257  
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
CES125  
CES126  
CES127  
CES128  
• Top to Top  
• Top to Bottom  
7
• Top to Bottom  
258  
Scanner Settings  
Scanner Settings  
This section describes how to configure the scanner settings.  
Changing Scanner Settings  
The procedure for changing the file type setting is provided as an example.  
1. Press the [Scanner] key.  
CES175  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys.  
7
CES168  
3. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [File Type], and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Multi-page] or [Single Page], and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
259  
     
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
Scanner Setting Parameters  
This section describes the scanner setting parameters.  
Scan Size  
Specifies the scanning size according to the size of the original.  
Default:  
• 8 1/2 × 14, 8 1/2 × 11, 8 1/2 × 5 1/2, 7 1/4 × 10 1/2, A4, B5, A5, Custom Size  
B&W Scanning Mode  
[A4],  
[8 1/2 × 11]  
Specifies the scanning mode for black-and-white scanning using the control panel.  
Default: [Halftone]  
• Halftone  
The machine creates 1-bit black-and-white images. Images contain only black and white  
colors.  
• Grey Scale  
The machine creates 8-bit black-and-white images. Images contain black and white, and  
intermediate gray colors.  
Max. E-mail Size  
7
Specifies the maximum size of a file that can be sent by e-mail.  
Default: [1 MB]  
• 1 MB  
• 2 MB  
• 3 MB  
• 4 MB  
• 5 MB  
• No Limit  
Density  
Specifies the image density for scanning originals.  
Default:  
(Lightest)  
(Darkest)  
260  
   
Scanner Settings  
Resolution  
Specifies the resolution for scanning the original.  
Default: [300 × 300dpi]  
• 100 × 100dpi  
• 150 × 150dpi  
• 200 × 200dpi  
• 300 × 300dpi  
• 400 × 400dpi  
• 600 × 600dpi  
Compression (Colour)  
Specifies the color compression ratio for JPEG files. The lower the compression ratio, the higher the  
quality but greater the file size.  
Default: [Medium]  
• Low  
• Medium  
• High  
Limitless Scan  
7
Sets the machine to request next originals when scanning with the exposure glass.  
Default: [Off]  
• On  
• Off  
File Type  
Specifies whether to create a multi-page file containing all pages or separate single-page files  
when scanning multiple pages.  
Note that a scanned file can contain multiple pages only when the file format is PDF or TIFF. If the  
file format is JPEG, a single-page file is created for each scanned page.  
Default: [Multi-page]  
• Multi-page  
• Single Page  
261  
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
Fax Transmission Settings  
This section describes how to configure the fax transmission settings.  
Changing Fax Transmission Settings  
The procedure for setting the resolution for scanning the original is provided as an example.  
1. Press the [Facsimile] key.  
CES176  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys.  
7
CES168  
3. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Resolution], and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the desired resolution, and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
262  
     
Fax Transmission Settings  
Fax Transmission Setting Parameters  
This section describes fax transmission setting parameters.  
Immediate TX  
Sets the machine to send a fax immediately when the original is scanned.  
Default: [Off]  
• Off  
Select this when using Memory Transmission.  
• On  
Select this when using Immediate Transmission.  
• Next Fax Only  
Select this when using Immediate Transmission for the next transmission only.  
Resolution  
Specifies the resolution to use for scanning originals.  
The "Photo" resolution is not available for Internet Faxes. Faxes will be sent using "Detail" resolution  
if "Photo" resolution has been specified.  
Default: [Standard]  
• Standard  
7
Select this when the original is a printed or typewritten document with normal-sized  
characters.  
• Detail  
Select this when the original is a document with small print.  
• Photo  
Select this when the original contains images such as photographs or shaded drawings.  
Density  
Specifies the image density to use for scanning originals.  
Default: [Normal]  
• Light  
• Normal  
• Dark  
Pause Time  
Specifies the length of pause time when a pause is inserted between the digits of a fax number.  
Default: 3 seconds  
• 1 to 15 seconds, in 1 second increments  
263  
   
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
Auto Redial  
Sets the machine to redial the fax destination automatically when the line is busy or a transmission  
error occurs, if the machine is in Memory Transmission mode. The number of redial attempts is  
preset to two or three times, depending on the [Country] setting under [Admin. Tools], in five-minute  
intervals.  
Default: [On]  
• Off  
• On  
Print Fax Header  
Sets the machine to add a header to every fax you send. The header includes the current date and  
time, user fax name and number, job ID, and page information.  
Default: [On]  
• Off  
• On  
7
264  
Fax Feature Settings  
Fax Feature Settings  
This section describes how to configure the fax feature settings.  
Changing Fax Feature Settings  
The procedure for setting the tray for printing faxes is provided as an example.  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
CES184  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Fax Features], and then press the [OK] key.  
7
3. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Select Paper Tray], and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the desired tray, and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
Fax Feature Setting Parameters  
This section describes fax feature setting parameters.  
• Some items might not appear, depending on the model type you are using.  
Reception Settings  
Specifies the settings for receiving a fax.  
• Switch Reception Mode  
Specifies the reception mode.  
Default: [Fax Only]  
265  
         
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
• Fax Only  
The machine automatically answers all incoming calls in fax reception mode.  
• FAX/TEL(Mnl.)  
The machine rings when it receives incoming calls. The machine receives faxes only  
when you manually receive faxes.  
• FAX/TAD  
The machine receives faxes automatically when a fax call is received. Otherwise, the  
connected telephone answering device answers the call.  
• FAX/TEL(Auto)  
The machine receives faxes automatically when a fax call is received. Otherwise, the  
machine starts to ring.  
• Auto Reduction  
Sets the machine to reduce the size of a received fax if it is too large to print on a single sheet  
of paper.  
Note that the machine only reduces the size down to 74%. If further reduction is required to fit  
the fax on a single sheet, it will be printed on separate sheets without being reduced.  
Default: [On]  
(Default may be [Off] depending on the [Country] setting under [Admin. Tools].)  
7
• Off  
• On  
• Overall Ringings w/ TAD  
Specifies the number of times the external telephone answering device rings before the  
machine starts to receive faxes in FAX/TAD mode.  
Default: 5 times  
• 1 to 20 times, in increments of 1  
• Number of Rings  
Specifies the number of times the machine rings before it starts to receive faxes in Fax Only  
mode.  
Default: 3 times  
• 3 to 5 times, in increments of 1  
• RX Mode Auto Switch Time  
Specifies the length of time the machine tries to detect the fax calling tone in FAX/TEL  
Automatic mode.  
Default: 15 seconds  
• 5 to 99 seconds, 1 second increments  
266  
Fax Feature Settings  
• Authorized Reception  
Sets the machine to receive (or reject) faxes only from the programmed Special Senders. This  
helps you screen out unwanted documents, such as junk faxes, and prevents the wasting of  
fax paper.  
Default: [Inactive]  
• Active  
• Inactive  
• Auth.RX: Receive Conditions  
Specifies whether to receive or reject faxes from the programmed Special Senders.  
This setting is available when [Authorized Reception] is enabled.  
Default: [Special Sender]  
• Special Sender  
Receive faxes from the Special Senders and reject faxes from all other senders.  
• Other Than Special Sender  
Reject faxes from the Special Senders and receive faxes from all other senders.  
• Reception File Setting  
Sets the machine to store received faxes into memory for printing or forward them to a preset  
destination.  
7
This setting appears only for the Type 2 model.  
Default: [Print]  
• Print  
• Forward  
• Print Received File  
Sets the machine to automatically print the faxes received into memory or store them for later  
manual printing.  
This setting appears only for the Type 2 model.  
Default: [On]  
• On  
Automatically print out the received faxes and delete from memory.  
• Off  
Store the received faxes in memory for manual printing.  
• Print Forwarded File  
267  
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
Sets the machine to store the faxes in memory for printing or delete them after forwarding.  
This setting appears only for the Type 2 model.  
Default: [Off]  
• On  
Store the faxes in memory for printing after forwarding.  
• Off  
Delete the faxes from memory after forwarding.  
• Notify Forward Status  
Sets the machine to send e-mail notifications after faxes are forwarded. The e-mail notification  
destination depends on how the forwarding destination is configured using Web Image  
This setting appears only for the Type 2 model.  
Default: [Inactive]  
• Active  
• Inactive  
• Manual POP  
Connects to the POP3 server to receive e-mail messages manually.  
7
Press [Yes] to connect to the POP3 server and receive e-mail messages. Press [No] to exit to  
the previous level of the menu tree without connecting to the POP3 server.  
Select Paper Tray  
Specifies the tray for printing received faxes. Note that only A4, Letter, or Legal size paper can be  
used for printing faxes. Make sure to select a tray that contains paper of the valid size.  
If tray 2 is not installed, only [Tray 1] appears.  
Default: [Auto]  
• Auto  
The machine uses tray 1 and tray 2 if they contain paper of the same size. In this case, the  
machine starts to print from the tray specified as the priority tray in [Paper Tray Priority] under  
system settings. If that tray runs out of paper, the machine automatically switches to the other  
tray to continue printing.  
• Tray 1  
• Tray 2  
Delete TX Standby File  
Deletes unsent fax jobs remaining in the machine's memory.  
This function is only performed when selected.  
• Delete Selected File  
268  
Fax Feature Settings  
To delete a fax job, select the desired job, and then select [Yes]. Selecting [No] exits to the  
previous level of the menu tree without deleting the fax job.  
• Delete All Files  
To delete the fax jobs, select [Yes]. Selecting [No] exits to the previous level of the menu tree  
without deleting the fax job.  
Communication Settings  
• ECM Transmission  
Sets the machine to automatically resend parts of the data that are lost during transmission.  
This function is not available with Internet Fax transmission.  
Default: [On]  
• Off  
• On  
• ECM Reception  
Sets the machine to automatically receive parts of the data that are lost during reception.  
This function is not available with Internet Fax reception.  
Default: [On]  
• Off  
7
• On  
• Dial Tone Detect  
Sets the machine to detect a dial tone before the machine begins to dial the destination  
automatically.  
Default: [Detect]  
• Detect  
• Not Detect  
• Transmission Speed  
Specifies the transmission speed for the fax modem.  
Default: [33.6 Kbps]  
• 33.6 Kbps  
• 14.4 Kbps  
• 9.6 Kbps  
• 7.2 Kbps  
• 4.8 Kbps  
• 2.4 Kbps  
• Reception Speed  
269  
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
Specifies the reception speed for the fax modem.  
Default: [33.6 Kbps]  
• 33.6 Kbps  
• 14.4 Kbps  
• 9.6 Kbps  
• 7.2 Kbps  
• 4.8 Kbps  
• 2.4 Kbps  
• JBIG  
Enables transmission and reception of JBIG-compressed images, which require less  
communication time than MMR-/MR-/MH-compressed images.  
Note that to use this function, [ECM Transmission] and [ECM Reception] must also be  
enabled.  
This function is not available with Internet Fax.  
Default: [Active]  
• Active  
• Inactive  
7
Report Print Settings  
• Print TX Status Report  
Sets the machine to print a transmission report automatically after a fax transmission.  
When the machine is in Immediate Transmission mode, the image of the original will not be  
reproduced on the report, even if [Error Only (Image Attached)] or [Every TX (Image  
Attached)] is selected.  
The transmission report will be printed using the tray set for [Facsimile] under [Paper Tray  
Priority] in system settings, on A4 or Letter size paper.  
Default: [Every TX (Image Attached)]  
• Error Only  
Prints a report when a transmission error occurs.  
• Error Only (Image Attached)  
Prints a report with an image of the original when transmission error occurs.  
• Every TX  
Prints a report for every fax transmission.  
• Every TX (Image Attached)  
Prints a report with an image of the original for every fax transmission.  
270  
Fax Feature Settings  
• Do not Print  
• Print Fax Journal  
Sets the machine to print a fax journal automatically for every 50 fax jobs (both sent and  
received).  
The fax journal will be printed using the tray set for [Facsimile] under [Paper Tray Priority] in  
system settings, on A4 or Letter size paper.  
Default: [Auto Print]  
• Auto Print  
• Do not Auto Print  
7
271  
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
Fax Address Book Settings  
This section describes the fax Quick Dial/Speed Dial settings.  
Registering Fax Destinations in Fax Quick Dial/Speed Dial  
Register fax destinations in the Address Book using this menu.  
• A password for accessing the [Address Book] menu can be specified in [Admin. Tools Lock].  
Fax Address Book Parameters  
Quick Dial Dest.  
7
Specifies the fax number and name for Quick Dial entries. You can register up to 20 Quick Dial  
entries.  
• No.  
Specifies the Quick Dial number.  
• Fax No.  
Specifies the fax number for Quick Dial entries. The fax number can contain up to 40  
characters, including 0 to 9, pause, " ", " ", and space.  
• Name  
Specifies the name for Quick Dial entries. The name can contain up to 20 characters.  
Fax Speed Dial Dest.  
Specifies the fax number and name for Speed Dial entries. You can register up to 200 Speed Dial  
entries.  
• No.  
Specifies the Speed Dial number.  
• Fax No.  
Specifies the fax number for Speed Dial entries. The fax number can contain up to 40  
characters, including 0 to 9, pause, " ", " ", and space.  
• Name  
272  
         
Fax Address Book Settings  
Specifies the name for Speed Dial entries. The name can contain up to 20 characters.  
7
273  
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
System Settings  
This section describes the machine's operational settings.  
Changing System Settings  
The procedure for changing the volume of the panel key sound is provided as an example.  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
CES184  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [System Settings], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Adjust Sound Volume], and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Panel Key Sound], and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [ ][ ] keys to change the volume, and then press the [OK] key.  
6. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
7
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
System Setting Parameters  
This section describes the system setting parameters.  
• Some items might not appear, depending on the model type you are using.  
Adjust Sound Volume  
Specifies the volume of the sounds produced by the machine.  
Default: [Low] for [Panel Key Sound], and [Middle] for other parameters.  
• Panel Key Sound  
274  
         
System Settings  
Specifies the volume of the beep that sounds when a key is pressed.  
• Off  
• Low  
• Middle  
• High  
• Ring Volume  
Specifies the volume of the ring when a call is received.  
• Off  
• Low  
• Middle  
• High  
• On Hook Mode  
Specifies the volume of the sound from the speaker during on hook mode.  
• Off  
• Low  
• Middle  
• High  
7
• Job End Tone  
Specifies the volume of the beep that sounds when a job is complete.  
• Off  
• Low  
• Middle  
• High  
• Job Error Tone  
Specifies the volume of the beep that sounds when a fax transmission error occurs.  
• Off  
• Low  
• Middle  
• High  
• Alarm Volume  
Specifies the volume of the alarm that sounds when an operation error occurs.  
• Off  
• Low  
275  
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
• Middle  
• High  
Tray Paper Settings  
• Paper Type: Tray 1  
Specifies the paper type for tray 1.  
Default: [Middle Thick Paper]  
Thin Paper, Plain Paper, Middle Thick Paper, Thick Paper 1, Recycled Paper, Colour Paper,  
Letterhead, Preprinted Paper, Prepunched Paper, Label Paper, Bond Paper, Cardstock,  
Envelope, Thick Paper 2  
• Paper Type: Tray 2  
Specifies the paper type for tray 2.  
This setting appears only when tray 2 is installed.  
Default: [Middle Thick Paper]  
Thin Paper, Plain Paper, Middle Thick Paper, Thick Paper 1, Recycled Paper, Colour Paper,  
Letterhead, Preprinted Paper, Prepunched Paper  
• Paper Type: Bypass Tray  
Specifies the paper type for bypass tray.  
Default: [Middle Thick Paper]  
7
Thin Paper, Plain Paper, Middle Thick Paper, Thick Paper 1, Recycled Paper, Colour Paper,  
Letterhead, Prepunched Paper, Label Paper, Bond Paper, Cardstock, Envelope, Thick Paper 2  
• Paper Size: Tray 1  
Specifies the paper size for tray 1.  
Default:  
[A4],  
[8 1/2 x 11]  
A4, B5 JIS, A5, B6 JIS, A6, 8 1/2 x 14, 8 1/2 x 11, 5 1/2 x 8 1/2, 7 1/4x10 1/2, 8 x  
13, 8 1/2 x 13, 8 1/4 x 13, 16K, 4 1/8 x 9 1/2, 3 7/8 x 7 1/2, C5 Env, C6 Env, DL  
Env, Custom Size  
• Paper Size: Tray 2  
Specifies the paper size for tray 2.  
This setting appears only when tray 2 is installed.  
Default:  
[A4],  
[8 1/2 x 11]  
[8 1/2 x 11]  
A4, 8 1/2 x 11  
• Paper Size: Bypass Tray  
Specifies the paper size for bypass tray.  
Default:  
[A4],  
276  
System Settings  
A4, B5 JIS, A5, B6 JIS, A6, 8 1/2 x 14, 8 1/2 x 11, 5 1/2 x 8 1/2, 7 1/4x10 1/2, 8 x  
13, 8 1/2 x 13, 8 1/4 x 13, 16K, 4 1/8 x 9 1/2, 3 7/8 x 7 1/2, C5 Env, C6 Env, DL  
Env, Custom Size  
• Bypass Tray Priority  
Specifies how print jobs using the bypass tray are handled.  
Default: [Machine Setting(s)]  
• Machine Setting(s)  
The machine prints all print jobs according to the machine’s settings.  
An error will occur if the paper size/type settings of the machine and printer driver do  
not match.  
• Any Size/Type  
The machine prints all print jobs according to the printer driver’s settings.  
Printing proceeds even if the paper size/type settings of the machine and printer driver  
do not match. However, if the paper is too small for the print job, the printed image will  
be cropped.  
• Any Custom Size/Type  
The machine prints custom size print jobs according to the printer driver’s settings and  
prints standard size print jobs according to the machine’s settings.  
7
For custom size print jobs, printing proceeds even if the paper size/type settings of the  
machine and printer driver do not match. However, if the paper is too small for the print  
job, the printed image will be cropped.  
For standard size print jobs, an error will occur if the paper size/type settings of the  
machine and printer driver do not match.  
• Paper Tray Priority  
Specifies the tray that the machine uses first for print jobs, printing out copies, or printing out  
faxes, from tray 1 or tray 2. If that tray runs out of paper, the machine automatically switches  
to the other tray to continue printing.  
If tray 2 is not installed, only [Tray 1] appears.  
Default for all functions: [Tray 1]  
• Printer  
If automatic tray selection is specified for the print job and both tray 1 and tray 2 contain  
paper that matches the print job, the machine starts to print from the specified tray.  
• Copier  
If [A4] or [8 1/2 x 11] is selected for [Select Paper] under copy settings and both tray 1  
and tray 2 contain paper of that size, the machine starts to print from the specified tray.  
• Facsimile  
277  
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
If [Auto] is selected for [Select Paper Tray] under fax feature settings, and both tray 1  
and tray 2 contain paper of the same size, the machine starts to print from the specified  
tray.  
I/O Timeout  
• USB  
Specifies how many seconds the machine waits for print data, if the data is interrupted while it  
is being sent from the computer via USB. If the machine does not receive any more data within  
the time specified here, the machine only prints the data it has received. If printing is frequently  
interrupted by data from other ports, increase the timeout period.  
Default: 60 seconds  
• 15 sec.  
• 60 sec.  
• 300 sec.  
• Network  
Specifies how many seconds the machine waits for print data, if the data is interrupted while it  
is being sent from the computer via network. If the machine does not receive any more data  
within the time specified here, the machine only prints the data it has received. If printing is  
frequently interrupted by data from other ports, increase the timeout period.  
7
Default: 60 seconds  
• 15 sec.  
• 60 sec.  
• 300 sec.  
• Locked Print  
Specifies how many seconds the machine holds a new Locked Print file, when the machine  
cannot store any more Locked Print files. Within this time, you can print or delete the new  
Locked Print file. You can also print or delete an existing Locked Print file so that the new  
Locked Print file can be stored in the machine.  
This setting appears only for the Type 2 model.  
Default: 60 seconds  
• 0 to 300 seconds, in increments of 1 second  
• User Authentication (Copy)  
Specifies how many seconds a user stays authenticated after paper is output when copying  
with the exposure glass. Note that authentication for other functions will expire immediately  
after using that function.  
This setting appears only for the Type 2 model (when the user restriction function is enabled  
via Web Image Monitor).  
278  
System Settings  
Default: 30 seconds  
• 5 to 60 seconds, in increments of 1 second  
• Fixed USB Port  
Specifies whether the same printer/LAN-Fax driver can be used for multiple machines or not  
under USB connection.  
Default: [Off]  
• On  
The same printer/LAN-Fax driver you have installed in your computer can be used with  
any machine other than the one originally used for installation, if the machine is of the  
same model.  
• Off  
You must install the printer/LAN-Fax driver separately for individual machines, because  
the machine other than the original will be recognized as a new device upon USB  
connection.  
Auto Continue  
Sets the machine to ignore an error with paper size or type and continue printing. The printing stops  
temporarily when an error is detected, and restarts automatically after about ten seconds using the  
settings made on the control panel.  
7
Default: [Off]  
• On  
• Off  
Toner Saving  
Sets the machine to print using a reduced amount of toner (for prints made by the copier function  
only).  
Default: [Off]  
• On  
• Off  
Supplies Status  
Displays information about consumables.  
• Toner  
Displays the remaining amount of toner.  
• Black:  
(New),  
,
,
,
,
(Needs replacing)  
• Magenta:  
279  
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
(New),  
,
,
,
,
,
,
,
,
,
,
,
,
(Needs replacing)  
• Cyan:  
• Yellow:  
(New),  
(Needs replacing)  
(New),  
(Needs replacing)  
• Other Supplies  
Displays the remaining life of the waste toner bottle, fusing unit, transfer belt, and second  
transfer roller.  
To replace the fusing unit, transfer belt, or second transfer roller, contact your sales or service  
representative.  
• Waste Toner Bottle:  
[Waste Toner Bottle: Full] (Usable), [WasteTnr.Bttl.: AlmostFull] (Almost full and needs  
replacing soon), [Waste Toner Bottle: Ready] (Needs replacing)  
• Fusing Unit:  
7
(New),  
,
,
,
,
,
,
,
,
,
,
,
,
(Needs replacing)  
• IntTrans. Belt  
(New),  
(Needs replacing)  
• Transfer Roller:  
(New),  
(Needs replacing)  
Scanner Carriage  
Returns the scanning unit inside the machine to its original position. Before transporting the  
machine, use this function to return the scanning unit to its original position.  
Press [Yes] to return the scanning unit to its original position. Press [No] to exit to the previous level  
of the menu tree without returning the scanning unit to its original position.  
Anti-Humidity Level  
Sets the machine to produce prints in consistent quality even when humidity is high.  
Note that the default value for this setting will not be restored by performing [Reset All Settings]  
under [Admin. Tools] or [Reset Menu Settings] under [Administrator Tools] of Web Image Monitor.  
Default: [Off]  
280  
System Settings  
• Off  
• Lvl.1: Weak  
Select this mode if printouts are blurred.  
• Lvl.2: Medium  
Select this mode if printouts are curled and/or blurred. Note that if you select this mode, the  
first print takes longer than subsequent prints to complete.  
• Lvl.3: Strong  
Select this mode if printouts are still curled and/or blurred even when prints are made in [Lvl.  
2: Medium]. Note that this mode requires more time to produce the first print than [Lvl.2:  
Medium].  
Colour Registration  
Adjusts color registration as necessary. (This adjustment is usually executed by the machine  
automatically.)  
Press [Yes] to execute color registration adjustment. Press [No] to exit to the previous level of the  
menu tree without adjusting color registration.  
Auto Cleaning  
Sets the machine to execute periodic cleaning of the interior. You may hear some noise while  
cleaning is being executed. This noise does not indicate a malfunction.  
7
Default: [On]  
• [On]  
• [Off]  
B&W Print Priority  
Sets the machine to suppress the consumption of color toner when printing black-and-white pages.  
Also, the amount of color toner consumed during warm-up time for maintenance will also be  
lowered.  
Note that the default value for this setting will not be restored by performing [Reset All Settings]  
under [Admin. Tools] or [Reset Menu Settings] under [Administrator Tools] of Web Image Monitor.  
Default: [Off]  
• [On]  
• [Off]  
Notify: Toner Almost Empty  
Specifies the low toner level notification timing.  
Note that the default value for this setting will not be restored by performing [Reset All Settings]  
under [Admin. Tools] or [Reset Menu Settings] under [Administrator Tools] of Web Image Monitor.  
Default: [Normal]  
• Sooner  
281  
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
Low toner level notification will be made when the number of pages that can be printed with  
the remaining toner is approximately 300.  
• Normal  
Low toner level notification will be made when the number of pages that can be printed with  
the remaining toner is approximately 200.  
• Later  
Low toner level notification will be made when the number of pages that can be printed with  
the remaining toner is approximately 100.  
7
282  
Network Settings  
Network Settings  
This section describes the network settings.  
Changing Network Settings  
The procedure for changing the network speed is provided as an example.  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
CES184  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Network Settings], and then press the [OK] key.  
7
3. If you are requested to enter a password, enter the password using the number keys,  
and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Ethernet], and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Set Ethernet Speed], and then press the [OK] key.  
6. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the network speed, and then press the [OK] key.  
7. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
• A password for accessing the [Network Settings] menu can be specified in [Admin. Tools Lock].  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
Network Setting Parameters  
This section describes the network setting parameters.  
Ethernet  
• MAC Address  
283  
         
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
Displays the machine's MAC address.  
• Ethernet Speed  
Displays the current Ethernet speed setting.  
• 100Mbps Full Duplex  
• 100Mbps Half Duplex  
• 10Mbps Full Duplex  
• 10Mbps Half Duplex  
• Ethernet Unavailable  
Appears when a network cable is not connected.  
• Set Ethernet Speed  
Specifies the speed for Ethernet communication. Select a speed that matches your network  
environment.  
For most networks, the default setting is the optimum setting.  
Default: [Auto Select]  
• Auto Select  
• 100Mbps Full Duplex  
• 100Mbps Half Duplex  
• 10Mbps Full Duplex  
• 10Mbps Half Duplex  
IPv4 Configuration  
7
• DHCP  
Sets the machine to receive its IPv4 address, subnet mask, and default gateway address  
automatically from a DHCP server.  
When DHCP is used, you cannot specify the IPv4 address, subnet mask, or default gateway  
address manually.  
Default: [Active]  
• Active  
• Inactive  
• IP Address  
Specifies the machine's IPv4 address when DHCP is not used.  
Use this menu to check the current IP address when DHCP is used.  
Default: XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX  
The numbers represented by "X" vary according to your network environment.  
• Subnet Mask  
284  
Network Settings  
Specifies the machine's subnet mask when DHCP is not used.  
Use this menu to check the current subnet mask when DHCP is used.  
Default: XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX  
The numbers represented by "X" vary according to your network environment.  
• Gateway Address  
Specifies the machine's default gateway address when DHCP is not used.  
Use this menu to check the current default gateway address when DHCP is used.  
Default: XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX  
The numbers represented by "X" vary according to your network environment.  
• IP Address Method  
Displays the IP address acquisition method.  
• DHCP  
• Auto IP  
• Manual Config.  
• Default IP  
IPv6 Configuration  
• IPv6  
Select whether to enable or disable IPv6.  
7
Default: [Active]  
• Active  
• Inactive  
• DHCP  
Sets the machine to receive its IPv6 address from a DHCP server.  
When DHCP is used, you cannot specify the IPv6 address manually.  
Default: [Inactive]  
• Active  
• Inactive  
• IP Address (DHCP)  
Displays the IPv6 address obtained from a DHCP server.  
• Manual Config. Address  
• Manual Config. Address  
Specifies the machine's IPv6 address when DHCP is not used. Can contain up to 39  
characters.  
285  
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
• Prefix Length  
Specifies the prefix length, using a value between 0 and 128.  
• Gateway Address  
Specifies the IPv6 address of the default gateway. Can contain up to 39 characters.  
• Stateless Address  
Displays the IPv6 stateless addresses obtained from a Router Advertisement.  
• Stateless Address 1  
• Stateless Address 2  
• Stateless Address 3  
• Stateless Address 4  
• Link-local Address  
Displays the IPv6 link local address.  
• Contact your network administrator for information about the network configuration.  
7
286  
Printing Lists/Reports  
Printing Lists/Reports  
This section describes the types of reports that can be printed.  
Printing the Configuration Page  
Follow the procedure below to print the configuration page.  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
CES184  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Print List/Report], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Configuration Page], and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press [Yes] in the confirmation screen.  
7
The configuration page is printed.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
Types of Report  
Configuration Page  
Prints general information and the current configurations of the machine.  
Fax Journal  
Prints a fax transmission and reception journal for the last 50 jobs.  
TX/RX Standby File List  
Prints a list of fax jobs remaining in the machine's memory to be printed, sent, or forwarded.  
Quick Dial Dest. List  
Prints a list of scan and fax Quick Dial entries.  
287  
           
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
Fax Speed Dial Dest. List  
Prints a list of Speed Dial entries.  
• Sort by Speed Dial No.  
Prints the list with the entries sorted by Speed Dial registration number.  
• Sort by Name  
Prints the list with the entries sorted by name.  
Scanner Dest. List  
Prints a list of scan destinations.  
Scanner Journal  
Prints a scanner journal for the last 100 Scan to E-mail, Scan to FTP, and Scan to Folder  
transmissions.  
Maintenance Page  
Prints the maintenance page.  
Special Sender List  
Prints a list of fax Special Senders.  
• Reports will be printed using the tray set for [Facsimile] under [Paper Tray Priority] in system  
settings.  
7
• Repots will be printed on A4 or Letter size paper. Load one of these sizes of paper into the tray  
before printing reports.  
Reading the Configuration Page  
System Reference  
• Model Name  
Shows the machine model name.  
• Machine ID  
Shows the serial number assigned to the machine by the manufacturer.  
• Total Memory  
Shows the total amount of memory installed on the machine.  
• Bootloader Version  
288  
   
Printing Lists/Reports  
Shows the version of the machine's bootloader.  
• Firmware Version  
Shows the version of the machine's firmware.  
• Engine FW Version  
Shows the version of firmware for the machine engine.  
Paper Input  
Information about tray 2 appears only when it is installed.  
• Tray 1  
Shows paper size and type settings.  
• Tray 2  
Shows paper size and type settings.  
• Bypass Tray  
Shows paper size and type settings.  
• Tray Priority  
Shows the fax, printer, and copy priority tray settings.  
• Bypass Tray Priority  
Shows the bypass tray priority settings.  
• B&W Print Priority  
7
Shows the black-and-white print priority setting.  
• Notify:TonerAlmstEmpty  
Shows the toner near-end notification setting.  
Supplies Status  
Shows information about supply levels.  
• Toner (Black)  
• Toner (Magenta)  
• Toner (Yellow)  
• Toner (Cyan)  
• Fusing Unit  
• Int. Transfer Unit  
• Transfer Roller  
• Waste Toner Bottle  
Counter  
Shows counter information.  
289  
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
• Total Counter  
• Printer  
• Coverage  
• Economy Color Prints  
• Scanner  
• Facsimile  
• Copier  
• Duplex  
• No.of Toner (High Yield /Low Yield)  
System Settings  
Shows the system settings.  
Admin Tools  
Shows the administrator settings.  
Copy Settings  
Shows the copy settings.  
Scan Settings  
Shows the scanner settings.  
Fax Features  
7
Shows the fax settings.  
Network Settings  
Shows the settings for the following items:  
• MAC Address  
• Set Ethernet Speed  
• TCP/IP  
• SNMP  
• E-mail  
IPv6 Configuration  
Shows the IPv6 settings.  
• IPv6  
• DHCP  
• IP Address (DHCP)  
• Stateless Address  
• Link-local Address  
290  
Printing Lists/Reports  
• Manual Address  
• Prefix Length  
• DNS Method  
• Primary DNS Server  
• Secondary DNS Server  
• Domain Name  
• Default Gateway  
• Gateway (Manual Addr.)  
Internet Fax (T.37)  
Shows the Internet Fax settings.  
• SMTP Server Address  
• E-mail Address  
• POP Server Address  
• POP Account  
• Admin. E-mail Address  
• Automatic POP  
• POP Interval  
7
• Auth.(Internet Fax TX)  
• Auth.(Internet Fax RX)  
• Internet Fax TX  
• Error Notification E-mail  
• POP Server: E-mail Recept.Set.  
• Insert System-fixed Text  
• Information about Internet Fax appears only for the Type 2 model.  
Reading the Fax Journal  
No.  
Shows the job number.  
Date/Time  
Shows the transmission start date and time for fax transmission.  
Shows the reception date and time for fax reception.  
291  
   
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
Communication Type  
Shows the following information:  
• Transmission: a fax was sent.  
• Reception: a fax was received.  
• LAN-Fax: a fax was sent by LAN-Fax.  
• Internet Fax TX: a fax was sent via Internet Fax.  
• Internet Fax RX: a fax was received via Internet Fax.  
• Forwarding: a fax was forwarded.  
Duration  
Shows the time taken for fax transmission or reception to complete.  
Sender/Destination  
For a received fax, shows the fax number registered by the sender or an e-mail address if the fax  
was received via Internet Fax.  
For a fax that was sent, shows the following information according to the transmission method:  
• If an external telephone was used: shows the fax number registered by the receiving party.  
• If a Quick Dial/Speed Dial was used: shows the name registered for the destination; if a  
name was not programmed, shows the destination's fax number.  
7
• If a fax number was input using the control panel number keys: shows the dialed fax number.  
• If the fax was sent from the computer (LAN-Fax): shows the dialed fax number.  
• If the fax was sent via Internet Fax: shows the destination e-mail address.  
No. of Pages  
Shows the number of pages transmitted or received.  
Results  
Shows the result of a fax transmission or reception. If an error occurred during the fax  
communication, shows an error code.  
Reading the TX/RX Standby File List  
No.  
Shows the job number.  
Date/Time  
Shows the date and time at which a fax was stored in memory.  
292  
   
Printing Lists/Reports  
Type  
Shows the following information:  
• Redial: sending was done by automatic redial.  
• Broadcast: sending was done by broadcast.  
• LAN-Fax: sending was done by LAN-Fax.  
• Forwarding: sending was done by forwarding.  
• Memory TX: sending was done by any other method.  
Sender/Destination  
For a received fax, shows the fax number registered by the sender or an e-mail address if the fax  
was received via Internet Fax.  
For a fax that was sent, shows the following information according to the transmission method:  
• If an external telephone was used: shows the fax number registered by the receiving party.  
• If a Quick Dial/Speed Dial was used: shows the name registered for the destination; if a  
name was not programmed, shows the destination's fax number.  
• If a fax number was input using the control panel number keys: shows the dialed fax number.  
• If the fax was sent from the computer (LAN-Fax): shows the dialed fax number.  
• If the fax was sent via Internet Fax: shows the destination e-mail address.  
7
No. of Pages  
Shows the number of pages a fax contained.  
Reading the Scanner Journal  
No.  
Shows the job number.  
Date  
Shows the date of a transmission.  
Time  
Shows the time at which a transmission was completed.  
Type  
Shows the transmission method.  
Destination  
Shows the scan destination.  
No. of Pages  
Shows the number of pages scanned.  
293  
   
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
Color B&W  
Shows whether scanning was performed in color or black and white.  
File Format  
Shows the file format.  
Results  
Shows whether the transmission successfully ended or failed.  
7
294  
Administrator Settings  
Administrator Settings  
This section describes administrator settings.  
Changing Administrator Settings  
The procedure for changing the start-up mode after power-on is provided as an example.  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
CES184  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Admin. Tools], and then press the [OK] key.  
7
3. If you are requested to enter a password, enter the password using the number keys,  
and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Function Priority], and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select the desired mode, and then press the [OK] key.  
6. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
• A password for accessing the [Admin. Tools] menu can be specified in [Admin. Tools Lock].  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
Administrator Setting Parameters  
This section describes administrator setting parameters.  
Set Date/Time  
Sets the date and time of the machine’s internal clock.  
• Set Date  
295  
         
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
Specifies the date of the machine’s internal clock.  
Only dates that correspond with the year and month can be set. Incompatible dates will be  
refused.  
Default date format:  
• Year: 2000 to 2099  
• Month: 1 to 12  
• Day: 1 to 31  
[Day/Month/Year],  
[Month/Day/Year]  
• Date format: Month/Day/Year, Day/Month/Year, or Year/Month/Day  
• Set Time  
Sets the time of the machine’s internal clock.  
Default time format:  
[24-hour Format],  
[12-hour Format]  
• Time format: 12-hour Format, 24-hour Format  
• AM/PM stamp: AM, PM (for 12-hour Format)  
• Hour: 0 to 23 (for 24-hour Format), or 1 to 12 (for 12-hour Format)  
• Minute: 0 to 59  
Program Fax Information  
Specifies the user information for sending a fax.  
• Number:  
7
Specifies the fax number of the machine using up to 20 characters, including 0 to 9, space,  
and "+".  
• Name:  
Specifies the name of the machine using up to 20 alphanumeric characters and symbols.  
Dial/Push Phone  
Specifies the line type of the telephone line.  
To configure this setting, contact your telephone company and select the setting based on your  
telephone line. Selecting a wrong setting may cause failures in fax transmissions.  
[Dial Phone (20PPS)] may not appear depending on the country setting of the machine.  
Default: [Push Phone]  
• Push Phone  
• Dial Phone (10PPS)  
• Dial Phone (20PPS)  
PSTN / PBX  
Sets the machine to connect to the public switched telephone network (PSTN) or a private branch  
exchange (PBX).  
296  
Administrator Settings  
Default: [PSTN]  
• PSTN  
• PBX  
PBX Access Number  
Specifies the dial number to access the outside line when the machine is connected to a PBX.  
Make sure that this setting matches the setting of your PBX. Otherwise, you may not be able to send  
faxes to outside destinations.  
Default: 9  
• 0 to 999  
Function Priority  
Specifies the mode that is activated when the power is turned on, or if the time specified for [System  
Auto Reset Timer] elapses without activity while the initial screen of the current mode is displayed.  
Default: [Copier]  
• Copier  
• Facsimile  
• Scanner  
System Auto Reset Timer  
7
Sets the machine to return to the initial screen of the current mode if the machine receives no input  
for a specified period of time during configuration.  
Also, if the specified period elapses while the initial screen of the current mode is displayed, the  
machine returns to the mode specified in [Function Priority].  
Default: [On] (30 seconds)  
• On (30 sec., 1 min., 2 min., 3 min., 5 min., 10 min.)  
• Off  
Energy Saver Mode  
Sets the machine to enter Energy Saver mode, Energy Saver mode 1 or Energy Saver mode 2, to  
reduce power consumption. The machine recovers from Energy Saver mode when it receives a  
print job, prints a received fax, or when the [Copy], [Color Start], or [B&W Start] key is pressed.  
• EnergySaverMode 1  
The machine enters Energy Saver mode 1 if the machine has been idle for about 30 seconds.  
It takes less time to recover from Energy Saver mode 1 than from power-off state or Energy  
Saver mode 2, but power consumption is higher in Energy Saver mode 1 than in Energy  
Saver mode 2.  
Default: [Off]  
• Off  
297  
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
• On (30 seconds)  
• EnergySaverMode 2  
The machine enters Energy Saver mode 2 after the period of time specified for this setting is  
passed. The machine consumes less power in Energy Saver mode 2 than in Energy Saver  
mode 1, but it takes longer to recover from Energy Saver mode 2 than from Energy Saver  
mode 1.  
Default: [On] (10.1minutes) Operation panel LCD will display 10 minutes  
• On (1 to 240 minutes, in 1 minute increments)  
• Off  
Language  
Specifies the language used on the screen and in reports.  
The default value for this setting is the language you have specified during the Initial Setup, which is  
required after turning on the machine for the first time.  
Country  
Selects the country in which the machine is used. The country code you specify determines the time  
and date display format and the default values of the fax transmission-related settings.  
Make sure to select the country code correctly. Selecting a wrong country code may cause failures  
in fax transmissions.  
7
The default value for this setting is the country code you have specified during the Initial Setup,  
which is required after turning on the machine for the first time.  
Reset Settings  
Be sure not to clear the settings by mistake.  
• Reset All Settings  
Resets the machine's settings to their defaults except the following: language for the screen,  
country setting, network settings, and fax Quick Dial/Speed Dial destinations.  
Press [Yes] to execute. Press [No] to exit to the previous level of the menu tree without clearing  
the settings.  
• Reset Network Settings  
Resets the network settings to their defaults.  
Press [Yes] to execute. Press [No] to exit to the previous level of the menu tree without clearing  
the settings.  
• Clear Address Book  
Clears the fax Quick Dial/Speed Dial destinations and Special Sender list.  
Press [Yes] to execute. Press [No] to exit to the previous level of the menu tree without clearing  
the destinations.  
298  
Administrator Settings  
Admin. Tools Lock  
Specifies a four-digit password for accessing the [Address Book], [Network Settings], and [Admin.  
Tools] menus.  
Do not forget this password.  
• On (0000 to 9999)  
• Off  
IPsec  
Selects whether to enable or disable IPsec.  
This function appears only when a password is specified under [Admin. Tools Lock].  
Default: [Inactive]  
• Active  
• Inactive  
Fax Number Confirmation  
Sets the machine to require a fax number to be entered twice when specifying a destination  
manually.  
This function appears only when a password is specified under [Admin. Tools Lock].  
Default: [Off]  
• On  
7
• Off  
299  
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
Printer Feature Settings  
This section describes the printer feature settings.  
• Printer feature settings are only available for the Type 2 model.  
Changing Printer Feature Settings  
The procedure for changing the setting for duplex printing is described as an example.  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
7
CES184  
2. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Printer Features], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [System], and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Duplex], and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [None], [Long Edge Bind], or [Short Edge Bind], and then  
press the [OK] key.  
6. Press the [User Tools] key to return to the initial screen.  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
Printer Feature Setting Parameters  
This section describes the printer feature setting parameters.  
List/Test Print  
Prints lists showing configurations on the machine.  
The lists will be printed using the tray set for [Printer] under [Paper Tray Priority] in system settings on  
A4 or Letter size paper.  
300  
         
Printer Feature Settings  
• Config. Page  
Prints general information and the current configurations of the machine.  
• Menu List  
Prints the machine's function menus.  
• Test Page  
Prints a test page to check the current color settings.  
• PCL Font List  
Prints installed PCL font list.  
• PS Font List  
Prints installed PostScript font list.  
System  
• Copies  
Sets the machine to print the specified number of sets.  
This setting is disabled if the number of pages to print is specified by the printer driver.  
Default: 1  
• 1 to 999, in increments of 1  
• Sub Paper Size  
7
Sets the machine to print onto paper of another size if the specified paper is not loaded in any  
tray. Alternative sizes are preset to A4 and Letter.  
Default: [Off]  
• Auto  
• Off  
• Page Size  
Specifies the paper size to be used when the paper size is not specified in the print job.  
This setting is disabled if the number of pages to print is specified by the printer driver.  
Default:  
[A4],  
[8 1/2 × 11]  
• A4, B5 JIS, A5, B6 JIS, A6, 8 1/2 × 14, 8 1/2 × 11, 5 1/2 × 8 1/2, 7 1/4 × 10  
1/2, 8 × 13, 8 1/2 x 13, 8 1/4 x 13, 16K, 4 1/8 × 9 1/2, 3 7/8 × 7 1/2, C5 Env,  
C6 Env, DL Env  
• Duplex  
Sets the machine to print on both sides of paper according to the specified binding method.  
Default: [None]  
• None  
• Long Edge Bind  
301  
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
• Short Edge Bind  
• Blank Page Print  
Sets the machine to print blank pages.  
When cover sheet printing is enabled from the printer driver, cover sheets are inserted even if  
you select [Off].  
Default: [On]  
• On  
• Off  
• B&W Page Detect  
Sets the machine to print all monochrome pages in monochrome mode even if color printing is  
specified.  
Default: [On]  
• On  
• Off  
• Print Error Report  
Sets the machine to print an error page when the machine detects a printer or memory error.  
Default: [Off]  
• On  
7
• Off  
PCL Menu  
Specifies conditions when using PCL for printing.  
• Orientation  
Specifies the page orientation.  
Default: [Portrait]  
• Portrait  
• Landscape  
• Form Lines  
Specifies the number of lines per page.  
Default:  
• 5 to 128, in increments of 1  
• Font Number  
64,  
60  
Specifies the ID of the default font you want to use.  
Default: 0  
• 0 to 89  
302  
Printer Feature Settings  
• Point Size  
Specifies the point size for the default font.  
This setting is effective only for a variable-space font.  
Default: 12.00 points  
• 4.00 to 999.75, in 0.01 increments  
• Font Pitch  
Specifies the number of characters per inch for the default font.  
This setting is effective only for fixed-space fonts.  
Default: 10.00 pitch  
• 0.44 to 99.99, in 0.01 increments  
• Symbol Set  
Specifies the character set for the default font. The following sets are available:  
Default: [PC-8]  
• Roman-8, Roman-9, ISO L1, ISO L2, ISO L5, PC-8, PC-8 D/N, PC-850, PC-852,  
PC-858, PC8-TK, Win L1, Win L2, Win L5, Desktop, PS Text, VN Intl, VN US, MS Publ,  
Math-8, PS Math, VN Math, Pifont, Legal, ISO 4, ISO 6, ISO 11, ISO 15, ISO 17, ISO  
21, ISO 60, ISO 69, Win 3.0, MC Text, ISO L6, ISO L9, PC-775, PC-1004, Win  
Baltic  
7
• Courier Font  
Specifies a courier-type font.  
Default: [Regular]  
• Regular  
• Dark  
• Ext. A4 Width  
Sets the machine to extend the width of the printable area of A4 size paper, reducing side  
margin width.  
Default: [Off]  
• On  
• Off  
• Append CR to LF  
Sets the machine to append a CR code to each LF code to print text data clearly.  
Default: [Off]  
• On  
• Off  
303  
7. Configuring the Machine Using the Control Panel  
• Resolution  
Specifies the print resolution in dots per inch.  
Default: [600 × 600 1bit]  
• 600 × 600 1bit  
• 600 × 600 2bit  
• 600 × 600 4bit  
PS Menu  
Specifies conditions when using PostScript for printing.  
• Resolution  
Specifies the print resolution in dots per inch.  
Default: [600 × 600 1bit]  
• 600 × 600 1bit  
• 600 × 600 2bit  
• 600 × 600 4bit  
• Colour Profile  
Specifies the color profile.  
Default: [Solid Colour]  
• Solid Colour  
7
• Presentation  
• Photographic  
• Off  
304  
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web  
Image Monitor  
You can check the machine's status or change its settings by accessing the machine directly using Web  
Image Monitor.  
Using Web Image Monitor  
• Some items might not appear, depending on the model type you are using.  
• Some items can also be configured using the control panel.  
Available operations  
The following operations can be performed remotely using Web Image Monitor on a computer:  
• Displaying the machine’s status or settings  
• Configuring the machine's settings  
• Registering the scan and fax destinations  
• Registering the fax Special Senders  
• Configuring the user restriction settings  
• Configuring the network settings  
8
• Configuring the IPsec settings  
• Printing reports  
• Setting the administrator password and e-mail address  
• Resetting the machine's configuration to the factory default  
• Creating backup files of the machine's configuration  
• Restoring the machine's configuration from backup files  
• Configuring the machine's date and time  
• Configuring the machine's Energy Saver mode setting  
Supported Web browsers  
• Internet Explorer 6 or later  
• Firefox 3.0 or later  
• Safari 3.0 or later  
• To operate the machine via Web Image Monitor, you must first configure the machine's TCP/IP  
settings.  
305  
     
Displaying Top Page  
Displaying Top Page  
When you access the machine using Web Image Monitor, the top page appears in your browser's  
window.  
1. Launch the Web browser.  
2. In the Web browser’s address bar, enter “http://(machine’s IP address)/” to access the  
machine.  
If a DNS or WINS server is used and the machine’s host name has been specified, you can enter  
the host name instead of the IP address.  
The top page of Web Image Monitor appears.  
Top page  
Every Web Image Monitor page is divided into the following areas:  
2
3
1
8
4
CES256  
1. Menu area  
Clicking a menu shows its contents in the main area.  
2. Tab area  
Contains tabs for switching between information and settings you want to see or configure.  
3. FAQs/Knowledge Base  
Provides answers to frequently asked questions and other useful information about using this  
machine.  
An internet connection is required to view this information.  
307  
   
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
4. Main area  
Displays the contents of the item selected in the menu area.  
Information in the main area is not automatically updated. Click [Refresh] at the upper-right in  
the main area to update the information. Click the Web browser's [Refresh] button to refresh  
the entire browser screen.  
• If you use an older version of a supported Web browser or the Web browser has JavaScript and  
cookies disabled, display and operation problems may occur.  
• If you are using a proxy server, configure the Web browser settings as necessary. For details about  
the settings, contact your network administrator.  
• The previous page may not appear even if the back button of the Web browser is clicked. If this  
happens, click the refresh button of the Web browser.  
• The FAQs (Frequently Asked Questions)/Knowledge Base are not available in certain languages.  
Changing the Interface Language  
Select the desired interface language from the [Language] list.  
8
308  
   
Checking the System Information  
Checking the System Information  
Click [Home] to display the main page of Web Image Monitor. You can check the current system  
information on this page.  
This page contains three tabs: [Status], [Counter], and [Machine Information].  
Checking the Status Information  
Click the [Status] tab on the main page to display system information, paper tray status and toner levels.  
Item  
Model Name  
Location  
Description  
Shows the name of the machine.  
8
Shows the location of the machine as registered on the [SNMP] page.  
Contact  
Shows the contact information of the machine as registered on the [SNMP]  
page.  
Host Name  
Shows the host name specified in [Host Name] on the [DNS] page.  
Shows the current messages on the machine's display.  
Device Status  
Toner  
Item  
Description  
Shows the amount of black toner remaining.  
Shows the amount of magenta toner remaining.  
Shows the amount of yellow toner remaining.  
Black  
Magenta  
Yellow  
309  
       
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
Item  
Description  
Cyan  
Shows the amount of cyan toner remaining.  
Waste Toner Bottle  
Shows the remaining life of the waste toner bottle, as "Status OK", "Almost  
Full" or "Full".  
Intermediate Transfer  
Unit  
Shows the remaining life of the transfer unit, as "Status OK", "Replacement  
Required Soon" or "Replacement Required".  
For replacing, contact your sales or service representative.  
Fusing Unit  
Shows the remaining life of the fusing unit, as "Status OK", "Replacement  
Required Soon" or "Replacement Required".  
For replacing, contact your sales or service representative.  
Transfer Roller  
Shows the remaining life of the transfer roller, as "Status OK", "Replacement  
Required Soon" or "Replacement Required".  
For replacing, contact your sales or service representative.  
Paper Tray  
Item  
Description  
Tray 1  
Shows the current state and paper size/type setting of tray 1.  
Shows the current state and paper size/type setting of tray 2.  
Shows the current state and paper size/type setting of the bypass tray.  
Tray 2  
8
Bypass Tray  
• The information about tray 2 appears only when it is installed.  
• The information about intermediate transfer unit, fusing unit, and transfer roller appear only for the  
Type 2 model.  
• If non-genuine print cartridges are installed, toner life cannot be reliably indicated.  
Checking the Counter Information  
Click the [Counter] tab on the main page to check the counter information.  
310  
   
Checking the System Information  
Page Counter  
Item  
Description  
Printer  
Shows the following for pages printed using the printer function:  
• Total number of pages  
8
• Number of color pages  
• Number of black-and-white pages  
Scanner  
Copier  
Shows the following for pages scanned using the scanner function:  
• Total number of pages  
• Number of color pages  
• Number of black-and-white pages  
Shows the following for pages printed using the copier function:  
• Total number of pages  
• Number of color pages  
• Number of black-and-white pages  
311  
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
Item  
Description  
Fax  
Shows the following for public telephone line faxes:  
• Total number of pages sent and received  
• Number of pages sent  
• Number of pages received  
Machine Counter  
Item  
Description  
Machine Counter  
Shows the following for pages printed using the printer, copier, and fax  
functions, and lists/reports:  
• Total number of pages  
• Number of color pages  
• Number of black-and-white pages  
Black  
Shows the following for pages printed using the printer, copier, and fax  
functions, and lists/reports:  
• Accumulated value of black toner A4 page coverage (in percent)  
• Accumulated value of black toner consumption (converted into fully-  
covered A4 pages)  
8
Cyan  
Shows the following for pages printed using the printer, copier, and fax  
functions, and lists/reports:  
• Accumulated value of cyan toner A4 page coverage (in percent)  
• Accumulated value of cyan toner consumption (converted into fully-  
covered A4 pages)  
Magenta  
Yellow  
Shows the following for pages printed using the printer, copier, and fax  
functions, and lists/reports:  
• Accumulated value of magenta toner A4 page coverage (in percent)  
• Accumulated value of magenta toner consumption (converted into  
fully-covered A4 pages)  
Shows the following for pages printed using the printer, copier, and fax  
functions, and lists/reports:  
• Accumulated value of yellow toner A4 page coverage (in percent)  
• Accumulated value of yellow toner consumption (converted into fully-  
covered A4 pages)  
312  
Checking the System Information  
Economy Color Prints  
Item  
Description  
Economy Color Prints  
(Color)  
Shows the number of pages printed in Economy Color Printing mode using  
the printer function.  
Black  
Shows the following for pages printed in Economy Color Printing mode  
using the printer function:  
• Accumulated value of black toner A4 page coverage (in percent)  
• Accumulated value of black toner consumption (converted into fully-  
covered A4 pages)  
Cyan  
Shows the following for pages printed in Economy Color Printing mode  
using the printer function:  
• Accumulated value of cyan toner A4 page coverage (in percent)  
• Accumulated value of cyan toner consumption (converted into fully-  
covered A4 pages)  
Magenta  
Yellow  
Shows the following for pages printed in Economy Color Printing mode  
using the printer function:  
• Accumulated value of magenta toner A4 page coverage (in percent)  
• Accumulated value of magenta toner consumption (converted into  
fully-covered A4 pages)  
8
Shows the following for pages printed in Economy Color Printing mode  
using the printer function:  
• Accumulated value of yellow toner A4 page coverage (in percent)  
• Accumulated value of yellow toner consumption (converted into fully-  
covered A4 pages)  
Duplex  
Item  
Description  
Duplex Total Page  
Shows the total number of pages printed on both sides.  
• A sheet printed on both sides counts as two printed pages.  
313  
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
Checking the Machine Information  
Click the [Machine Information] tab on the main page to display machine information.  
Machine Information  
Item  
Firmware Version  
Engine FW Version  
PCL Version  
Description  
Shows the version of firmware installed on the machine.  
Shows the version of firmware for the machine engine.  
Shows the version of the PCL interpreter.  
PS Version  
Shows the version of the PS interpreter.  
8
Machine ID  
Shows the serial number of the machine.  
Fax Card  
Shows whether or not the fax card is installed.  
Shows the total memory installed on the machine.  
Total Memory  
• Information about PCL and PS appear only for the Type 2 model.  
314  
   
Configuring the System Settings  
Configuring the System Settings  
Click [System Settings] to display the page for configuring the system settings.  
This page contains the following tabs: [Sound Volume Adjustment], [Tray Paper Settings], [Copier],  
[Fax], [Priority Tray], [Toner Saving], [I/O Timeout], and [B&W Print Priority].  
Configuring the Sound Volume  
Click the [Sound Volume Adjustment] tab on the system settings page to configure the sound volume  
settings.  
Sound Volume Adjustment  
Item  
Description  
8
Panel Key Sound  
Select the volume of the beep that sounds when a key is pressed from [Off],  
[Low], [Middle], or [High].  
Ring Volume  
Select the volume of the ring when a call is received from [Off], [Low],  
[Middle], or [High].  
On Hook Mode  
Job End Tone  
Job Error Tone  
Alarm Volume  
Select the volume of the sound from the speaker during on hook mode from  
[Off], [Low], [Middle], or [High].  
Select the volume of the beep that sounds when a job is complete from  
[Off], [Low], [Middle], or [High].  
Select the volume of the beep that sounds when a fax transmission error  
occurs from [Off], [Low], [Middle], or [High].  
Select the volume of the alarm that sounds when an operation error occurs  
from [Off], [Low], [Middle], or [High].  
315  
       
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
Configuring the Paper Settings  
Click the [Tray Paper Settings] tab on the system settings page to configure the paper settings.  
Tray 1  
Item  
Paper Size  
Description  
Select the paper size for tray 1 from the following:  
A4, B5 JIS, A5, B6 JIS, A6, 8 1/2 × 14, 8 1/2 × 11, 5 1/2 × 8 1/2, 7  
1/4 × 10 1/2, 8 × 13, 8 1/2 × 13, 8 1/4 × 13, 16K, 4 1/8 × 9 1/2, 3  
7/8 × 7 1/2, C5 Env, C6 Env, DL Env, Custom Size  
Paper Type  
Select the paper type for tray 1 from the following:  
Thin Paper (60-65g/m2), Plain Paper (66-74g/m2), Middle Thick Paper  
(75-90g/m2), Thick Paper 1 (91-105g/m2), Recycled Paper, Color  
Paper, Letterhead, Preprinted Paper, Prepunched Paper, Label Paper, Bond  
Paper, Cardstock, Envelope, Thick Paper 2 (106-160g/m2)  
8
Tray 2  
Item  
Description  
Paper Size  
Select the paper size for tray 2 from the following:  
A4, 8 1/2 × 11  
Paper Type  
Select the paper type for tray 2 from the following:  
Thin Paper (60-65g/m2), Plain Paper (66-74g/m2), Middle Thick Paper  
(75-90g/m2), Thick Paper 1 (91-105g/m2), Recycled Paper, Color  
Paper, Letterhead, Preprinted Paper, Prepunched Paper  
316  
   
Configuring the System Settings  
Bypass Tray  
Item  
Description  
Paper Size  
Select the paper size for the bypass tray from the following:  
A4, B5 JIS, A5, B6 JIS, A6, 8 1/2 × 14, 8 1/2 × 11, 5 1/2 × 8 1/2, 7  
1/4 × 10 1/2, 8 × 13, 8 1/2 × 13, 8 1/4 × 13, 16K, 4 1/8 × 9 1/2, 3  
7/8 × 7 1/2, C5 Env, C6 Env, DL Env, Custom Size  
Paper Type  
Select the paper type for the bypass tray from the following:  
Thin Paper (60-65g/m2), Plain Paper (66-74g/m2), Middle Thick Paper  
(75-90g/m2), Thick Paper 1 (91-105g/m2), Recycled Paper, Color  
Paper, Letterhead, Prepunched Paper, Label Paper, Bond Paper,  
Cardstock, Envelope, Thick Paper 2 (106-160g/m2)  
Bypass Tray Setting Priority  
Item  
Description  
Bypass Tray Setting  
Priority  
Select how print jobs using the bypass tray are handled.  
• System Settings  
The machine prints all print jobs according to the machine’s settings.  
An error will occur if the paper size/type settings of the machine and  
printer driver do not match.  
• Any Size/Type  
8
The machine prints all print jobs according to the printer driver’s  
settings.  
Printing proceeds even if the paper size/type settings of the machine  
and printer driver do not match, but if the paper is too small for the  
print job, the printed image will be cropped.  
• Any Custom Size/Type  
The machine prints custom size print jobs according to the printer  
driver’s settings and prints standard size print jobs according to the  
machine’s settings.  
For custom size print jobs, printing proceeds even if the paper size/  
type settings of the machine and printer driver do not match, but if the  
paper is too small for the print job, the printed image will be cropped.  
For standard size print jobs, an error will occur if the paper size/type  
settings of the machine and printer driver do not match.  
317  
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
• The information about tray 2 appears only when it is installed.  
Specifying the Size of Paper for Printing Copies  
Click the [Copier] tab on the system settings page to specify the size of paper for printing copies.  
Select Paper  
Item  
Select Paper  
Description  
Select the paper size used for printing copies from the following: [Tray 1],  
[Tray 2], [Bypass Tray], [A4], or [8 1/2 × 11].  
When a tray is selected, the machine prints from that tray only. When a  
paper size is selected, the machine prints from the tray that contains the  
paper of the specified size, except the bypass tray. If tray 1 and tray 2 both  
contain the paper of the specified size, the machine starts to print from the  
tray specified as the priority tray for [Copier] in the [Priority Tray] page. If  
that tray runs out of paper, the machine automatically switches to the other  
tray to continue printing.  
8
• If tray 2 is not installed, only [Tray 1] and [Bypass Tray] appear.  
Configuring the Fax Settings  
Click the [Fax] tab on the system settings page to configure the fax settings.  
318  
       
Configuring the System Settings  
Select Paper Tray  
Item  
Description  
Select Paper Tray  
Select the tray for printing faxes from the following: [Auto], [Tray 1], or  
[Tray 2].  
If [Auto] is selected, the machine uses tray 1 and tray 2 if they contain  
paper of the same size. In this case, the machine starts to print from the tray  
specified as the priority tray for [Fax] in the [Priority Tray] page. If that tray  
runs out of paper, the machine automatically switches to the other tray to  
continue printing.  
Only A4, Letter, or Legal size paper can be used for printing faxes. Make  
sure to select a tray that contains paper of the valid size.  
8
If tray 2 is not installed, only [Tray 1] appears.  
Fax Number Confirmation  
Item  
Description  
Fax Number  
Confirmation  
Enable this setting to configure the machine to require a fax number to be  
entered twice when specifying a destination manually.  
This setting appears only when the administrator password is set in the  
[Administrator] page.  
Fax Received File Processing  
Item  
Description  
Received File  
Processing  
Select whether received faxes are stored into the machine’s memory for  
printing or forwarded to a destination specified for [Forwarding  
Destination].  
319  
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
Item  
Description  
Print Automatically  
Select whether the faxes received into the machine’s memory are printed  
automatically or stored for later manual printing.  
Print Forwarded File  
Notify Forward Status  
Select whether the forwarded faxes are printed or not.  
Select whether e-mail notifications are sent after forwarding faxes or not. E-  
mail notification destination depends on how [Forwarding Destination] is  
specified:  
• If specified with [E-mail Address]: the notification will be sent to the  
administrator e-mail address specified in [Administrator E-mail  
Address] in the [Administrator] page.  
• If specified with [Scan Destination]: the notification will be sent to the  
notification destination specified for the selected scan destination.  
Note that if a destination e-mail address is not specified, no notification will  
be sent even if this setting is enabled.  
Forwarding Destination Specifies the forwarding destination.  
• [E-mail Address]: Enter a destination e-mail address. Can contain up  
to 64 characters.  
• [Scan Destination]: Select a scan destination as a forwarding  
destination.  
8
Number of Trials of  
Forwarding (time)  
Specifies how many times the machine attempts to forward a fax (1 to 255  
times).  
Interval of Forwarding  
Trial (min.)  
Specifies how many minutes the machine waits between forwarding  
attempts (1 to 255 minutes).  
Authorized Reception  
Item  
Description  
Authorized Reception  
Enable this setting to set the machine to receive (or reject) faxes only from  
the programmed Special Senders. This helps you screen out unwanted  
documents, such as junk faxes, and prevents the wasting of fax paper.  
Special Senders can be programmed in the [Special Sender] page.  
320  
Configuring the System Settings  
Item  
Description  
Receive Conditions  
Specifies whether to receive or reject faxes from the programmed Special  
Senders.  
• Special Sender  
Receive faxes from the Special Senders and reject faxes from all other  
senders.  
• Other Than Special Sender  
Reject faxes from the Special Senders and receive faxes from all other  
senders.  
• [Fax Received File Processing] appears only for the Type 2 model.  
Specifying the Priority Tray  
8
Click the [Priority Tray] tab on the system settings page to specify the priority tray.  
321  
   
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
Priority Tray  
Item  
Description  
Printer  
Copier  
Fax  
Select the tray that the machine uses first for printer jobs from tray 1 or tray  
2.  
If automatic tray selection is specified for the print job and both tray 1 and  
tray 2 contain paper that matches the print job, the machine starts to print  
from the specified tray. If that tray runs out of paper, the machine  
automatically switches to the other tray to continue printing.  
Select the tray that the machine uses first for printing out copies from tray 1  
or tray 2.  
If [A4] or [8 1/2 × 11] is selected for [Select Paper] in the [Copier] page  
and both tray 1 and tray 2 contain paper of that size, the machine starts to  
print from the specified tray. If that tray runs out of paper, the machine  
automatically switches to the other tray to continue printing.  
Select the tray that the machine uses first for printing out faxes from tray 1 or  
tray 2.  
If [Auto] is selected for [Select Paper Tray] in the [Fax] page and both tray  
1 and tray 2 contain paper of the same size, the machine starts to print from  
the specified tray. If that tray runs out of paper, the machine automatically  
switches to the other tray to continue printing.  
8
• If tray 2 is not installed, only [Tray 1] appears.  
Configuring the Toner Saving Setting  
Click the [Toner Saving] tab on the system settings page to configure the toner saving setting.  
322  
   
Configuring the System Settings  
Toner Saving  
Item  
Description  
Toner Saving  
Enable this setting to print using a reduced amount of toner when printing  
out copies.  
Configuring the I/O Timeout Settings  
Click the [I/O Timeout] tab on the system settings page to configure the I/O timeout settings.  
8
I/O Timeout  
Item  
Description  
Fixed USB Port  
Specifies whether the same printer/LAN-Fax driver can be used for multiple  
machines or not under USB connection.  
If this setting is enabled, the same printer/LAN-Fax driver you have  
installed in your computer can be used with any machine other than the one  
originally used for installation, if the machine is of the same model.  
If disabled, you must install the printer/LAN-Fax driver separately for  
individual machines, because the machine other than the original will be  
recognized as a new device upon USB connection.  
323  
   
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
Item  
Description  
Locked Print Timeout  
(seconds)  
Specifies how many seconds the machine holds a new Locked Print file,  
when the machine cannot store any more Locked Print files (0 to 300  
seconds). Within this time, you can print or delete the new Locked Print file.  
You can also print or delete an existing Locked Print file so that the new  
Locked Print file can be stored in the machine.  
• [Locked Print Timeout (seconds)] appears only for the Type 2 model.  
Configuring the Black-and-White Print Priority Settings  
Click the [B&W Print Priority] tab on the system settings page to configure the black-and-white print  
priority settings.  
8
B&W Print Priority  
Item  
Description  
B&W Print Priority  
Enable this setting to suppress the consumption of color toner when printing  
black-and-white pages. Also, amount of color toner consumed during  
warm-up time for maintenance will also be lowered.  
324  
   
Registering Destinations  
Registering Destinations  
Scan and fax destinations can be registered using Web Image Monitor.  
A maximum of 100 scan destinations and 200 fax destinations can be registered. See the scan and fax  
sections for more information on registering destinations.  
8
325  
   
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
Registering Fax Special Senders  
Fax Special Senders can be registered using Web Image Monitor.  
A maximum of 30 Special Senders be registered.  
8
326  
   
Restricting Machine Functions According to User  
Restricting Machine Functions According to  
User  
You can set the machine to require a user code when someone tries to use certain machine functions.  
• This function is available for the Type 2 model only.  
• When print jobs are restricted, you can only authenticate through the PCL printer driver. Printing  
from the PostScript 3 printer driver will not be possible.  
Using Web Image Monitor, enable user restriction for all or some of the functions listed below, and then  
register users who can use those functions.  
• Copying (both color and black-and-white)  
• Color copying  
• Sending faxes  
• Scan to E-mail/FTP/Folder  
• Scan to USB  
• PictBridge printing  
• Printing (both color and black-and-white)  
• Color printing  
• Sending faxes via LAN-Fax  
8
For each user, you can specify which functions are available upon authentication. A maximum of 30  
users can be registered.  
327  
   
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
Configuring the Network Settings  
Click [Network Settings] to display the page for configuring the network settings.  
This page contains the following tabs: [Network Status], [IPv6 Configuration], [Network Application],  
[DNS], [Auto E-mail Notification], [SNMP], [SMTP], [POP3], and [Internet Fax].  
Checking the Network Status  
Click the [Network Status] tab on the network settings page to display network information.  
General Status  
Item  
Description  
8
Ethernet Speed  
IPP Printer Name  
Network Version  
Shows the type and speed of the network connection.  
Shows the name used to identify the machine on the network.  
Shows the version of the machine's network module (a part of the machine  
firmware).  
MAC Address  
Shows the MAC address of the machine.  
TCP/IP Status  
Item  
Description  
DHCP  
Select whether the machine should receive a dynamic IPv4 address  
automatically using DHCP. To use DHCP, select [Active]. When enabled,  
the items below cannot be configured.  
Enter the IPv4 address for the machine.  
Enter the subnet mask of the network.  
IP Address  
Subnet Mask  
328  
       
Configuring the Network Settings  
Item  
Description  
Gateway  
Enter the IPv4 address of the network gateway.  
Configuring the IPv6 Settings  
Click the [IPv6 Configuration] tab on the network settings page to configure the IPv6 settings.  
IPv6  
Item  
Description  
IPv6  
Select whether to enable or disable IPv6. You cannot disable IPv6 using  
Web Image Monitor if the machine is currently in use in an IPv6  
environment. In this case, use the control panel to disable [IPv6] under  
network settings.  
8
When disabled, [DHCP], [Manual Configuration Address], [Prefix Length],  
and [Gateway Address] below cannot be configured.  
IPv6 Address  
Item  
Description  
DHCP  
Select whether or not the machine obtains its IPv6 address from a DHCP  
server. To specify the machine's IPv6 address manually, select [Inactive]  
and enter the machine's IPv6 address in [Manual Configuration Address].  
IP Address (DHCP)  
Displays the IPv6 address obtained from the DHCP server when [DHCP] is  
set to [Active].  
Stateless Address  
Gateway Address  
Displays up to four stateless auto addresses.  
Displays the machine's default gateway address.  
329  
   
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
Item  
Description  
Link-local Address  
Displays the link local address of the machine. The link local address is an  
address that is valid only inside the local network (local segment).  
Manual Configuration  
Address  
Enter the machine's IPv6 address. Can contain up to 39 characters.  
Prefix Length  
Enter the prefix length, using a value between 0 and 128.  
Gateway Address  
Enter the default gateway's IPv6 address. Can contain up to 39 characters.  
Configuring the Network Application Settings  
Click the [Network Application] tab on the network settings page to configure the network application  
settings.  
8
Scanner Send Setting  
Item  
Description  
E-mail  
Select to enable the Scan to E-mail feature.  
Max. E-mail Size  
Select the maximum size of scan files that can be attached to an e-mail  
message (1 to 5 MB, or no limit).  
FTP  
Select to enable the Scan to FTP feature.  
Select to enable the Scan to Folder feature.  
Folder  
330  
   
Configuring the Network Settings  
Network Print Setting  
Item  
Description  
IPP  
Select to enable network printing using Internet Print Protocol (via TCP port  
631/80).  
FTP  
Select to enable network printing using an embedded FTP server in the  
machine (via TCP port 20/21).  
RAW  
Select to enable network raw printing.  
Port No.  
Enter the TCP port number to use for raw printing. The valid range is 1024  
to 65535, except 53550 (default is 9100).  
LPR  
Select to enable network printing using LPR/LPD (via TCP port 515).  
mDNS Setting  
Item  
Description  
mDNS  
Select to enable Multicast DNS (via UDP port 5353). If disabled, the item  
below cannot be configured.  
Printer Name  
Enter the name of the machine. Can contain up to 32 characters.  
Configuring the DNS Settings  
8
Click the [DNS] tab on the network settings page to configure the DNS settings.  
331  
   
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
DNS  
Item  
Description  
DNS Method  
Select whether to specify domain name servers manually or receive DNS  
information from the network automatically. When set to [Auto-Obtain  
(DHCP)], [Primary DNS Server], [Secondary DNS Server], and [Domain  
Name] below become unavailable.  
Primary DNS Server  
Enter the IPv4 address of the primary DNS.  
Secondary DNS Server Enter the IPv4 address of the secondary DNS.  
Domain Name  
Enter the IPv4 domain name for the machine. Can contain up to 32  
characters.  
IPv6 DNS Method  
Select whether to specify the domain server manually or have the machine  
obtain its DNS information automatically.  
When set to [Auto], [Primary IPv6 DNS Server], [Secondary IPv6 DNS  
Server], and [IPv6 Domain Name] below become unavailable.  
Primary IPv6 DNS  
Server  
Enter the IPv6 address of the primary IPv6 DNS server. Can contain up to  
39 characters.  
Secondary IPv6 DNS  
Server  
Enter the IPv6 address of the secondary IPv6 DNS server. Can contain up  
to 39 characters.  
8
IPv6 Domain Name  
Enter the IPv6 domain name of the machine. Can contain up to 32  
characters.  
DNS Resolve Priority  
Select whether to give priority to IPv4 or IPv6 for DNS name resolution.  
DNS Timeout (seconds) Enter the number of seconds the machine waits before considering a DNS  
request to have timed out (1 to 999 seconds).  
Host Name  
Enter a host name for the machine. Can contain up to 15 characters.  
Configuring the Auto E-mail Notification Settings  
Click the [Auto E-mail Notification] tab on the network settings page to configure the e-mail notification  
settings.  
332  
   
Configuring the Network Settings  
E-mail Notification 1/E-mail Notification 2  
Item  
Description  
Display Name  
Enter a sender name for notification e-mail. Can contain up to 32  
characters.  
E-mail Address  
Enter the address of the recipient of the alert email. Can contain up to 64  
characters.  
Paper Misfeed  
Out of Paper  
Select to send an alert e-mail to the specified address if a paper jam occurs.  
Select to send an alert e-mail to the specified address if paper runs out.  
Select to send an alert e-mail to the specified address if toner becomes low.  
Toner Almost Empty  
Call Service  
Select to send an alert e-mail to the specified address if the machine  
requires servicing.  
8
Out of Toner  
Cover Open  
Select to send an alert e-mail to the specified address if toner runs out.  
Select to send an alert e-mail to the specified address if a cover is open.  
Configuring the SNMP Settings  
Click the [SNMP] tab on the network settings page to configure the SNMP settings.  
333  
   
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
SNMP  
Item  
Description  
SNMP  
Select whether to enable the machine to use SNMP services.  
Trap  
Item  
Description  
Target Trap  
Select whether to enable the machine to send traps to the management host  
(NMS).  
When disabled, [SNMP Management Host 1] and [SNMP Management  
Host 2] below become unavailable.  
SNMP Management  
Host 1  
Enter the IP address or host name of a management host. Can contain up to  
64 characters.  
8
SNMP Management  
Host 2  
Enter the IP address or host name of a management host. Can contain up to  
64 characters.  
Community  
Item  
Description  
Get Community  
Enter the community name to use for authentication of Get requests. Can  
contain up to 32 characters.  
Trap Community  
Enter the community name to use for authentication of Trap requests. Can  
contain up to 32 characters.  
System  
Item  
Description  
Location  
Enter the location of the machine. The location entered here is displayed on  
the main page. Can contain up to 64 characters.  
334  
Configuring the Network Settings  
Item  
Description  
Contact  
Enter the contact information of the machine. The contact information  
entered here is displayed on the main page. Can contain up to 64  
characters.  
Configuring the SMTP Settings  
Click the [SMTP] tab on the network settings page to configure the SMTP settings.  
SMTP  
Item  
Description  
Primary SMTP Server  
Enter the IP address or host name of the SMTP/POP3 server. Can contain  
up to 64 characters.  
8
Port No.  
Enter the port number for SMTP (1 to 65535).  
Authentication Method Select an authentication method from the following:  
[Anonymous]: The user name and password are not necessary.  
[SMTP]: The machine supports NTLM and LOGIN authentication.  
[POP before SMTP]: The POP3 server is used for authentication. When  
sending e-mails to an SMTP server, you can enhance the SMTP server  
security level by connecting to the POP server for authentication.  
User Name  
Password  
Enter the user name for logging in to the SMTP server. Can contain up to 32  
characters.  
Enter the password for logging in to the SMTP server. Can contain up to 32  
characters.  
335  
   
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
Item  
Description  
Device E-mail Address Enter the machine’s e-mail address.  
This address is used as the sender's address of e-mail messages sent from  
this machine, such as notification e-mails and Internet Faxes. Can contain  
up to 64 characters.  
Server Timeout  
(seconds)  
Enter the number of seconds the machine waits before considering an  
SMTP operation to have timed out (1 to 999).  
Time Zone  
Select a time zone according to your geographic location. Selecting a  
different time zone may cause transmission date and time to be incorrect for  
email sent by the Scan to E-mail function, even when the machine's clock is  
set correctly.  
Configuring the POP3 Settings  
Click the [POP3] tab on the network settings page to configure the POP3 settings.  
8
POP3 Settings  
Item  
POP3 Server  
Description  
Enter the IP address or host name of the POP3 server for e-mail reception.  
The POP3 server specified here will be used for [POP before SMTP]. Can  
contain up to 64 characters.  
User Account  
Enter the user name for logging in to the POP3 server. Can contain up to 32  
characters.  
If an e-mail address is entered here, the address will be used as the e-mail  
address for receiving Internet Faxes.  
User Password  
Enter the password for logging in to the POP3 server. Can contain up to 32  
characters.  
336  
   
Configuring the Network Settings  
Item  
Description  
Authentication  
Select an authentication method from the following:  
[None]: Password will not be encrypted.  
[APOP Authentication]: Password will be encrypted.  
[Auto]: Password will be encrypted or not encrypted according to the POP3  
server’s settings.  
Configuring the Internet Fax Settings  
Click the [Internet Fax] tab on the network settings page to configure the Internet Fax settings.  
Internet Fax Settings  
Item  
Description  
8
Internet Fax  
Select whether to enable or disable the Internet Fax function.  
Transmission  
Error Notification E-  
mail  
Select whether to send a notification e-mail to the sender of the Internet Fax  
or not when e-mail reception fails.  
The text will include the machine's host name (as set in the DNS settings  
page), model name, and contact e-mail address (as set in the administrator  
settings page).  
Insert System-fixed Text Select whether to include system-fixed text in the body of the e-mail or not  
when sending Internet Faxes.  
The text will include the machine's host name (as set in the DNS settings  
page), model name, and contact e-mail address (as set in the administrator  
settings page).  
Automatic POP  
Select whether to automatically connect to the POP3 server to check for  
new e-mails or not. If this setting is enabled, the connection will be made at  
an interval specified in [POP Interval (minutes)].  
337  
   
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
Item  
Description  
POP Server: E-mail  
Reception Setting  
Select whether to leave or delete e-mails in the POP3 server after receiving  
them.  
[No]: Delete e-mails from the server after receiving them.  
[Save E-mail]: Leave e-mails on the server after receiving them.  
[Save Only Error Info]: Delete e-mails that are successfully received from  
the server only.  
POP Interval (minutes)  
Specifies how many minutes the machine waits between automatic  
connections to the POP3 server to acquire new e-mails (2 to 1440  
minutes).  
8
338  
Configuring the IPsec Settings  
Configuring the IPsec Settings  
Click [IPsec Settings] to display the page for configuring the IPsec settings.  
This page contains the following tabs: [IPsec Global Settings] and [IPsec Policy List].  
• This function is available only when an administrator password is specified.  
Configuring the IPsec Global Settings  
Click the [IPsec Global Settings] tab on the IPsec settings page to configure the IPsec global settings.  
Item  
IPsec Function  
Default Policy  
Description  
Select whether to enable or disable IPsec.  
Select whether to allow for the default IPsec policy.  
8
Broadcast and  
Multicast Bypass  
Select the services that you do not want to apply IPsec from the following:  
[DHCPv4], [DHCPv6], [SNMP], [mDNS], [NetBIOS], [UDP Port 53550]  
All ICMP Bypass  
Select whether to apply IPsec to ICMP packets (IPv4 and IPv6) from the  
following:  
[Active]: All ICMP packets will be bypassed without IPsec protection.  
"ping" command (echo request and echo reply) is not encapsulated by  
IPsec.  
[Inactive]: Some ICMP message types will be bypassed without IPsec  
protection.  
339  
       
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
• For details about which ICMP message types will be bypassed when setting [All ICMP Bypass] to  
[Inactive], see Web Image Monitor Help.  
Configuring the IPsec Policy  
Click the [IPsec Policy List] tab on the IP security settings page to display the list of registered IPsec  
policies.  
Item  
Description  
No.  
IPsec policy number.  
Name  
Displays the name of the IPsec policy.  
Address Settings  
Displays the IP address filter of the IPsec policy as below:  
Remote address/Prefix length  
8
Action  
Status  
Displays the action of the IPsec policy as "Allow", "Drop", or "Require  
Security".  
Displays the status of the IPsec policy as "Active" or "Inactive".  
To configure IPsec policies, select the desired IPsec policy, and then click [Change] to open the "IPsec  
Policy Settings" page. The following settings can be made on the "IPsec Policy Settings" page.  
340  
   
Configuring the IPsec Settings  
IP Policy Settings  
Item  
Description  
No.  
Specify a number between 1 and 10 for the IPsec policy. The number you  
specify will determine the position of the policy in the IPsec Policy List. Policy  
searching is performed according to the order of the list. If the number you  
specify is already assigned to another policy, the policy you are  
configuring will take the number of the earlier policy, and the earlier policy  
and any subsequent policies will be renumbered accordingly.  
8
Activity  
Select whether to enable or disable the policy.  
Name  
Enter the name of the policy. Can contain up to 16 characters.  
Address Type  
Select IPv4 or IPv6 as the type of IP address to be used in IPsec  
communication.  
Local Address  
Displays the IP address of this printer.  
Remote Address  
Enter the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the device with which to communicate.  
Can contain up to 39 characters.  
Prefix Length  
Enter the prefix length of the Remote Address, using a value between 1 and  
128. If this setting is left blank, "32" (IPv4) or "128" (IPv6) will be  
automatically selected.  
341  
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
Item  
Description  
Action  
Specify how the IP packets are processed from the following:  
• [Allow]: IP packets are both sent and received without IPsec applied to  
them.  
• [Drop]: IP packets are discarded.  
• [Require Security]: IPsec is applied to IP packets that are both sent and  
received.  
If you have selected [Require Security], you must configure [IPsec Settings]  
and [IKE Settings].  
IPsec Settings  
Item  
Description  
Encapsulation Type  
Specify the encapsulation type from the following:  
• [Transport]: Select this mode to secure only the payload section of  
each IP packet when communicating with IPsec compliant devices.  
• [Tunnel]: Select this mode to secure every section of each IP packet.  
We recommend this type for communication between security  
gateways (such as VPN devices).  
Security Protocol  
Select the security protocol from the following:  
8
• [AH]: Establishes secure communication that supports authentication  
only.  
• [ESP]: Establishes secure communication that supports both  
authentication and data encryption.  
• [ESP&AH]: Establishes secure communication that supports both data  
encryption and authentication of packets, including packet headers.  
Note that you cannot specify this protocol when [Tunnel] is selected  
for [Encapsulation Type].  
Authentication  
Algorithm for AH  
Specify the authentication algorithm to be applied when [AH] or [ESP&AH]  
is selected for [Security Protocol] from the following:  
[MD5], [SHA1]  
Encryption Algorithm  
for ESP  
Specify the encryption algorithm to be applied when [ESP] or [ESP&AH] is  
selected for [Security Protocol] from the following:  
[None], [DES], [3DES], [AES-128], [AES-192], [AES-256]  
342  
Configuring the IPsec Settings  
Item  
Description  
Authentication  
Algorithm for ESP  
Specify the authentication algorithm to be applied when [ESP] is selected  
for [Security Protocol] from the following:  
[MD5], [SHA1]  
Life Time  
Specify the life time of the IPsec SA (Security Association) as a time period  
or data volume. The SA will expire when the time period you specify  
elapses or the volume of data you specify reaches the volume carried.  
If you specify both a time period and a data volume, the SA will expire as  
soon as either is reached, and a new SA will then be obtained by  
negotiation.  
To specify the life time of the SA as a time period, enter a number of  
seconds.  
To specify the life time of the SA as a data volume, enter a number of KBs.  
Key Perfect Forward  
Secrecy  
Select whether to enable or disable PFS (Perfect Forward Secrecy).  
IKE Settings  
Item  
Description  
IKE Version  
Displays the IKE version.  
8
Encryption Algorithm  
Specify the encryption algorithm from the following:  
[DES], [3DES], [AES-128], [AES-192], [AES-256]  
Authentication  
Algorithm  
Specify the authentication algorithm from the following:  
[MD5], [SHA1]  
IKE Life Time  
Specify the life time of the ISAKMP SA as a time period. Enter a number of  
seconds.  
IKE Diffie-Hellman  
Group  
Select the IKE Diffie-Hellman Group to be used in the generation of the IKE  
encryption key from the following:  
[DH1], [DH2]  
Pre-Shared Key  
Specify the PSK (Pre-Shared Key) to be used for authentication of a  
communicating device. Can contain up to 32 characters.  
Key Perfect Forward  
Secrecy  
Select whether to enable or disable PFS (Perfect Forward Secrecy).  
343  
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
8
344  
Printing Lists/Reports  
Printing Lists/Reports  
Click [Print List/Report] to display the page for printing reports. Then, select an item and click [Print] to  
print out information for that item.  
Print List/Report  
Item  
Configuration Page  
Fax Journal  
Description  
Prints general information about the machine and its current configuration.  
Prints a fax transmission and reception journal for the last 50 jobs.  
Fax TX/RX Standby File Prints a list of fax jobs remaining in the machine's memory to be printed,  
List sent, or forwarded.  
8
Quick Dial Destination Prints a list of Quick Dial entries.  
List  
Fax Speed Dial  
Destination List  
Prints a list of Speed Dial entries.  
Scanner Destination List Prints a list of scan destinations.  
Scanner Journal  
Prints a scanner journal for the last 100 Scan to E-mail, Scan to FTP, and  
Scan to Folder transmissions.  
Maintenance Page  
Prints the maintenance page.  
• Reports cannot be printed via Web Image Monitor if other jobs are printing. Before printing  
reports, confirm that machine is not printing.  
• Reports will be printed using the tray set as the priority tray for the fax function.  
345  
   
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
• Reports will be printed on A4 or Letter size paper. Load one of these sizes of paper into the tray  
before printing reports.  
8
346  
Configuring the Administrator Settings  
Configuring the Administrator Settings  
Click [Administrator Tools] to display the page for configuring the administrator settings.  
This page contains the following tabs: [Administrator], [Reset Settings], [Backup Setting], [Restore  
Setting], [Set Date/Time], and [Energy Saver Mode].  
Configuring the Administrator Password and E-mail Address  
Click the [Administrator] tab on the administrator settings page to configure the administrator password  
and e-mail address.  
Administrator Settings  
Item  
Description  
8
Change Password  
New Password  
Check this to configure the administrator password.  
Enter the new administrator password. Can contain up to 16 characters.  
Confirm New Password Enter the same password again, to confirm.  
Change E-mail Address Check this to configure the administrator e-mail address.  
Administrator E-mail  
Address  
Enter the administrator e-mail address.  
If the machine’s e-mail address is not configured in the [SMTP] page, this  
address will be used as the sender's address of e-mails sent from this  
machine, such as notification e-mails and Internet Faxes. Can contain up to  
64 characters.  
• Administrator e-mail address can only be configured with the Type 2 model.  
347  
       
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
Resetting the Machine’s Settings  
Click the [Reset Settings] tab on the administrator settings page to reset the machine's settings.  
Reset Settings  
Item  
Description  
Reset Network Settings Select to restore network settings to their defaults.  
Reset Menu Settings  
Select to restore settings that are not related to the network to their defaults.  
8
Clear Scan Destination Select to clear the scan destinations.  
Reset Settings of  
Select to clear the user restriction settings.  
Available Functions  
Clear Address Book  
Reset IPsec Settings  
Select to clear the fax destinations and Special Sender list.  
Select to clear the IPsec settings.  
• [Reset IPsec Settings] appears only when a password is specified in [Administrator Password].  
Backing Up the Machine's Settings  
Click the [Backup Setting] tab on the administrator settings page to create backup files containing the  
machine's configuration settings. If necessary, these backup files can be used to restore previous  
configurations.  
348  
       
Configuring the Administrator Settings  
• When sending the machine for repair, it is important that you create backup files in advance. The  
machine's settings are returned to the default after repair.  
Backup Setting  
Item  
Description  
Back up Network  
Settings  
Backs up settings configured under the [Network Settings] and  
[Administrator Tools].  
Note that, however, [Max. E-mail Size] setting under [Network  
Application] will not be backed up here; it will be backed up by [Back up  
Menu Settings] instead.  
Back up Menu Settings Backs up settings that are not related to the network.  
8
Back up Scan  
Destination  
Backs up scan destinations to a file.  
Back up Settings of  
Available Functions  
Backs up user restriction settings to a file.  
Back up Address Book Backs up fax destinations and Special Sender list to a file.  
Back up IPsec Settings Backs up the IPsec settings to a file.  
Follow the procedure below to create configuration backup files.  
1. Select the radio button for the type of data you wish to back up.  
2. Enter the administrator password if required.  
3. Click [OK].  
4. Click [Save] in the confirmation dialog box.  
5. Navigate to the location to save the backup file.  
6. Specify a name for the file, and click [Save].  
349  
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
• [Back up IPsec Settings] appears only when a password is specified in [Administrator Password].  
Restoring the Machine's Settings from a Backup File  
Click the [Restore Setting] tab on the administrator settings page to restore the machine's settings from a  
previously created backup file.  
• When the machine is returned from repair, it is important that you restore the machine's settings  
from the backup files. The machine's settings are returned to the default after repair.  
Restore Setting  
8
Item  
Description  
File to Restore  
Enter the path and name of the file to restore, or click [Browse] to select the  
file.  
Follow the procedure below to restore configuration backup files.  
1. Click [Browse].  
2. Navigate to the directory containing the backup file to restore.  
3. Select the backup file, and click [Open].  
4. Enter the administrator password if required.  
5. Click [OK].  
• If the settings are not restored successfully, an error message appears. Try again to restore the file  
completely.  
350  
   
Configuring the Administrator Settings  
Configuring the Date and Time Settings  
Click the [Set Date/Time] tab on the administrator settings page to configure the date and time settings.  
Set Date  
Item  
Description  
Enter the current year (2000 to 2099).  
Year  
Month  
Day  
Enter the current month (1 to 12).  
Enter the current day (1 to 31).  
Date Format  
Select the date format from [MM/DD/YYYY], [DD/MM/YYYY], or  
[YYYY/MM/DD].  
8
Set Time  
Item  
Description  
Time Format  
Time (AM/PM)  
hour (0-23)  
hour (1-12)  
min. (0-59)  
Select 24- or 12-hour time format.  
Select [AM] or [PM] if 12-hour time format is selected.  
Enter the current hour if 24-hour time format is selected (0-23).  
Enter the current hour if 12-hour time format is selected (1-12).  
Enter the current minute (0-59).  
Configuring the Energy Saver Mode Settings  
Click the [Energy Saver Mode] tab on the administrator settings page to set the machine to enter Energy  
Saver mode, Energy Saver mode 1 or Energy Saver mode 2, to reduce power consumption.  
351  
       
8. Configuring the Machine Using Web Image Monitor  
Energy Saver Mode  
Item  
Description  
Energy Saver Mode 1  
Select [Active] to set the machine to enter Energy Saver mode 1 if the  
machine has been idle for about 30 seconds.  
It takes less time to recover from Energy Saver mode 1 than from power-off  
state or Energy Saver mode 2, but power consumption is higher in Energy  
Saver mode 1 than in Energy Saver mode 2.  
Energy Saver Mode 2  
Select [Active] to set the machine to enter Energy Saver mode 2 after the  
period of time specified for [Waiting Time (1-240)] is passed (1 to 240  
minutes).  
The machine consumes less power in Energy Saver mode 2 than in Energy  
Saver mode 1, but it takes longer to recover from Energy Saver mode 2  
than from Energy Saver mode 1.  
8
• The machine recovers from Energy Saver mode when it receives a print job, prints a received fax,  
or when the [Copy], [Color Start], or [B&W Start] key is pressed.  
352  
9. Troubleshooting  
This chapter provides a guide for solving problems in operating the machine.  
Overview  
Troubleshooting is divided into the following sections:  
9
353  
   
9. Troubleshooting  
Common Problems  
This section describes how to troubleshoot common problems that may occur while operating the  
machine.  
Problem  
Possible cause  
Solution  
• Make sure that the power  
plug is firmly inserted into  
the wall outlet.  
The power cord is not  
connected properly.  
The machine does not turn on.  
• Make sure that the wall  
outlet is not defective by  
connecting another  
working device.  
An error message is shown on  
the machine's screen.  
An error has occurred.  
Wait until "Printing..." appears  
on the screen. If "Processing..."  
is displayed on the screen, the  
machine is receiving data.  
The machine is warming up or  
receiving data.  
Pages are not printed.  
• Reconnect the cable.  
The interface cable is not  
connected correctly.  
Pages are not printed.  
Strange noise is heard.  
• Check that the interface  
cable is the correct type.  
The supplies or options are not  
properly installed.  
Confirm that the supplies or  
options are properly installed.  
9
The machine executes periodic  
cleaning of the interior when  
[Auto Cleaning] in [System  
Settings] is set to [On].  
The noise does not indicate a  
malfunction. Wait until the  
cleaning is complete.  
Strange noise is heard.  
Adjust the volume of the beep,  
ring, speaker, and alarm  
The volume of the sounds  
produced by the machine is too  
loud.  
The volume is set to the high  
level.  
Adjust the volume of the beep,  
The volume is muted or set to the ring, speaker, and alarm  
The volume of the sounds  
produced by the machine is too  
quiet.  
low level.  
354  
   
Common Problems  
• If any of these problems persist, turn off the power, pull out the power cord, and contact your sales  
or service representative.  
9
355  
9. Troubleshooting  
Paper Feed Problems  
If the machine is operating but paper will not feed or paper jams occur frequently, check the condition of  
the machine and paper.  
Problem  
Solution  
• Load paper correctly, making sure that the paper guides  
Paper does not feed smoothly.  
• If the paper is curled, straighten the paper.  
• Take out the paper from tray and fan it well. Then,  
reverse the top and bottom of the paper, and put it back  
in the tray.  
• If there are gaps between the paper and the paper  
guides, adjust the paper guides to remove the gaps.  
• Avoid printing on both sides of paper when printing  
images that contain large areas of solid color, which  
consume a lot of toner.  
Paper jams occur frequently.  
• Load paper only as high as the upper limit markings on  
the paper guide.  
9
• Make sure that the friction pad, paper feed roller or  
356  
   
Paper Feed Problems  
Problem  
Solution  
• Fan the paper well before loading. Also make sure that  
the edges are even by tapping the stack on a flat surface  
such as a desk.  
• Make sure that the paper guides are in the right position.  
• Load paper only as high as the upper limit markings on  
the paper guide.  
Multiple sheets of paper are fed at  
one time.  
• Make sure that the friction pad, paper feed roller or  
• Check that paper was not added while there was still  
some left in the tray.  
Only add paper when there is none left in the tray.  
• Paper is damp. Use paper that has been stored properly.  
Paper gets wrinkles.  
• If there are gaps between the paper and the paper  
guides, adjust the paper guides to remove the gaps.  
• Load the paper upside down in the paper tray.  
9
• If the paper curl is severe, take prints from the output tray  
more frequently.  
• Paper is damp. Use paper that has been stored properly.  
The printed paper is curled.  
• Select [Lvl.2: Medium] or [Lvl.3: Strong] in [Anti-Humidity  
Level] under [System Settings]. Note that if you select [Lvl.  
2: Medium] or [Lvl.3: Strong], the first print takes longer  
than subsequent prints to complete.  
357  
9. Troubleshooting  
Problem  
Solution  
Images are printed diagonally to the  
pages.  
If there are gaps between the paper and the paper guides,  
adjust the paper guides to remove the gaps.  
CER091  
Removing Printing Jams  
If a paper jam occurs, one of the following messages appears on the screen:  
• “Misfeed: Dup. Unit Remove Paper”  
• “Internal Misfeed”  
• “Misfeed: Stnd. Tray”  
• “Misfeed: Paper Tray”  
Open the front cover and check the following positions, in the order indicated, to locate the jammed  
paper.  
• Jammed paper may be covered in toner. Be careful not to get toner on your hands or clothes.  
9
• Toner on prints made immediately after clearing a paper jam may be insufficiently fused and can  
smudge. Make test prints until smudges no longer appear.  
• Do not forcefully remove jammed paper, as it may tear. Torn pieces remaining inside the machine  
will cause further jams and possibly damage the machine.  
• Paper jams can cause pages to be lost. Check your print job for missing pages and reprint any  
pages that did not print out.  
358  
   
Paper Feed Problems  
1
2
3
CES150  
1. Fusing Unit  
2. Tray  
3. Transfer Unit  
If paper jams inside the fusing unit  
If paper jams inside the fusing unit, follow the procedure below to remove it.  
9
• The inside of this machine becomes very hot. Do not touch the parts labeled " " (indicating a  
hot surface).  
• Some of this machine's internal components get very hot. For this reason, take care when  
removing misfed paper. Not doing so could result in burns.  
• Since the temperature around the guide is high, wait for it to cool before checking for jammed  
paper.  
359  
   
9. Troubleshooting  
1. Pull the opening lever on the front cover, and then carefully lower the front cover.  
CES141  
2. Lower the fusing unit lever, and pull out the jammed paper carefully.  
CES257  
Pull the paper downward to remove it. Do not pull it upward.  
9
CES144  
If you cannot find the jammed paper, check for it by pulling down the guide.  
360  
Paper Feed Problems  
CES145  
3. Pull up the fusing unit levers.  
CES258  
4. Using both hands, carefully push up the front cover until it closes.  
9
CES142  
• When closing the front cover, push the upper area of the cover firmly. After closing the cover,  
check that the error is cleared.  
If paper jams inside a tray  
If paper jams in tray 1 or 2, follow the procedure below to remove it.  
361  
   
9. Troubleshooting  
1. Pull the opening lever on the front cover, and then carefully lower the front cover.  
CES141  
2. Pull out the jammed paper carefully.  
CES083  
If paper has jammed inside the transfer unit, holding both sides of the paper, pull the paper  
carefully forward and out.  
9
CER063  
362  
Paper Feed Problems  
3. Using both hands, carefully push up the front cover until it closes.  
CES142  
• Do not pull out the paper tray (Tray 1).  
• If paper is jammed in tray 2 but is difficult to locate, pull out tray 2 to remove it. After removing the  
paper, carefully push tray 2 all the way back inside the machine.  
• When closing the front cover, push the upper area of the cover firmly. After closing the cover,  
check that the error is cleared.  
If paper jams inside the transfer unit  
If paper jams inside the transfer unit, follow the procedure below to remove it.  
1. Pull the opening lever on the front cover, and then carefully lower the front cover.  
9
CES141  
363  
   
9. Troubleshooting  
2. Carefully remove any paper that is jammed under the transfer unit.  
CER046  
If you cannot find the jammed paper, look inside the machine.  
3. Using both hands, carefully push up the front cover until it closes.  
CES142  
• When closing the front cover, push the upper area of the cover firmly. After closing the cover,  
check that the error is cleared.  
9
Removing Scanning Jams  
If a paper jam occurs in the ADF, one of the following messages appears on the screen:  
• "ADF Original Misfeed Open ADF Cover and Remove paper."  
• "Misfeed: Tray 1"  
• "Misfeed: Tray 2"  
Follow the procedure below to remove the original jammed in the ADF.  
364  
   
Paper Feed Problems  
1. Open the ADF cover.  
CES100  
2. Gently pull the jammed original to remove it. Be careful not to pull the original too hard,  
as it may rip.  
CES101  
3. If you cannot pull out the jammed original easily, move the lever slightly to the machine  
rear, and then pull it up to unlock the paper feed roller.  
9
CES044  
365  
9. Troubleshooting  
4. Lift the paper feed roller slightly and pull it out toward you.  
CES113  
5. Gently pull the jammed original to remove it.  
CES114  
6. If you cannot pull out the jammed original easily, raise the input tray to see if the original  
is jammed in the output area.  
9
CES120  
366  
Paper Feed Problems  
7. Gently pull the jammed original to remove it.  
CES121  
8. Put the paper feed roller back in with the roller part facing downwards.  
CES115  
9. Lower the lever until it clicks into place.  
9
CES116  
367  
9. Troubleshooting  
10. Close the ADF cover.  
CES102  
11. Lift the ADF, and if there is original remaining in the ADF, gently pull the jammed original  
to remove it.  
Be careful not to hold the input tray when lifting the ADF, for the tray might be damaged.  
CES153  
12. Close the ADF.  
9
368  
Print Quality Problems  
Print Quality Problems  
This section describes likely causes of and possible solutions for problems with print quality.  
Checking the Condition of the Machine  
If there is a problem with the quality of printing, first check the condition of the machine.  
Possible Cause  
Solution  
There is a problem with the  
machine's location.  
Make sure that the machine is on a level surface. Place the  
machine where it will not be subject to vibration or shock.  
Make sure that the paper being used is supported by the  
Unsupported types of paper is used.  
The paper type setting is incorrect.  
Make sure that the paper type setting of the printer driver  
Refilled or non-genuine print cartridges reduce print quality  
and can cause malfunctions. Use genuine print cartridges only.  
A non-genuine print cartridge is  
being used.  
Print cartridges should be opened before their expiration date  
and used within six months of being opened.  
An old print cartridge is being used.  
The machine is dirty.  
9
Color degradation may occur in color printing after the  
machine is moved or a large number of pages are printed. In  
this case, adjust color registration by executing [Colour  
Registration] in [System Settings].  
Color degradation has occurred.  
369  
     
9. Troubleshooting  
Printer Problems  
This section describes printing problems and possible solutions.  
Problem  
Solution  
If an error occurs when printing, change the computer or  
printer driver settings.  
• Check the printer icon name does not exceed 32  
alphanumeric characters. If it does, shorten it.  
An error occurs.  
• Check whether other applications are operating.  
Close any other applications, as they may be interfering  
with printing. If the problem is not resolved, close  
unneeded processes too.  
• Check that the latest printer driver is being used.  
• Printing on Legal size paper may be canceled, if the  
printing is performed with a certain print quality setting. If  
using the PCL or DDST printer driver, set [Gradation:] in  
[Print Quality] to [Speed] or [Standard]. If using the  
PostScript 3 printer driver, set [Print Quality:] in [Printer  
Features] to [Standard] or [High Quality]. For details, see  
the printer driver Help.  
A print job is canceled.  
• If [I/O Timeout] under [System Settings] is set to 15  
seconds, increase the time period. A print job may be  
canceled if printing is frequently interrupted by data from  
other ports, or if printing data is large and takes time for  
9
370  
   
Printer Problems  
Problem  
Solution  
• The machine already has 5 jobs or 5 MB of Locked Print  
data. Print or delete an existing Locked Print file. For  
• Even if the machine cannot store any more Locked Print  
files, the machine holds the new Locked Print file for the  
period of time specified in [Locked Print] under system  
settings before canceling that file. Within this time, you  
can print or delete the new Locked Print file. You can also  
print or delete an existing Locked Print file so that the new  
Locked Print file can be stored in the machine. For details  
A Locked Print file is canceled.  
• The Locked Print file has too many pages or it is too large.  
Reduce the number of pages to print, or print with a  
lower setting for [Gradation:] in [Print Quality]. For  
details, see the printer driver Help.  
• Processing time depends on data volume. High volume  
data, such as graphics-heavy documents, take longer to  
process.  
There is considerable delay between  
the print start command and actual  
printing.  
• If "Processing..." is displayed on the screen, the machine  
is receiving data. Wait for a while.  
• To speed up printing, reduce the printing resolution using  
the printer driver. For details, see the printer driver Help.  
9
• The machine is calibrating color. Wait for a while.  
Pull up the appropriate stop fence (forward fence for A4/  
Prints fall behind the machine when  
they are output.  
• Paper is damp. Use paper that has been stored properly.  
• Select [Lvl.2: Medium] or [Lvl.3: Strong] in [Anti-Humidity  
Level] under [System Settings]. Note that if you select [Lvl.  
2: Medium] or [Lvl.3: Strong], the first print takes longer  
than subsequent prints to complete.  
Prints do not stack properly.  
• Pull up the appropriate stop fence (forward fence for  
371  
9. Troubleshooting  
Problem  
Solution  
• Paper is damp. Use paper that has been stored properly.  
• Select [Lvl.1: Weak], [Lvl.2: Medium] or [Lvl.3: Strong] in  
[Anti-Humidity Level] under [System Settings]. Note that if  
you select [Lvl.2: Medium] or [Lvl.3: Strong], the first print  
takes longer than subsequent prints to complete.  
• If you enable [Toner Saving] under [System Settings],  
printing is generally less dense.  
• If you select [On] for [Economy Color] in the [Print  
Quality] tab (PCL/DDST printer driver) or under [Printer  
Features] (PostScript 3 printer driver), print will be at  
lower density. For details, see the printer driver Help.  
The whole printout is blurred.  
• Toner is almost depleted. If “Toner Almost Empty Replace  
Required Soon: Toner Cartridge (X)” (“X” indicates the  
toner color) appears on the screen, replace the indicated  
print cartridge.  
• Condensation may have collected. If rapid change in  
temperature or humidity occurs, use this machine only  
after it has acclimatized.  
The toner is powdery and comes  
away from the paper, or the printed  
image has a matt appearance.  
Check if the fusing unit levers are properly set. Pull up the  
fusing unit levers.  
9
Check if the fusing unit levers are properly set. Lower the fusing  
unit levers.  
Printed envelopes come out creased.  
Changing the Printer Driver Settings  
You may eliminate certain problems by changing the printer driver settings as described below.  
Possible Cause  
Solution  
• Increase the print quality settings.  
• Adjust the color density.  
Cannot print properly when using a certain  
application, or cannot print image data  
properly.  
• Set the document to print in gray-scale.  
• Increase the print quality settings.  
Some characters are printed faintly or not  
printed.  
• Set the document to print in gray-scale.  
372  
   
Printer Problems  
Printed Colors Do Not Match Displayed Colors  
If the colors of images displayed on the computer screen do not match print results, the cause may be  
one of the following.  
Possible Cause  
Solution  
Check that both the application and the driver are  
configured for color printing. For details, see the  
printer driver Help.  
Color printing was not specified for the data.  
Configure the print quality settings. For details, see  
the printer driver Help.  
Print quality settings have not been configured.  
If bidirectional communication is not enabled, the  
tone of printed images might differ from that of  
displayed images. Establish bidirectional  
Bidirectional communication is not enabled with  
the machine.  
If Economy Color printing is enabled, prints will be  
at lower density and the color gradation may  
appear differently. For details, see the printer  
driver Help.  
[Economy Color] is enabled in the [Print Quality]  
tab (PCL/DDST printer driver) or under [Printer  
Features] (PostScript 3 printer driver).  
Print Positions Do Not Match Display Positions  
9
If the position of items on the printed page differs from the position displayed on the computer screen,  
the cause may be one of the following.  
Possible Cause  
Solution  
Check that the page layout settings are properly  
configured in the application.  
Page layout settings have not been configured.  
Make sure the paper size selected in the printer  
The paper size setting does not match the paper properties dialog box matches the size of the  
loaded.  
paper loaded. For details, see the printer driver  
Help.  
Set the printable area to maximum. For details, see  
the printer driver Help.  
The printable area has been changed.  
373  
     
9. Troubleshooting  
Copier Problems  
This section describes photocopy problems and possible solutions.  
Problem  
Solution  
On the control panel, change the [Sort] setting under copy  
settings to collate pages as you require. For details about  
Photocopied pages are not in  
correct order.  
The original is not set correctly.  
When using the exposure glass, place originals copy side  
down. When using the ADF, place them copy side up. See  
Photocopied paper is blank.  
If copying from the exposure glass, make sure that there are  
no originals in the ADF.  
The wrong original was copied.  
Copied pages are too dark or too  
light.  
Select the correct scan mode according to the type of original.  
Copied pages do not look the same  
as the originals.  
The original may have stuck to the exposure glass due to high  
humidity.  
Black spots appear when  
photocopying a photographic print.  
Place the original on the exposure glass, and then place two  
or three sheets of white paper on top of it. Leave the ADF open  
when copying.  
9
The original probably has heavily lined or dotted areas.  
A moire pattern is produced.  
Switching the setting for image quality between [Photo] and  
[Mixed] may eliminate the moire pattern.  
374  
   
Copier Problems  
Problem  
Solution  
• Image density is too high.  
• Toner on the printed surface is not dry.  
Do not touch printed surfaces immediately after copying.  
Remove freshly printed sheets one by one, taking care  
not to touch printed areas.  
Photocopied paper is dirty.  
• Before placing originals on the exposure glass, make  
sure that toner or correction fluid is dry.  
When copying from the exposure  
glass, the print area of the copy is  
out of alignment with the original.  
Place the original copy side down, making sure that it is  
aligned to the rear left corner and pressed flat against the  
exposure glass.  
9
375  
9. Troubleshooting  
Scanner Problems  
This section describes scanner problems and possible solutions.  
Problem  
Solution  
The ADF or ADF cover is open. If the ADF or ADF cover is  
The machine does not start scanning. open, you cannot scan using the ADF. Close the ADF or ADF  
cover.  
The scanned image is dirty.  
• Before placing originals on the exposure glass, make  
sure that toner or correction fluid is dry.  
The scanned image is distorted or  
out of position.  
The original was moved during scanning. Do not move the  
original during scanning.  
The original was placed upside down. Place the original in the  
The scanned image is upside down.  
The original was placed with the front and back reversed.  
When using the exposure glass, place originals copy side  
down. When using the ADF, place originals copy side up. See  
The scanned image is blank.  
The scanned image is too dark or  
too light.  
9
The Scan to E-mail, Scan to FTP, or  
Scan to Folder function does not  
work.  
Check if a USB flash disk is inserted into the machine. If a USB  
flash disk is inserted, scanning functions other than Scan to  
USB are not possible from the control panel.  
376  
   
Fax Problems  
Fax Problems  
This section describes fax problems and possible solutions.  
When an error code appears on the fax journal or transmission status report  
The table below describes the meaning of error codes that appear under "Results" on the fax  
journal or transmission status report, and what to do when a particular error code appears.  
"X" indicates a number in an error code that appear differently depending on a specific situation.  
Error Code  
Solution  
An original has been jammed inside the ADF while sending a  
fax in Immediate Transmission mode.  
• Remove jammed originals, and then place them again.  
1XXX11  
The line could not be connected correctly.  
• Confirm that the telephone line is properly connected to  
the machine.  
• Disconnect the telephone line from the machine, and  
connect a standard telephone in its place. Confirm that  
you can make calls using the telephone. If you cannot  
make calls this way, contact your telephone company.  
1XXX21  
• If the problem persists, contact your sales or service  
representative.  
9
Dial fails when trying to send faxes.  
• Confirm that the fax number you dialed is correct.  
• Confirm that the destination is a fax machine.  
• Confirm that the line is not busy.  
1XXX22 to 1XXX23  
• You may need to insert a pause between dial digits. Press  
the [Pause/Redial] key after, for example, the area code.  
• Confirm that [PSTN / PBX] under [Admin. Tools] is set  
properly for your connection method to the telephone  
377  
   
9. Troubleshooting  
Error Code  
Solution  
An error occurred while sending a fax.  
• Confirm that the telephone line is properly connected to  
the machine.  
• Disconnect the telephone line from the machine, and  
connect a standard telephone in its place. Confirm that  
you can make calls using the telephone. If you cannot  
make calls this way, contact your telephone company.  
1XXX32 to 1XXX84  
• If the problem persists, contact your sales or service  
representative.  
The machine was not able to print the received fax, or the  
machine's memory reached capacity while receiving a fax  
because the document was too large.  
• The paper tray was empty. Load paper in the paper tray.  
• The tray set for [Select Paper Tray] under [Fax Features]  
did not contain A4, Letter, or Legal size paper. Load  
valid size paper in the tray, and configure the paper size  
settings under [System Settings] accordingly.  
2XXX14  
• A cover or tray was open. Close the cover or tray.  
• There was a paper jam. Remove the jammed paper. See  
• A print cartridge was empty. Replace the print cartridge.  
9
• The received fax was too large. Ask the sender to re-send  
the document in parts as several smaller individual faxes,  
or to send at a lower resolution.  
An error occurred while receiving a fax.  
• Confirm that the telephone line is properly connected to  
the machine.  
• Disconnect the telephone line from the machine, and  
connect a standard telephone in its place. Confirm that  
you can make calls using the telephone. If you cannot  
make calls this way, contact your telephone company.  
2XXX32 to 2XXX84  
• If the problem persists, contact your sales or service  
representative.  
378  
Fax Problems  
Error Code  
Solution  
3XXX11  
Connection to the server failed while sending an Internet Fax.  
• Confirm that the network cable is properly connected to  
the machine.  
• Confirm that the network settings such as IP address,  
DNS, and SMTP settings have been configured properly  
(make sure that no double-byte character is used). See  
3XXX12  
3XXX13  
3XXX14  
3XXX33  
E-mail transmission failed while sending an Internet Fax.  
• There was an error in the header of the e-mail. Confirm  
that the network settings such as IP address, DNS, and  
SMTP settings have been configured properly (make sure  
E-mail transmission failed while sending an Internet Fax.  
• There was an error in the part header of the e-mail.  
Confirm that the network settings such as IP address,  
DNS, and SMTP settings have been configured properly  
(make sure that no double-byte character is used). See  
E-mail transmission failed while sending an Internet Fax.  
• There was an error in the converted TIFF file. Confirm that  
the network settings such as IP address, DNS, and SMTP  
settings have been configured properly (make sure that  
9
The machine memory reached capacity while sending an  
Internet Fax.  
• The fax was too large. Resend the document in parts as  
several smaller individual faxes, or send at a lower  
resolution.  
379  
9. Troubleshooting  
Error Code  
Solution  
4XXX21  
Connection to the server failed while receiving an Internet Fax.  
• Confirm that the network cable is properly connected to  
the machine.  
• Confirm that the network settings such as IP address,  
DNS, and POP3 settings have been configured properly  
(make sure that no double-byte character is used). See  
4XXX22  
4XXX23  
4XXX24  
E-mail reception failed while receiving an Internet Fax.  
• LIST command to the POP3 server failed. Ask the sender  
to check the e-mail settings.  
E-mail reception failed while receiving an Internet Fax.  
• There was an error in the header of the e-mail. Ask the  
sender to check the e-mail settings.  
E-mail reception failed while receiving an Internet Fax.  
• There was an error in the part header of the e-mail. Ask  
the sender to check the e-mail settings.  
• The e-mail had an invalid Content-Type, or an  
unsupported type of file (such as PDF or JPEG) was  
received. Ask the sender to check the file type.  
4XXX25  
4XXX26  
E-mail reception failed while receiving an Internet Fax.  
9
• There was an error in the text part of the part body of the  
e-mail. Ask the sender to check the e-mail settings.  
E-mail reception failed while receiving an Internet Fax.  
• There was an error in the received TIFF file (which  
resulted from a condition not indicated by the error codes  
4XXX43 to 4XXX45). Ask the sender to check the TIFF  
file.  
4XXX42  
E-mail reception failed while receiving an Internet Fax.  
• There was an error in the part header of the e-mail. Ask  
the sender to check the e-mail settings.  
380  
Fax Problems  
Error Code  
Solution  
4XXX43  
4XXX44  
A TIFF file could not be received via Internet Fax properly.  
• The compression method of the received TIFF file was  
other than MH/MR/MMR. Ask the sender to check the  
TIFF file.  
A TIFF file could not be received via Internet Fax properly.  
• The resolution of the TIFF file was not supported, or the  
width of the TIFF file was A3 or B4. Ask the sender to  
check the TIFF file.  
4XXX45  
4XXX46  
A TIFF file could not be received via Internet Fax properly.  
• The format of the TIFF file was other than TIFF-S/F. Ask  
the sender to check the TIFF file.  
The machine memory reached capacity while receiving an  
Internet Fax.  
• The fax was too large. Ask the sender to resend the  
document in parts as several smaller individual faxes, or  
send at a lower resolution.  
When other problems occur  
The table below describes how to troubleshoot problems that do not produce an error code.  
Problem  
Cannot send faxes.  
Solution  
9
See the solutions provided for errors 1XXX32 to 1XXX84 in the  
above table.  
See the solutions provided for errors 2XXX32 to 2XXX84 in the  
above table.  
Cannot receive faxes.  
• A print cartridge is empty. Replace the print cartridge.  
• The paper tray is empty. Load paper in the paper tray.  
Cannot receive faxes even when  
sending them is possible.  
• If fax reception mode is FAX/TEL Manual mode, you  
381  
9. Troubleshooting  
Problem  
Solution  
• The paper tray is empty. Load paper in the paper tray.  
Cannot print received faxes.  
• The paper tray does not contain paper of the right size.  
Load paper of the right size in the paper tray.  
Faxes you sent appear spotty or  
dirty when received.  
• Before placing originals on the exposure glass, make  
sure that ink or correction fluid is dry.  
A fax you sent appears blank when The original was placed upside down. Place the original in the  
received.  
The background of received images  
is dirty, or images from the rear side  
of the originals are visible.  
See the solutions provided for errors 1XXX22 to 1XXX23 in the  
above table.  
Dial fails when trying to send faxes.  
9
382  
Error and Status Messages on the Screen  
Error and Status Messages on the Screen  
This section describes the meaning of messages that appear on the screen and what to do when a  
particular message appears.  
Messages are listed in alphabetical order in the table below.  
"X" indicates the parts of the messages that appear differently depending on a specific situation, such as  
the paper sizes or types, tray names, or toner colors.  
Message  
Causes  
Solutions  
• The paper tray was empty. Load  
• The tray set for [Select Paper Tray]  
under [Fax Features] did not contain  
A4, Letter, or Legal size paper. Load  
valid size paper in the tray, and  
configure the paper size settings  
under [System Settings] accordingly.  
The machine was not able to  
print the received fax, or the  
machine's memory reached  
capacity while receiving a fax  
because the document was too  
large.  
• A cover or tray was open. Close the  
cover or tray.  
2XXX14  
• There was a paper jam. Remove the  
• A print cartridge was empty. Replace  
9
• The received fax was too large. Ask  
the sender to resend the document in  
parts as several smaller individual  
faxes, or to send at a lower  
resolution.  
ADF Cover Open  
Close ADF Cover  
The ADF cover is open.  
• Close the cover completely.  
383  
   
9. Troubleshooting  
Message  
Causes  
Solutions  
• Remove jammed originals, and then  
ADF Original  
Misfeed  
An original has been jammed  
inside the ADF.  
Open ADF Cover  
and  
• Check the originals are suitable for  
Remove paper.  
Almost Full  
The waste toner bottle is almost  
full.  
Prepare a new waste toner bottle.  
Waste Toner Bottle  
• Specify the tray containing the A4,  
B5, Letter, Legal, or Executive size  
paper (other than the bypass tray) in  
2-sided copy could not be  
Available: 2 Sided  
Copy  
performed because the tray  
does not contain the valid size  
paper, which are A4, B5, Letter,  
A4/B5/LG/LT/EXE  
• Specify the A4, B5, Letter, Legal,  
F/Folio/FoolScap/  
16K  
1
Legal, Executive, 8" × 13",  
Executive, 8" × 13", 8 / " × 13",  
2
1
8 / " × 13", Folio, or 16K.  
2
Folio, or 16K size for the tray  
selected for printing copies. See  
Available: 2 Sided  
2-sided copy could not be  
Specify a setting other than [Bypass Tray]  
Copy Tray 1 or Tray performed because paper is set for the [Select Paper] setting. See p.253  
2
to be fed from the bypass tray.  
9
• Set the machine to print copies using  
the A4 or Letter size paper in the  
ID card copy could not be  
performed because the tray  
Copy A4 or 8 1/2 x does not contain the valid size  
Available: IDCard  
11  
paper, which are A4 or Letter  
size.  
• Specify the A4 or Letter size paper for  
the tray selected for printing copies.  
• Set the machine to print copies using  
the A4, Letter, or Legal size paper in  
2-in-1 or 4-in-1 copy could not  
be performed because the tray  
does not contain the valid size  
paper, which are A4, Letter, or  
Legal size.  
Cannot Copy This  
Setting  
Comb.: 2 on 1 / 4  
on 1  
• Specify the A4, Letter, or Legal size  
paper for the tray selected for printing  
384  
Error and Status Messages on the Screen  
Message  
Causes  
Solutions  
• Use the ADF, even when copying a  
single sheet.  
2-in-1, 4-in-1, or 2-sided copy  
could not be performed  
because the originals were not  
placed in the ADF.  
• If you need to use the exposure glass,  
turn off [Comb. 2 on 1], [Comb. 4 on  
1], or [2 Sided Copy] under copy  
settings, and then try again. See  
Cannot copy.  
Set Original to ADF  
The paper size set for the  
document differs from the size of  
the paper in the indicated tray.  
Press [FormFeed] to begin printing, or  
press [JobReset] to cancel the job.  
Check Paper Size  
Check Paper Type  
The paper type set for the  
document differs from the type  
of the paper in the indicated  
tray.  
Press [FormFeed] to begin printing, or  
press [JobReset] to cancel the job.  
• Confirm that the telephone line is  
properly connected to the machine.  
• Disconnect the telephone line from  
the machine, and connect a standard  
telephone in its place. Confirm that  
you can make calls using the  
telephone. If you cannot make calls  
this way, contact your telephone  
company.  
The line could not be connected  
correctly.  
Connection Failed  
Cover open  
9
A cover is open.  
Close the cover completely.  
Density Sensor  
Require Cleaning  
The machine failed to adjust  
color registration.  
• Press a different One Touch button.  
No Quick Dial entry is  
associated with the One Touch  
button you pressed.  
Dest. is not  
Programmed  
• Assign a registered destination to the  
385  
9. Troubleshooting  
Message  
Causes  
Solutions  
• Confirm that the fax number you  
dialed is correct.  
• Confirm that the destination is a fax  
machine.  
Dial Failed  
The fax could not be sent.  
• Confirm that the line is not busy.  
• You may need to insert a pause  
between dial digits. Press the [Pause/  
Redial] key after, for example, the  
area code.  
• Configure [Resolution] under scanner  
settings to reduce the scanning  
The scan file exceeds the size  
limit for files that can be sent  
through e-mail.  
Exceeded Max.E-  
mail Size  
• Configure [Max. E-mail Size] under  
scanner settings to increase the  
The Scan to USB function failed  
Failed to Access File because the machine could not Use a USB flash disk that is not password-  
Press Clear key  
access the USB flash disk  
properly.  
or write-protected.  
The Scan to USB function failed  
because there was not enough  
memory on the USB flash disk.  
9
Failed to Create File  
Press Clear key  
Use a USB flash disk with enough memory.  
The number of fax jobs in  
Fax Job Memory  
Overflow  
memory (unsent or unprinted  
faxes) has reached maximum,  
so new jobs cannot be stored.  
Wait until pending jobs have been  
transmitted or printed.  
The timeout period set in [I/O  
Timeout] expires when printing  
is frequently interrupted by data  
from other ports, or when  
printing data is large and takes  
time for processing.  
If [I/O Timeout] is set to 15 seconds,  
increase the time period. For details, see  
I/O Timeout  
386  
Error and Status Messages on the Screen  
Message  
Causes  
Solutions  
A non-supported print cartridge Remove and replace it with a print  
Indep.Sply.Toner: X  
is installed for the indicated  
color.  
cartridge specified by an authorized  
dealer.  
Paper has been jammed in the  
machine.  
Internal Misfeed  
If several originals are still to be scanned,  
it is recommended to start printing now,  
and copy the remaining originals  
separately. If originals are being scanned  
from the ADF, remove any remaining  
pages from the ADF.  
Memory has almost reached  
capacity during sort copy.  
Memory Almost Full  
• Select [600 × 600 1bit] in  
[Resolution] under [Printer Features]  
• The data is too large or  
complex to print.  
• If you try to print a Locked  
Print file stored in the  
• Print or delete other Locked Print files  
in the machine, and then print the  
Locked Print file that the machine  
failed to print. Alternately, resend the  
Locked Print file to the machine with  
[Gradation:] set to [Speed] or  
[Standard], and then print the Locked  
Print file.  
machine with the printer  
driver's [Gradation:] set to  
[Fine] in the [Print Quality]  
tab, printing may be  
canceled depending on  
the machine's current  
memory usage.  
Memory Overflow  
9
• When performing printing  
on Legal size paper under  
certain print quality setting,  
print data becomes large  
and the job may be  
• If using the PCL or DDST printer  
driver, set [Gradation:] in [Print  
Quality] to [Speed] or [Standard]. If  
using the PostScript 3 printer driver,  
set [Print Quality:] in [Printer Features]  
to [Standard] or [High Quality].  
canceled.  
387  
9. Troubleshooting  
Message  
Causes  
Solutions  
• The machine's memory  
reached capacity while  
scanning the first page of  
the original to store a fax  
job in memory before  
transmission.  
Resend the fax in parts as several smaller  
individual faxes, or send at a lower  
resolution.  
Memory Overflow  
• The machine's memory  
reached capacity while  
sending a fax via LAN-Fax.  
Memory has reached capacity  
while scanning the second or  
Memory Overflow  
Press [TX] to send only the pages that have  
TX  
later pages of the original when been scanned in memory, or press  
trying to send a fax in Memory  
Transmission mode.  
[Cancel] to cancel.  
Cancel  
Misfeed: Dup. Unit  
Remove Paper  
Paper has been jammed in the  
duplex unit.  
Paper has been jammed in the  
paper tray.  
Misfeed: Paper Tray  
Misfeed: Stnd. Tray  
Misfeed: Tray 1  
Paper has been jammed in the  
paper exit area.  
Paper has been jammed in the  
ADF input tray.  
9
Paper has been jammed in the  
ADF output tray.  
Misfeed: Tray 2  
Connection with the server was  
lost while sending or receiving  
data.  
Net Communication  
Error  
Contact the network administrator.  
A scanned file could not be sent  
because the machine has not  
Wait until the machine receives the IP  
Network is not Ready received IP address information address information completely, and then  
from the DHCP server  
completely.  
try the operation again.  
The machine has been off-hook Put down the handset or press the [Clear/  
for an extended period of time. Stop] key.  
On Hook or Stop key  
388  
Error and Status Messages on the Screen  
Message  
Causes  
Solutions  
The indicated tray has run out of Load paper to the indicated tray. See p.99  
Out of Paper: X  
paper.  
• Press [No] to cancel the job and  
replace the indicated print cartridge.  
Out of Toner: X  
The machine has run out of the  
indicated toner.  
Continue printing?  
• Press [Yes] to finish printing before  
replacing the indicated print  
cartridge.  
Please Restart  
Machine  
The machine needs to be  
restarted.  
Turn off the power, and then turn it back  
on.  
The machine failed to proceed  
with the print job, because tray  
1 or tray 2 was specified as the Remove paper from the bypass tray.  
input tray but paper was set in  
Remove Paper:  
Bypass Tray  
the bypass tray.  
The fusing unit is no longer  
usable, and must be replaced.  
Contact your sales or service  
representative.  
Replace Fusing Unit  
Replace IntTrans. Belt  
The transfer belt is no longer  
usable, and must be replaced.  
Contact your sales or service  
representative.  
Replace the waste toner bottle with a new  
9
Replace:  
The waste toner bottle is full.  
Waste Toner Bottle  
A reception error occurred, and  
the fax could not be received  
correctly.  
If possible, contact the sender of the fax  
and ask them to resend it.  
RX Comm. Error  
A scanned file could not be sent  
because the Ethernet cable was  
not connected properly.  
Scan (NW)  
Disconnected  
Reconnect the Ethernet cable properly,  
and then try the operation again.  
The USB cable was  
disconnected while scanning  
from a computer.  
Scan (USB)  
Disconnected  
Reconnect the USB cable properly, and  
then try the operation again.  
389  
9. Troubleshooting  
Message  
Causes  
Solutions  
A scanned file could not be sent  
because the destination could  
not be reached.  
Server Connection  
Failed  
Confirm that the destination is registered  
correctly, and then try the operation again.  
Confirm that the destination is registered  
correctly, and then try the operation again.  
An error occurred in  
communication with the server  
before beginning transmission.  
Server Response  
Error  
If the problem could not be solved, contact  
the network administrator.  
A fatal hardware error has  
occurred, and the machine  
cannot function.  
Contact your sales or service  
representative.  
Service call - X  
While the message is displayed, press the  
[OK] key. A menu for changing the paper  
size of the current tray appears.  
Load A4/Letter/ Legal size paper in the  
tray, and then select the corresponding  
paper size using [ ][ ] keys and press the  
[OK] key. The machine will then print out  
the fax.  
The tray set for [Select Paper  
Tray] under [Fax Features] does  
not contain A4, Letter, or Legal  
size paper.  
Set Correct Paper  
Note that the paper size setting for the tray  
under system settings will be changed. See  
9
• Use the ADF, even when scanning  
A4/Letter or smaller size originals.  
Scanning could not be  
Set Original to ADF  
performed because the originals  
were not placed in the ADF,  
even though the machine is set  
to scan originals larger than  
A4/Letter size.  
Cannot use exposure  
glass  
• If you need to use the exposure glass,  
set A4/Letter or smaller size in [Scan  
Size] under scanner settings, and then  
with set. in [Scan  
Size].  
Setting Error:  
The waste toner bottle has been Reinstall the waste toner bottle. See p.399  
installed incorrectly.  
Waste Toner Bottle  
Toner Almost Empty  
Replace Required  
Soon:  
The print cartridge is almost  
empty.  
Prepare a new print cartridge.  
Toner Cartridge (X)  
390  
Error and Status Messages on the Screen  
Message  
Causes  
Solutions  
The print cartridge has not been  
installed or has not been  
installed correctly.  
Toner Set Error: X  
If the [Auto Redial] setting is enabled, the  
machine will redial the number and try  
again. If all attempts fail, or if the machine  
is in Immediate Transmission mode, the fax  
will not be transmitted. Try the operation  
again.  
A transmission error occurred,  
and the fax could not be  
transmitted correctly.  
TX Comm. Error  
• Specify the tray containing the valid  
type paper (other than the bypass  
tray) in the [Select Paper] setting. See  
2-sided copy could not be  
performed because the tray  
does not contain the valid type  
paper, which are thin, plain,  
middle thick, recycled, color,  
preprinted or prepunched.  
Unavailable Paper  
Type  
• Specify the valid paper type for the  
tray selected for printing copies. See  
The Scan to USB function failed  
because a USB device other  
than a USB flash disk or a USB  
flash disk with an unsupported  
file system was used.  
Unsupported Device  
Please Remove  
Use a USB flash disk that is compatible  
with the Scan to USB function.  
The Scan to USB function failed  
because a USB device other  
than a USB flash disk or a USB  
flash disk with an unsupported  
file system was used.  
9
Unsupported Device  
Press Clear key  
Use a USB flash disk that is compatible  
with the Scan to USB function.  
The Scan to USB function failed  
because a USB device other  
than a USB flash disk or a USB  
flash disk with an unsupported  
file system was used.  
Unsupported USB  
Hub Please Remove  
Use a USB flash disk that is compatible  
with the Scan to USB function.  
The Scan to USB function failed Check that the USB flash disk is securely  
because the USB flash disk was inserted in the machine. Do not pull out the  
USB Disconnected  
Press Clear key  
removed before the operation  
could be completed.  
USB flash disk until "Ready" appears on  
the display.  
391  
9. Troubleshooting  
Message  
Causes  
Solutions  
USB Memory  
The Scan to USB function failed  
Overflow Press Clear because there was not enough  
Use a USB flash disk with enough memory.  
key  
memory on the USB flash disk.  
The Scan to USB function failed  
Write Protect Press  
Clear key  
because the machine could not Use a USB flash disk that is not password-  
access the USB flash disk  
properly.  
or write-protected.  
9
392  
Replacing Print Cartridges  
Replacing Print Cartridges  
• Do not incinerate toner (new or used) or toner containers. Doing so risks burns. Toner will ignite  
on contact with naked flame.  
• Do not store toner (new or used) or toner containers anywhere near naked flames. Doing so  
risks fire and burns. Toner will ignite on contact with naked flame.  
• Keep the polythene materials (bags, gloves, etc.) supplied with this machine away from babies  
and small children at all times. Suffocation can result if polythene materials are brought into  
contact with the mouth or nose.  
• Do not crush or squeeze toner containers. Doing so can cause toner spillage, possibly resulting  
in dirtying of skin, clothing, and floor, and accidental ingestion.  
• Store toner (new or used), toner containers, and components that have been in contact with  
toner out of reach of children.  
9
• If toner or used toner is inhaled, gargle with plenty of water and move into a fresh air  
environment. Consult a doctor if necessary.  
• When removing jammed paper or replacing toner, avoid getting toner (new or used) on your  
clothing. If toner comes into contact with your clothing, wash the stained area with cold water.  
Hot water will set the toner into the fabric and make removing the stain impossible.  
• When removing jammed paper or replacing toner, avoid getting toner (new or used) on your  
skin. If toner comes into contact with your skin, wash the affected area thoroughly with soap and  
water.  
393  
   
9. Troubleshooting  
• If toner or used toner gets into your eyes, flush immediately with large amounts of water. Consult  
a doctor if necessary.  
• If toner or used toner is swallowed, dilute by drinking a large amount of water. Consult a doctor  
if necessary.  
• Store print cartridges in a cool dark place.  
• Actual printable numbers vary depending on image volume and density, number of pages printed  
at a time, paper type and size, and environmental conditions such as temperature and humidity.  
Toner quality degrades over time. Early replacement of the print cartridge might be necessary.  
Therefore, we recommend you always keep a new print cartridge ready.  
• For good print quality, the manufacturer recommends that you use genuine toner from the  
manufacturer.  
• The manufacturer shall not be responsible for any damage or expense that might result from the use  
of parts other than genuine parts from the manufacturer with your office products.  
Messages on the screen  
• Replace the indicated print cartridge when any of the following messages appear on the  
screen:  
"Out of Toner: Black"  
"Out of Toner: Magenta"  
"Out of Toner: Cyan"  
"Out of Toner: Yellow"  
9
• Prepare the indicated print cartridge when any of the following messages appear on the  
screen:  
“Toner Almost Empty Replace Required Soon: Toner Cartridge (Black)”  
“Toner Almost Empty Replace Required Soon: Toner Cartridge (Magenta)”  
“Toner Almost Empty Replace Required Soon: Toner Cartridge (Cyan)”  
“Toner Almost Empty Replace Required Soon: Toner Cartridge (Yellow)”  
• Do not allow paper clips, staples, or other small objects to fall inside the machine.  
• Do not expose the print cartridge without its cover to direct sunlight for a long time.  
• Do not touch the print cartridge's photo conductor unit.  
394  
Replacing Print Cartridges  
CER088  
• Do not touch the ID chip on the side of the print cartridge as indicated in the illustration below.  
CES032  
• When removing print cartridges, be careful not to touch the Laser Scanning Unit on the underside  
of the upper cover (the position shown by the arrow in the illustration below).  
9
CES137  
• If cyan, magenta, or yellow toner runs out, you can print in black and white using just the black  
toner. Change the color mode setting to Black and White using the machine's driver.  
• If black toner runs out, you cannot print in black and white or color until the black print cartridge is  
replaced.  
1. Pull up the lever on the top cover, and then carefully raise the top cover.  
Make sure that the ADF is closed.  
395  
9. Troubleshooting  
CES138  
2. Carefully lift out the print cartridge vertically, holding its center.  
From the rear, the print cartridges are installed in the order of cyan (C), magenta (M), yellow (Y),  
and black (K).  
CES139  
• Do not shake the removed print cartridge. Doing so can cause remaining toner to leak.  
• Place the old print cartridge on paper or similar material to avoid dirtying your workspace.  
• The toner color is indicated by the label on each print cartridge.  
9
3. Take the new print cartridge out of the box, and then take it out of the plastic bag.  
CBK123  
396  
Replacing Print Cartridges  
4. Hold the print cartridge and shake it from side to side five or six times.  
CER236  
Even distribution of toner within the bottle improves print quality.  
5. Remove the cover from the print cartridge.  
CER010  
6. Check the toner color and corresponding location, and then carefully insert the print  
cartridge vertically.  
9
CES255  
7. Using both hands, hold the center of the top cover and close the cover carefully. Be  
careful not to trap your fingers.  
After closing the top cover, wait until the initial screen is displayed.  
397  
9. Troubleshooting  
CES140  
8. Put the cover that you removed in step 5 on the old print cartridge. Then, put the old print  
cartridge into the bag, and then put it into the box.  
CER055  
• Make sure to cover the old print cartridge with the protective cover for recycling and environmental  
purposes.  
9
• Comply with the print cartridge Recycling Program, whereby used print cartridges are collected for  
processing. For details, ask your sales or service representative.  
398  
Replacing the Waste Toner Bottle  
Replacing the Waste Toner Bottle  
• Do not incinerate spilled toner or used toner. Toner dust might ignite when exposed to an open  
flame.  
• Wait at least 30 minutes after disconnecting the power plug before removing the transfer unit.  
• Do not incinerate toner (new or used) or toner containers. Doing so risks burns. Toner will ignite  
on contact with naked flame.  
• Keep the polythene materials (bags, gloves, etc.) supplied with this machine away from babies  
and small children at all times. Suffocation can result if polythene materials are brought into  
contact with the mouth or nose.  
• The inside of this machine becomes very hot. Do not touch the parts labeled " " (indicating a  
hot surface).  
9
• Store toner (new or used), toner containers, and components that have been in contact with  
toner out of reach of children.  
Messages on the screen  
• Replace the waste toner bottle when the following message appears on the screen:  
“Replace: Waste Toner Bottle”  
• Prepare a waste toner bottle when the following message appears on the screen:  
“Almost Full Waste Toner Bottle”  
• Waste toner bottles cannot be reused.  
• For easy replacement, we recommend you purchase and store extra waste toner bottles.  
• When removing the waste toner bottle, make sure not to tilt it.  
399  
   
9. Troubleshooting  
• Make sure the transfer unit is installed. If the transfer unit is not installed, install it before turning on  
the power.  
• Comply with the waste toner bottle Recycling Program, whereby used waste toner bottles are  
collected for processing. For details, ask your sales or service representative.  
• Before removing the waste toner bottle from the machine, spread paper or similar material around  
the area to keep toner from dirtying your workspace.  
1. Pull the opening lever on the front cover, and then carefully lower the front cover.  
CES141  
2. Slide both levers on the front cover forward.  
9
CER014  
3. Holding the tabs on both ends of the transfer unit, tilt it backwards then lift it up.  
CER015  
400  
Replacing the Waste Toner Bottle  
4. Hold the center of the waste toner bottle, and then carefully pull it partially out without  
tilting it.  
CES073  
5. Pull the waste toner bottle halfway out, grab the bottle firmly, and then pull it straight out.  
CES074  
9
CES075  
To prevent the waste toner bottle touching the intermediate transfer unit (the position shown by the  
arrow in the illustration below), do not lift the bottle while pulling it out.  
401  
9. Troubleshooting  
CES076  
6. Close the bottle cap.  
CER039  
9
CER089  
7. Hold the center of the new waste toner bottle, and then carefully insert it halfway into the  
machine body.  
Leave the bottle cap open.  
402  
Replacing the Waste Toner Bottle  
CES078  
To prevent the waste toner bottle touching the intermediate transfer unit (the position shown by the  
arrow in the illustration below), do not lift the bottle while inserting it.  
CES079  
8. Push in the waste toner bottle until it clicks into place.  
Push the middle part all the way in.  
9
CES080  
403  
9. Troubleshooting  
9. Place the transfer unit down on the front cover.  
CES081  
10. Slide the transfer unit along the guide rails into the machine. When it stops, push on the  
PUSH mark until it clicks into place.  
CER017  
11. Using both hands, carefully push up the front cover until it closes.  
9
CES142  
• When closing the front cover, push the upper area of the cover firmly.  
404  
10. Maintenance  
This chapter describes how to maintain the machine.  
Cleaning  
Cautions to Take When Cleaning  
• Do not remove any covers or screws other than those explicitly mentioned in this manual. Inside  
this machine are high voltage components that are an electric shock hazard and laser  
components that could cause blindness. Contact your sales or service representative if any of the  
machine's internal components require maintenance, adjustment, or repair.  
• Do not attempt to disassemble or modify this machine. Doing so risks burns and electric shock.  
Note again that exposure to the laser components inside this machine risks blindness.  
• The inside of this machine becomes very hot. Do not touch the parts labeled " " (indicating a  
hot surface).  
• Be sure to disconnect the plug from the wall outlet and clean the prongs and the area around  
the prongs at least once a year. Allowing dust to build up on the plug constitutes a fire hazard.  
Clean the machine periodically to maintain high print quality.  
Dry wipe the exterior with a soft cloth. If dry wiping is not enough, wipe with a soft, damp cloth that is  
wrung out well. If you still cannot remove the stain or grime, use a neutral detergent, wipe over the area  
with a well-wrung damp cloth, and then dry wipe the area and allow it to dry.  
10  
• To avoid deformation, discoloration, or cracking, do not use volatile chemicals, such as benzine  
and thinner, or spray insecticide on the machine.  
• If there is dust or grime inside the machine, wipe with a clean, dry cloth.  
• You must disconnect the plug from the wall outlet at least once a year. Clean away any dust and  
grime from the plug and outlet before reconnecting. Accumulated dust and grime pose a fire  
hazard.  
• Do not allow paper clips, staples, or other small objects to fall inside the machine.  
405  
       
10. Maintenance  
Cleaning the Toner Density Sensor  
Clean the machine when the error message instructing you to do so appears.  
This procedure explains how to clean the toner density sensor of the yellow print cartridge as an  
example of how to clean a sensor.  
• The inside of this machine becomes very hot. Do not touch the parts labeled " " (indicating a  
hot surface).  
1. Pull up the lever on the top cover, and then carefully raise the top cover.  
Make sure that the ADF is closed.  
CES138  
2. Lift out the rearmost print cartridge.  
10  
CES086  
406  
   
Cleaning  
3. Slide the toner density sensor lever once to the left.  
CER056  
Slide the lever only once.  
4. Carefully insert the print cartridge removed in step 2 vertically.  
CES088  
5. Using both hands, hold the center of the top cover and close the cover carefully. Be  
careful not to trap your fingers.  
After closing the top cover, wait until the initial screen is displayed.  
10  
CES140  
407  
10. Maintenance  
Cleaning the Friction Pad and Paper Feed Roller  
If the friction pad or paper feed roller is dirty, a multi-feed or jam might occur. In this case, clean the  
friction pad and paper feed roller as follows:  
• Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet before you move the machine. While moving the  
machine, take care that the power cord is not damaged under the machine. Failing to take these  
precautions could result in fire or electric shock.  
• Do not pull out the paper tray forcefully. If you do, the tray might fall and cause an injury.  
• Do not put your hands inside the machine when the input tray is removed. Some internal parts  
become hot and are a burn hazard.  
• Do not use chemical cleaning fluids or organic solvents such as thinner or benzine.  
1. Turn off the power.  
2. Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet. Remove all the cables from the machine.  
3. Pull out tray 1 carefully with both hands.  
10  
CES059  
Place the tray on a flat surface. If there is paper in the tray, remove it.  
408  
   
Cleaning  
4. Wipe the friction pad with a damp cloth.  
CER058  
5. Wipe the rubber part of the roller with a soft damp cloth. After that, wipe it with a dry  
cloth to remove the moisture.  
CES146  
6. Push the metal plate down until it clicks into place to lock it.  
10  
CER031  
409  
10. Maintenance  
7. Reload the removed paper into the tray, and then push the tray carefully into the machine  
until it clicks into place.  
CES062  
8. Insert the plug of the power cord into the wall socket securely. Connect all the interface  
cables that were removed.  
9. Turn on the power.  
• If jams or multi-sheet feeds occur after cleaning the friction pad, contact your sales or service  
representative.  
• If the optional tray 2 is installed, clean its friction pad and paper feed roller in the same way as you  
did for tray 1.  
Cleaning the Registration Roller and Paper Tray  
The registration roller and paper tray can become dirty with paper dust if you print to non-standard  
paper.  
Clean the registration roller if white dots appear on prints.  
10  
• Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet before you move the machine. While moving the  
machine, take care that the power cord is not damaged under the machine. Failing to take these  
precautions could result in fire or electric shock.  
• The inside of this machine becomes very hot. Do not touch the parts labeled " " (indicating a  
hot surface).  
• Do not pull out the paper tray forcefully. If you do, the tray might fall and cause an injury.  
410  
   
Cleaning  
• Do not put your hands inside the machine when the input tray is removed. Some internal parts  
become hot and are a burn hazard.  
• Do not use chemical cleaning fluids or organic solvents such as thinner or benzine.  
• Do not touch the transcription roller (shown in the illustration below).  
1. Turn off the power.  
2. Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet. Remove all the cables from the machine.  
3. Pull out tray 1 carefully with both hands.  
10  
CES059  
Place the tray on a flat surface. If there is paper in the tray, remove it.  
411  
10. Maintenance  
4. Wipe the inside of the paper tray with a cloth.  
CER217  
5. Push the metal plate down until it clicks into place to lock it.  
CER031  
6. Reload the removed paper into the tray, and then push the tray carefully into the machine  
until it clicks into place.  
10  
CES062  
412  
Cleaning  
7. Pull the opening lever on the front cover, and then carefully lower the front cover.  
CES141  
Be sure to set the registration roller in the position shown by the arrow in the illustration below.  
CES089  
Clean the registration roller if prints are smeared after a paper jam is cleared.  
8. Clean the registration roller by applying a soft damp cloth while turning it.  
9. Using both hands, carefully push up the front cover until it closes.  
10  
CES142  
10. Plug in the power cord securely. Connect all the interface cables that were removed.  
11. Turn on the power.  
• When closing the front cover, push the upper area of the cover firmly.  
413  
10. Maintenance  
Cleaning the Exposure Glass  
The following procedure describes how to clean the exposure glass.  
1. Lift the ADF.  
Be careful not to hold the input tray when lifting the ADF, for the tray might be damaged.  
2. Clean the parts indicated with arrows with a soft damp cloth and then wipe the same  
parts with a dry cloth to remove any remaining moisture.  
CES090  
Cleaning the Auto Document Feeder  
The following procedure describes how to clean the ADF.  
1. Lift the ADF.  
Be careful not to hold the input tray when lifting the ADF, for the tray might be damaged.  
2. Clean the parts indicated with arrows with a soft damp cloth and then wipe the same  
parts with a dry cloth to remove any remaining moisture.  
10  
CES091  
414  
       
Moving the Machine  
Moving the Machine  
This section provides cautions that you must follow when moving the machine both short and long  
distances.  
• If you have to move the machine when the optional paper tray unit is attached, do not push on  
the main unit's top section. Doing so can cause the optional paper tray unit to detach, possibly  
resulting in injury.  
• The machine weighs approximately 30.0 kg (66.2 lb.). When moving the machine, use the  
inset grips on both sides, and lift slowly in pairs. The machine will break or cause injury if  
dropped.  
• Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet before you move the machine. While moving the  
machine, take care that the power cord is not damaged under the machine. Failing to take these  
precautions could result in fire or electric shock.  
• When disconnecting the power cord from the wall outlet, always pull the plug, not the cord.  
Pulling the cord can damage the power cord. Use of damaged power cords could result in fire  
or electric shock.  
• When moving the machine after use, do not take out any of the toners, nor the waste toner  
bottle to prevent toner spill inside the machine.  
10  
Repack the machine in its original packing materials when moving it a long distance.  
• Be sure to disconnect all cables from the machine before transporting it.  
• The machine is a precision piece of machinery. Be sure to handle it carefully when moving it.  
• Make sure to move the machine horizontally. Take extra caution when carrying the machine up or  
down stairs.  
• If tray 2 is installed, remove it from the machine, and move them separately.  
• Do not hold onto the tray area when lifting the machine.  
415  
   
10. Maintenance  
Moving over a Short Distance  
• Do not remove the print cartridges when moving the machine.  
1. Be sure to check the following points:  
• The power switch is turned off.  
• The power cord is unplugged from the wall outlet.  
• All other cables are unplugged from the machine.  
2. If tray 2 is installed, remove it.  
3. Return the scanning unit inside the machine to its original position using [Scanner  
Carriage] under [System Settings].  
4. Lift the machine with another person using the inset grips on both sides of the machine,  
and then move it horizontally to the place where you want to use it.  
CES052  
5. If you have removed tray 2, reinstall it.  
10  
• Be sure to hold the machine level while carrying it. To prevent toner from spilling, move the  
machine carefully.  
Moving over a Long Distance  
If you intend to move the machine over a long distance, you must pack it well. Empty all the paper trays,  
but do not remove any print cartridges. Take care not to tip or tilt the machine during transit.  
• Do not remove the print cartridges when moving the machine.  
416  
     
Moving the Machine  
1. Be sure to check the following points:  
• The power switch is turned off.  
• The power cord is unplugged from the wall outlet.  
• All other cables are unplugged from the machine.  
• All paper trays are empty.  
2. If tray 2 is installed, remove it.  
3. Return the scanning unit inside the machine to its original position using [Scanner  
Carriage] under [System Settings].  
• Toner might spill inside the machine if the machine is not kept level during transit.  
• For more information about moving the machine, contact your sales or service representative.  
10  
417  
10. Maintenance  
Disposal  
Ask your sales or service representative for information about correct disposal of this machine.  
10  
418  
 
If the Machine is Not Going to Be Used for a Long Time  
If the Machine is Not Going to Be Used for a  
Long Time  
If the machine is going to be inactive for a long time, follow the procedure shown here.  
• It is dangerous to handle the power cord plug with wet hands. Doing so could result in electric  
shock.  
• The inside of this machine becomes very hot. Do not touch the parts labeled " " (indicating a  
hot surface).  
• Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet before you move the machine. While moving the  
machine, take care that the power cord is not damaged under the machine. Failing to take these  
precautions could result in fire or electric shock.  
Preparing the Machine for a Long Period of Inactivity  
Use this procedure to prepare the machine for a long period of inactivity with its power switch turned off.  
Note that not using the following procedure could result in unusual noises when use of this machine is  
resumed.  
• Do not switch off the machine during printing.  
10  
1. Turn off the power switch.  
2. Pull out the plug from the socket.  
419  
     
10. Maintenance  
3. Pull the opening lever on the front cover, and then carefully lower the front cover.  
CES141  
4. Lower the fusing unit lever.  
CES257  
5. Close the front cover with both hands carefully.  
10  
CES142  
• This step is not necessary if the machine's power switch is on but the machine has been inactive for  
a long time.  
Using the Machine Again After It Has Been Inactive for a Long Period  
Use the following procedure to start using the machine again after it has been inactive for a long period.  
420  
   
If the Machine is Not Going to Be Used for a Long Time  
1. Plug in the power cable.  
2. Pull the opening lever on the front cover, and then carefully lower the front cover.  
CES141  
3. Pull up the fusing unit lever.  
CES258  
4. Close the front cover with both hands carefully.  
10  
CES142  
5. Turn the power switch to “ On”.  
421  
10. Maintenance  
Where to Inquire  
Contact your sales or service representative for further information about topics covered in this manual  
or to inquire about topics not covered in this manual.  
10  
422  
 
Consumables  
Consumables  
• Our products are engineered to meet high standards of quality and functionality, and we  
recommend that you use only the expendable supplies available at an authorized dealer.  
Print Cartridges  
*1  
Print cartridge  
Average printable number of pages per cartridge  
• For Type 1 model:  
2,300 pages  
Black  
• For Type 2 model:  
2,500 pages, 6,500 pages  
• For Type 1 model:  
2,300 pages  
Cyan  
• For Type 2 model:  
2,500 pages, 6,000 pages  
• For Type 1 model:  
2,300 pages  
Magenta  
Yellow  
• For Type 2 model:  
2,500 pages, 6,000 pages  
• For Type 1 model:  
2,300 pages  
10  
• For Type 2 model:  
2,500 pages, 6,000 pages  
The printable number of pages is based on pages that are compliant with ISO/IEC 19798 and the image  
density set as the factory default. ISO/IEC 19798 is an international standard on measurement of printable  
pages, set by the International Organization for Standardization.  
*1  
• If print cartridges are not changed when necessary, printing will become impossible. For easy  
replacement, we recommend you purchase and store extra print cartridges.  
423  
       
10. Maintenance  
• The actual number of printable pages varies depending on the image volume and density, number  
of pages printed at a time, paper type and paper size used, and environmental conditions such as  
temperature and humidity.  
• Print cartridges may need to be changed sooner than indicated above due to deterioration over  
the period of use.  
• Print cartridges (consumables) are not covered by warranty. However, if there is a problem,  
contact the store where they were purchased.  
• When you first use this machine, use the four print cartridges packaged with the machine.  
• The supplied print cartridges are good for approximately 1,000 pages.  
• This machine routinely performs cleaning and uses toner during this operation to maintain quality.  
Waste Toner Bottle  
*1  
Name  
Average printable number of pages  
25,000 pages  
Waste Toner Bottle SP C220  
A4/Letter 5% test chart, 3 pages per job, printing in 50% black and white/color.  
*1  
• The actual number of printable pages varies depending on the image volume and density, number  
of pages printed at a time, paper type and paper size used, and environmental conditions such as  
temperature and humidity.  
• If the waste toner bottle is not changed when necessary, printing will become impossible. For easy  
replacement, we recommend you purchase and store extra waste toner bottles.  
10  
424  
   
11. Appendix  
Functions and Network Settings Available in  
an IPv6 Environment  
The functions and network settings of this machine that are available in an IPv6 environment differ from  
those available in an IPv4 environment. Make sure the functions you use are supported in an IPv6  
environment, and then configure the necessary network settings.  
Available Functions  
Print via FTP  
Prints documents via FTP using the EPRT and EPSV commands. Windows Vista/7 and an FTP  
application that supports IPv6 are required to use these commands.  
Printer  
Prints documents using the printer driver.  
Scan to FTP  
Delivers files that have been scanned using the control panel to an FTP server.  
Scan to E-mail  
Sends files scanned using the control panel via e-mail.  
Scan to Folder  
Sends files scanned using the control panel to a shared folder on a computer on the network.  
This function is not available on Mac OS X.  
Network TWAIN Server  
11  
Controls the scanning function from a computer on the network, and delivers scanned data to the  
computer directly. This function is available only to computers that have a TWAIN-supporting  
application. The IP address of the multi-cast group supported by IPv6 is ff12::fb88:1.  
Bonjour  
Allows the machine to communicate with Bonjour protocol-supported computers on the network.  
The IP address of the multi-cast group supported by IPv6 is ff02::fb.  
LAN-Fax  
Sends a document created in an application as a fax and without printing it.  
425  
       
11. Appendix  
Web Image Monitor  
Allows you to check the machine's status and configure its settings using a Web browser.  
Configuration Page  
Prints a configuration page that shows you the machine's configuration, IP address, and other  
details.  
Internet Fax  
Transmission and reception of Internet Faxes.  
11  
426  
Transmission Using IPsec  
Transmission Using IPsec  
For securer communications, this machine supports the IPsec protocol. When applied, IPsec encrypts  
data packets at the network layer using shared key encryption. The machine uses encryption key  
exchange to create a shared key for both sender and receiver. To achieve even higher security, you can  
also renew the shared key on a validity period basis.  
• IPsec is not applied to data obtained through DHCP, DNS, or WINS.  
• IPsec compatible operating systems are Windows XP SP2, Windows Vista/7, Windows Server  
2003/2003 R2/2008/2008 R2, Mac OS X 10.4.8 and later, Red Hat Enterprise Linux WS 4.0,  
and Solaris 10. However, some setting items are not supported depending on the operating  
system. Make sure the IPsec settings you specify are consistent with the operating system's IPsec  
settings.  
• If you cannot access Web Image Monitor due to IPsec configuration problems, disable IPsec under  
[Admin. Tools] on the control panel, and then access Web Image Monitor.  
Encryption and Authentication by IPsec  
IPsec consists of two main functions: the encryption function, which ensures the confidentiality of data,  
and the authentication function, which verifies the sender of the data and the data's integrity. This  
machine's IPsec function supports two security protocols: the ESP protocol, which enables both of the  
IPsec functions at the same time, and the AH protocol, which enables only the authentication function.  
ESP Protocol  
11  
The ESP protocol provides secure transmission through both encryption and authentication. This  
protocol does not provide header authentication.  
• For successful encryption, both the sender and receiver must specify the same encryption  
algorithm and encryption key. The encryption algorithm and encryption key are specified  
automatically.  
• For successful authentication, the sender and receiver must specify the same authentication  
algorithm and authentication key. The authentication algorithm and authentication key are  
specified automatically.  
427  
       
11. Appendix  
AH Protocol  
The AH protocol provides secure transmission through authentication of packets only, including  
headers.  
• For successful authentication, the sender and receiver must specify the same authentication  
algorithm and authentication key. The authentication algorithm and authentication key are  
specified automatically.  
AH Protocol + ESP Protocol  
When combined, the ESP and AH protocols provide secure transmission through both encryption  
and authentication. These protocols provide header authentication.  
• For successful encryption, both the sender and receiver must specify the same encryption  
algorithm and encryption key. The encryption algorithm and encryption key are specified  
automatically.  
• For successful authentication, the sender and receiver must specify the same authentication  
algorithm and authentication key. The authentication algorithm and authentication key are  
specified automatically.  
• Some operating systems use the term "Compliance" in place of "Authentication".  
Security Association  
This machine uses encryption key exchange as the key setting method. With this method, agreements  
such as the IPsec algorithm and key must be specified for both sender and receiver. Such agreements  
form what is known as an SA (Security Association). IPsec communication is possible only if the  
receiver's and sender's SA settings are identical.  
The SA settings are auto configured on both parties' machines. However, before the IPsec SA can be  
established, the ISAKMP SA (Phase 1) settings must be auto configured. When this is done, the IPsec SA  
(Phase 2) settings, which allow actual IPsec transmission, will be auto configured.  
Also, for further security, the SA can be periodically auto updated by applying a validity period (time  
limit) for its settings. This machine only supports IKEv1 for encryption key exchange.  
11  
Multiple settings can be configured in the SA.  
Settings 1-10  
You can configure ten separate sets of SA details (such as different shared keys and IPsec  
algorithms).  
IPsec policies are searched through one by one, starting at [No.1].  
428  
   
Transmission Using IPsec  
Encryption Key Exchange Settings Configuration Flow  
This section explains the procedure for specifying encryption key exchange settings.  
Machine  
PC  
1. Set the same IPsec settings as the machine on  
PC.  
1. Set the IPsec settings on Web Image Monitor.  
2. Enable IPsec settings.  
2. Enable IPsec settings.  
3. Confirm IPsec transmission.  
• After configuring IPsec, you can use "ping" command to check if the connection is established  
correctly. Because the response is slow during initial key exchange, it may take some time to  
confirm that transmission has been established.  
• If you cannot access Web Image Monitor due to IPsec configuration problems, disable IPsec on  
the control panel, and then access Web Image Monitor.  
Specifying Encryption Key Exchange Settings  
1. Start the Web browser, and access the machine by entering its IP address.  
2. Click [IPsec Settings].  
3. Click the [IPsec Policy List] tab.  
4. Select the number of the setting you want to modify in the list, and then click [Change].  
5. Modify the IPsec related settings as necessary.  
11  
6. Enter the administrator password, and then click [Apply].  
7. Click the [IPsec Global Settings] tab, and then select [Active] in [IPsec Function].  
8. If necessary, specify [Default Policy], [Broadcast and Multicast Bypass], and [All ICMP  
Bypass] also.  
9. Enter the administrator password, and then click [Apply].  
429  
     
11. Appendix  
Specifying IPsec Settings on the Computer  
Specify exactly the same settings for IPsec SA settings on your computer as are specified for the IPsec  
Settings on the machine. Setting methods differ according to the computer's operating system. The  
following procedure is based on Windows XP in an IPv4 environment as an example.  
1. On the [Start] menu, click [Control Panel], [Performance and Maintenance], and then  
click [Administrative Tools].  
2. Double-click [Local Security Policy].  
3. Click [IP Security Policies on Local Computer].  
4. In the "Action" menu, click [Create IP Security Policy].  
The IP Security Policy Wizard appears.  
5. Click [Next].  
6. Enter a security policy name in "Name", and then click [Next].  
7. Clear the "Activate the default response rule" check box, and then click [Next].  
8. Select "Edit properties", and then click [Finish].  
9. In the "General" tab, click [Advanced].  
10. In "Authenticate and generate a new key after every", enter the same validity period (in  
minutes) that is specified on the machine in [IKE Life Time], and then click [Methods].  
11. Confirm that the Encryption Algorithm ("Encryption"), Hash Algorithm ("Integrity"), and  
IKE Diffie-Hellman Group ("Diffie-Hellman Group") settings in "Security method  
preference order" all match those specified on the machine in [IKE Settings].  
If the settings are not displayed, click [Add].  
12. Click [OK] twice.  
13. Click [Add] in the "Rules" tab.  
The Security Rule Wizard appears.  
14. Click [Next].  
15. Select "This rule does not specify a tunnel", and then click [Next].  
16. Select the type of network for IPsec, and then click [Next].  
11  
17. Select "Use this string to protect the key exchange (preshared key)", and then enter the  
same PSK text specified on the machine with the pre-shared key.  
18. Click [Next].  
19. Click [Add] in the IP Filter List.  
20. In [Name], enter an IP Filter name, and then click [Add].  
The IP Filter Wizard appears.  
21. Click [Next].  
430  
 
Transmission Using IPsec  
22. Select "My IP Address" in "Source address", and then click [Next].  
23. Select "A specific IP Address" in "Destination address", enter the machine's IP address,  
and then click [Next].  
24. For the IPsec protocol type, select "Any", and then click [Next].  
25. Click [Finish].  
26. Click [OK].  
27. Select the IP filter that you have just created, and then click [Next].  
28. Select the IPsec security filter, and then click [Edit].  
29. In the "Security Methods" tab, check "Negotiate security" and then click [Add].  
30. Select "Custom" and click [Settings].  
31. When [ESP] is selected for the machine in [Security Protocol] under [IPsec Settings], select  
[Data integrity and encryption (ESP)], and configure the following settings:  
Set the value of [Integrity algorithm] to the same value as the [Authentication Algorithm for ESP]  
specified on the machine.  
Set the value of [Encryption algorithm] to the same value as the [Encryption Algorithm for ESP]  
specified on the machine.  
32. When [AH] is selected for the machine in [Security Protocol] under [IPsec Settings], select  
[Data and address integrity without encryption (AH)], and configure the following  
settings:  
Set the value of [Integrity algorithm] to the same value as the [Authentication Algorithm for AH]  
specified on the machine.  
Clear the [Data integrity and encryption (ESP)] check box.  
33. When [ESP&AH] is selected for the machine in [Security Protocol] under [IPsec Settings],  
select [Data and address integrity without encryption (AH)], and configure the following  
settings:  
Set the value of [Integrity algorithm] under [Data and address integrity without encryption (AH)] to  
the same value as [Authentication Algorithm for AH] specified on the machine.  
Set the value of [Encryption algorithm] under [Data integrity and encryption (ESP)] to the same  
value as [Encryption Algorithm for ESP] specified on the machine.  
11  
34. In the Session key settings, select "Generate a new key every", and enter the same  
validity period (in seconds or Kbytes) as that specified for [Life Time] on the machine.  
35. Click [OK] three times.  
36. Click [Next].  
37. Click [Finish].  
If you are using IPv6 under Windows Vista or a newer version of Windows, you must repeat this  
procedure from step 13 and specify ICMPv6 as an exception. When you reach step 24, select  
431  
11. Appendix  
[58] as the protocol number for the "Other" target protocol type, and then set [Negotiate security]  
to [Permit].  
38. Click [OK].  
39. Click [Close].  
The new IP security policy (IPsec settings) is specified.  
40. Select the security policy that you have just created, right click on it, and then click  
[Assign].  
IPsec settings on the computer are enabled.  
• To disable the computer's IPsec settings, select the security policy, right click, and then click [Un-  
assign].  
Enabling and Disabling IPsec Using the Control Panel  
1. Press the [User Tools] key.  
2. Press the [ ][ ] key to select [Admin. Tools], and then press the [OK] key.  
3. If you are requested to enter a password, enter the password using the number keys,  
and then press the [OK] key.  
4. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [IPsec], and then press the [OK] key.  
5. Press the [ ][ ] keys to select [Active] or [Inactive], and then press the [OK] key.  
6. Press the [Clear/Stop] key to return to the initial screen.  
• A password for accessing the [Admin. Tools] menu can be specified in [Admin. Tools Lock].  
• You can press the [Escape] key to exit to the previous level of the menu tree.  
11  
432  
 
Specifications of the Machine  
Specifications of the Machine  
This section lists the machine's specifications.  
General Function Specifications  
Configuration  
Desktop  
Print process  
Laser electrostatic transfer  
Maximum paper size for scanning  
• Exposure glass  
1
A4, Letter (8 / " × 11 ")  
2
• ADF  
1
Legal (8 / " × 14 ")  
2
Maximum paper size for printing  
1
Legal (8 / " × 14 ")  
2
Warm-up time  
Less than 30 seconds (23 °C, 71.6 °F)  
Paper sizes  
• Standard paper sizes  
A4, B5 JIS, A5, A6, Legal (8 / " × 14 "), Letter (8 / " × 11 "), Half Letter (5 / " × 8 /  
2
1
1
1
1
2
2
1
2
1
1
1
"), Executive (7 / " × 10 / "), 8 " × 13 ", B6 JIS, 8 / " × 13 ", Folio (8 / " × 13 "), 16K  
4
2
2
7
4
1
1
1
(195 × 267 mm), Com 10 (4 / "×9 / "), Monarch (3 / " × 7 / "), C5 Env (162 × 229  
8
2
8
2
mm), C6 Env (114 × 162 mm), DL Env (110 × 220 mm)  
• Custom size  
11  
90 to 216 mm (3.54 to 8.5 inches) in width, 148 to 356 mm (5.83 to 14.0 inches) in length  
• Duplex supported paper sizes  
1
1
1
1
A4, B5 JIS, Legal (8 / " × 14 "), Letter (8 / " × 11 "), Executive (7 / " × 10 / ")  
2
2
4
2
Paper output capacity  
2
Standard 150 sheets (80 g/m , 20 lb.)  
Paper input capacity  
• Tray 1  
2
250 sheets (80 g/m , 20 lb.)  
433  
     
11. Appendix  
• Tray 2 (option)  
2
500 sheets (80 g/m , 20 lb.)  
• Bypass tray  
2
One sheet (80 g/m , 20 lb.)  
ADF capacity  
35 sheets (80 g/m , 20 lb.)  
Paper weight  
• Tray 1  
2
2
60 to 160 g/m (16 to 42 lb.)  
• Tray 2 (option)  
2
60 to 105 g/m (16 to 28 lb.)  
• Bypass tray  
2
60 to 160 g/m (16 to 42 lb.)  
Memory  
256 MB (128 MB for printer functions only)  
Power requirements  
220-240 V, 6 A, 50/60 Hz (when fully equipped)  
120 V, 11 A, 60 Hz (when fully equipped)  
Power consumption  
• Maximum power consumption  
1300 W  
• Energy Saver mode 1  
80 W  
11  
• Energy Saver mode 2  
10 W  
Machine dimensions (Width × Depth × Height)  
*1  
*1  
420 × 493 × 476 mm (16.6 × 19.5 × 18.8 inches)  
If tray 2 is installed, the height increases by 125 mm (5.0 inches).  
*1  
Weight (machine body with consumables)  
Approximately 30.0 kg (66.2 lb.)  
434  
Specifications of the Machine  
Printer Function Specifications  
Printing speed  
• Type 1 model  
Black and white: 16 pages per minute (A4/Letter)  
Color: 16 pages per minute (A4/Letter)  
• Type 2 model  
Black and white: 20 pages per minute (A4), 21 pages per minute (Letter)  
Color: 20 pages per minute (A4), 21 pages per minute (Letter)  
Resolution  
600 dpi (Maximum: 2400 × 600 dpi)  
First print speed  
14 seconds or less (A4/Letter, 600 × 600 dpi)  
Interface  
• Ethernet (10BASE-T, 100BASE-TX)  
• USB 2.0  
Printer language  
• Type 1 model  
DDST, PictBridge  
• Type 2 model  
PCL6, PCL5c, PostScript 3, PictBridge  
Fonts  
• Type 1 model  
Not installed  
• Type 2 model  
80 fonts  
11  
Network protocol  
TCP/IP, IPP, Bonjour  
Copier Function Specifications  
Maximum resolution (scanning and printing)  
• Exposure glass  
Scanning: 600 × 600 dpi  
435  
       
11. Appendix  
Printing: 600 × 600 dpi  
• ADF  
Scanning: 600 × 300 dpi  
Printing: 600 × 600 dpi  
Gradation  
Scanning: 256 levels (1 dot)  
Printing: Two-value (1 dot)  
First copy speed (A4/Letter, at 25 °C, 77 °F)  
30 seconds or less  
Multiple copy speed  
Black and white: 20 pages per minute  
Color: 20 pages per minute  
Reproduction ratio  
Fixed ratio: 50%, 71%, 82%, 93%, 122%, 141%, 200%, 400%  
Zoom ratio: 25 to 400% (600 × 300 dpi, 600 × 600 dpi)  
Fixed ratio: 50%, 65%, 78%, 93%, 129%, 155%, 200%, 400%  
Zoom ratio: 25 to 400% (600 × 300 dpi, 600 × 600 dpi)  
Copy quantity  
99  
Scanner Function Specifications  
Maximum scanning area (horizontal × vertical)  
• Exposure glass  
11  
216 × 297 mm (8.5 × 11.7 inches)  
• ADF  
216 × 356 mm (8.5 × 14.1 inches)  
Maximum resolution when scanning from the control panel (Scan to E-mail, Scan to FTP, Scan  
to Folder, Scan to USB)  
• Exposure glass  
600 × 600 dpi  
• ADF  
436  
   
Specifications of the Machine  
600 × 600 dpi  
Maximum resolution when scanning from a computer (TWAIN)  
• Exposure glass  
19200 × 19200 dpi  
• ADF  
600 × 600 dpi  
Maximum resolution when scanning from a computer (WIA)  
• Exposure glass  
600 × 600 dpi  
• ADF  
600 × 600 dpi  
Gradation  
Input: 16 bit color processing  
Output: 8 bit color processing  
Scanning time  
Black and white: 5 seconds or less  
Color: 10 seconds or less (A4/200 dpi/Compressed)  
Not including transfer time.  
ADF throughput  
Black and white: 120 mm per second  
Color: 60 mm per second (200 dpi)  
Interface  
• Scanning from the control panel  
Ethernet (10BASE-T, 100BASE-TX), USB2.0 (Scan to USB)  
• Scanning from a computer  
Ethernet (10BASE-T, 100BASE-TX), USB 2.0  
Sendable file formats  
11  
TIFF, JPEG, PDF  
Address book  
Maximum 100 items  
Number of redials: 1  
437  
11. Appendix  
Fax Function Specifications  
Fax transmission and reception  
Access line  
• Public switched telephone networks (PSTN)  
• Private branch exchange (PBX)  
Transmission mode  
ITU-T Group 3 (G3)  
Scan line density  
8 dots per mm × 3.85 line per mm (200 × 100 dpi)  
8 dots per mm × 7.7 line per mm (200 × 200 dpi)  
Transmission time  
3–4 seconds (8 dots per mm × 3.85 line per mm, 33.6 kbps, MMR, ITU-T # 1 chart)  
Transfer rate  
33.6 kbps to 2400 bps (auto shift down system)  
Data compression method  
MH, MR, MMR, JBIG  
Memory capacity  
More than 100 sheets (8 dots per mm × 3.85 line per mm)  
Address book  
• Speed dial  
200 items  
• Quick dial  
20 items  
• Number of redials for Fax  
1
11  
Internet Fax transmission and reception  
Interface  
Ethernet (10BASE-T, 100BASE-TX)  
Communication protocols  
• Transmission  
438  
     
Specifications of the Machine  
SMTP, TCP/IP  
• Reception  
POP3, TCP/IP  
Transmission function  
E-mail  
E-mail format  
Single/Multi-part, MIME Conversion  
Attached file forms (transmission): TIFF-S (MH encoding)  
Attached file forms (reception): TIFF-S/TIFF-F (MH/MR/MMR encoding)  
Authentication method  
SMTP-AUTH, POP before SMTP, A-POP  
Original size  
A4 (Length is up to 356 mm)  
Scan line density  
8 dots per mm × 3.85 line per mm (200 × 100 dpi)  
8 dots per mm × 7.7 line per mm (200 × 200 dpi)  
Destination machine specifications  
• Communication protocols  
• Transmission  
SMTP, TCP/IP  
• Reception  
POP3, TCP/IP  
• E-mail format  
• Format  
MIME, Base64  
11  
• Content-Type  
Image/tiff  
Multipart/mixed (text/plain, Image/tiff (attached file forms))  
• Data format  
• Profile  
TIFF-S  
• Encoding  
MH  
439  
11. Appendix  
• Original size  
A4  
• Resolution (dpi)  
200 × 100, 200 × 200  
11  
440  
Specifications of Options  
Specifications of Options  
This section lists the specifications of the various options.  
Paper Feed Unit TK1010  
Paper capacity  
500 sheets  
Paper size  
1
A4, Letter (8 / ” × 11”)  
2
Dimensions (Width × Depth × Height)  
400 × 450 × 127 mm (15.8 × 17.8 × 5 inches)  
Paper weight  
2
60 to 105 g/m (16 to 28 lb.)  
Weight  
Less than 4 kg (8.9 lb.)  
11  
441  
       
11. Appendix  
Electromagnetic Interference  
If this machine is located close to another electronic device, both devices may malfunction due  
electromagnetic interference.  
Televisions and radios may produce noise if located too close to this machine. If this happens, do the  
following:  
• Move the television or radio as far as possible from the machine.  
• Change the position of the antenna of the television or radio.  
• Use a different wall outlet on a different circuit.  
11  
442  
   
Copyright Information about Installed Applications  
Copyright Information about Installed  
Applications  
expat  
Copyright (c) 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai Open Source Software Centre, Ltd. and Clark Cooper.  
Copyright (c) 2001, 2002 Expat maintainers.  
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this software and  
associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including  
without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell  
copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the  
following conditions:  
The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or substantial  
portions of the Software.  
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR  
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS  
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR  
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN  
AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN  
CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.  
JPEG LIBRARY  
• The software installed on this product is based in part on the work of the Independent JPEG Group.  
11  
443  
           
11. Appendix  
11  
444  
INDEX  
Cleaning............................405, 406, 408, 410, 414  
Clear/Stop key.....................................................38  
Color paper...........................................................90  
Color Start key.......................................................38  
Colour adjustment...............................................254  
Colour registration..............................................274  
Communication settings......................................265  
Community...........................................................333  
Compression (Colour)........................................260  
Confidential document........................................143  
Configuration page...........................287, 288, 345  
Consumables.......................................................423  
Control panel..................................................34, 38  
Copier function.............................................24, 435  
Copier mode..........................................................38  
Copy key.................................................38, 60, 157  
Copy settings.......................................................253  
Copyright information.........................................443  
Counter information............................................310  
Country................................................................295  
Cover for the exposure glass................................34  
Cover sheet.................................................232, 233  
Coverage.............................................................310  
2 in 1.............................................................25, 164  
2-sided copy.................................................26, 169  
4 in 1.............................................................25, 164  
A
About originals....................................................122  
Address book..............................................177, 272  
Address book (LAN-Fax)........223, 224, 225, 226,  
Address Book key..................................................38  
ADF (Auto Document Feeder)....34, 122, 125, 414  
Adjust sound volume...........................................274  
Admin. tools lock.................................................295  
Administrator e-mail address.............................347  
Administrator password......................................347  
Administrator settings.................................295, 347  
Alert indicator........................................................38  
Anti-humidity level...............................................274  
Authentication......................................................427  
Authorized reception................245, 246, 318, 326  
Auto cleaning......................................................274  
Auto continue.......................................................274  
Auto e-mail notification settings.........................332  
Auto redial...........................................................263  
D
Date and time settings.........................................351  
Date setting.........................................201, 295, 351  
Default settings....................................................348  
Delete TX standby file.........................................265  
Density......................172, 192, 220, 254, 260, 263  
Density key.............................................................38  
Destinations..........................................................203  
DHCP...............................................................74, 77  
Dial/Push phone.................................................295  
Digital camera..............................................24, 149  
Digital camera connection....................................68  
Direct printing......................................................149  
Disclaimer..............................................................13  
DNS setting..........................................................331  
Document type....................................................173  
Duplex..................................................................310  
Duplex copy........................................................254  
B
B&W print priority......................................274, 324  
B&W scanning mode..........................................260  
B&W Start key.......................................................38  
Backup settings....................................................348  
Bidirectional communication.....................135, 136  
Bond paper............................................................90  
Broadcast.............................................................217  
Button for sliding the ADF.....................................35  
Bypass tray....................................................34, 111  
Bypass tray setting priority.................................316  
C
Cable cover...........................................................35  
Cancel fax...................................................213, 231  
Cancel print job..........................................141, 142  
Cardstock...............................................................90  
Characters...........................................................127  
445  
 
Feature highlights..................................................22  
File type................................................................260  
Forwarding..................................................241, 242  
Friction pad..........................................................408  
Front cover.............................................................34  
Function priority............................................60, 295  
E
E-mail notification 1............................................332  
E-mail notification 2............................................332  
Economy color prints..........................................310  
Electromagnetic interference..............................442  
Encryption............................................................427  
Encryption key exchange...................................429  
Energy saver..........................................................61  
Energy saver mode....................................295, 351  
Enlarged copy..............................................24, 162  
Envelope......................................90, 113, 114, 117  
Error messages....................................................383  
Escape key.............................................................38  
Ethernet..........................................................69, 283  
Ethernet port....................................................35, 69  
expat....................................................................443  
Exposure glass.....................................34, 124, 414  
Extender for the ADF tray.....................................34  
Exterior.............................................................34, 35  
External telephone...............................32, 218, 219  
External telephone connector...............................35  
G
G3 (analog) line interface connector..................35  
Gateway..............................................................283  
General status.....................................................328  
Group (LAN-Fax)................................................226  
H
How to read this manual.......................................18  
I
I/O timeout.................................................274, 323  
ID card copy.................................................26, 166  
ID Card Copy key.................................................38  
IKE settings...........................................................340  
Image quality.......................................................173  
Image Quality key.................................................38  
Immediate transmission.......................................209  
Immediate TX.......................................................263  
Initial setup.............................................................59  
Input tray for the ADF............................................34  
Installing the machine............................................43  
Interior....................................................................37  
Internet Fax.........................................210, 240, 438  
Internet Fax settings.............................................337  
IP address...............................................18, 74, 283  
IPsec.....................................................................295  
IPsec global settings............................................339  
IPsec policy..........................................................340  
IPsec settings........................................................339  
IPsec transmission................................................427  
IPv4 configuration...............................................283  
IPv6 configuration...............................................283  
IPv6 environment.................................................425  
IPv6 settings.........................................................329  
F
Facsimile key..........................................38, 60, 199  
Fax destinations......203, 204, 205, 206, 208, 214,  
Fax feature settings.............................................265  
Fax function...................................................31, 438  
Fax journal.........................................287, 291, 345  
Fax mode...............................................................38  
Fax number confirmation...........................295, 318  
Fax only mode.....................................................239  
Fax printing..........................................................244  
Fax received file processing...............................318  
Fax Received indicator.........................................38  
Fax Speed Dial Dest...........................................272  
Fax Speed Dial destination list..................287, 345  
Fax transmission..........................................209, 211  
Fax transmission settings.....................................262  
Fax TX/RX standby file list..................................345  
FAX/TAD mode..................................................240  
FAX/TEL automatic mode...................................239  
FAX/TEL manual mode.......................................238  
J
JPEG LIBRARY......................................................443  
446  
Network settings............................74, 76, 283, 328  
Network status.....................................................328  
Note.......................................................................18  
Notify toner almost empty..................................274  
Number keys..........................................................38  
L
Label paper............................................................90  
LAN-Fax.......................................32, 223, 230, 234  
LAN-Fax driver properties..................................235  
Language....................................................295, 308  
LED lamps...............................................................70  
Legal size.............................................................103  
Letterhead..............................................................90  
Limitless scan........................................................260  
List of option...........................................................17  
List/Test print.......................................................300  
Loading paper......................................99, 108, 111  
Locked Print.........................23, 143, 144, 145, 146  
Long period of inactivity.............................419, 420  
O
OK key...................................................................38  
On Hook Dial......................................................218  
On Hook Dial key.................................................38  
One Touch buttons...............................38, 186, 215  
Operation modes..................................................60  
Options..........................................................83, 441  
Original type.......................................................254  
Output tray.............................................................34  
Output tray for the ADF.........................................34  
Outside line access number..................................80  
M
Mac OS X..........................................136, 138, 195  
Machine counter.................................................310  
Machine information...........................................314  
Machine location..................................................43  
Maintenance page.....................................287, 345  
Manual IP address..........................................75, 78  
Manuals..............................................14, 19, 20, 21  
Max. e-mail size..................................................260  
mDNS setting.......................................................330  
Memory reception......................................241, 243  
Memory transmission..........................................209  
Menu chart..........................................................249  
Menu screen........................................................247  
Middle Thick paper...............................................90  
Missing image area............................................123  
Model types...........................................................15  
Model-specific information...................................15  
Moving........................................................415, 416  
Multi-access...........................................................62  
Multiple pages....................................................164  
P
Page counter........................................................310  
Paper capacity.......................................................86  
Paper feed roller.................................................408  
Paper Feed Unit TK1010.............................83, 441  
Paper jam..........................358, 359, 361, 363, 364  
Paper mismatch..........................................140, 141  
Paper recommendations.....................................122  
Paper settings.......................................................316  
Paper size.............................................86, 118, 120  
Paper storage........................................................97  
Paper tray............................................................309  
Paper type...............................86, 90, 96, 118, 119  
Paper weight..........................................................86  
Pause time............................................................263  
Pause/Redial key.........................................38, 186  
PBX...................................................................71, 80  
PBX access number.............................................295  
PCL menu.............................................................300  
PictBridge..............................24, 68, 149, 150, 151  
Placing originals.........................................122, 124  
Plain paper.............................................................90  
POP3 settings.......................................................336  
Power cord.............................................................56  
Power indicator......................................................38  
Power off................................................................56  
N
Names and functions............................................34  
Network application...........................................330  
Network connection.......................................22, 69  
Network print setting...........................................330  
Network printer.....................................................82  
447  
Power on................................................................56 Restrict user function.........129, 131, 132, 133, 327  
Power socket..........................................................35  
S
Power switch....................................................35, 56  
SA.........................................................................428  
Preprinted paper...................................................90  
Scan destinations..............177, 182, 183, 186, 325  
Prepunched paper.................................................90  
Scan settings.......................................172, 190, 220  
Presto! PageManager.........................................194  
Scan size.....................................................191, 260  
Print cartridge.......................................37, 393, 423  
Scan to E-mail......................................29, 177, 184  
Print fax header...................................................263  
Scan to Folder......................................30, 177, 184  
Print functions.......................................................153  
Scan to FTP...........................................29, 177, 184  
Print output functions...........................................154  
Scan to USB..................................................31, 187  
Print quality functions..........................................153  
Scanner carriage................................................274  
Printable area........................................................97  
Scanner destination list..............................287, 345  
Printer feature settings.........................................300  
Scanner function...........................................27, 436  
Printer function......................................22, 140, 435  
Scanner journal..................................287, 293, 345  
Printer properties.................................................138  
Scanner key............................................38, 60, 175  
Priority tray..................................................318, 321  
Scanner mode...............................................38, 175  
Program fax information.....................................295  
Scanner send setting...........................................330  
PS menu...............................................................300  
Scanner settings...................................................259  
PSTN................................................................71, 80  
Scanning from a computer.................................194  
PSTN/PBX...........................................................295  
Scanning using the control panel.......................184  
Screen....................................................................38  
Q
Quick Dial.......203, 204, 205, 206, 208, 215, 272 Scroll keys..............................................................38  
Quick Dial Dest...................................................272 Select paper................................................254, 318  
Quick Dial destination list..........................287, 345 Select paper tray........................................265, 318  
Selection key..........................................................38  
R
Set date................................................................351  
Rear cover..............................................................35  
Set date/time......................................................295  
Receiving a fax....................................................237  
Set time.................................................................351  
Reception mode..................................................237  
Shift key..................................................................38  
Reception settings................................................265  
SMTP settings.......................................................335  
Recycled paper.....................................................90  
SNMP settings.....................................................333  
Redial...................................................................217  
Sort.................................................................27, 254  
Reduce/Enlarge..................................................254  
Sound volume adjustment...................................315  
Reduce/Enlarge key....................................38, 162  
Special sender list...............................................287  
Reduced copy...............................................24, 162  
Special senders..........................................245, 326  
Region A model.....................................................15  
Specifications............................433, 435, 436, 438  
Region B model.....................................................15  
Registration roller................................................410  
Status information................................................309  
Report print settings.............................................265  
Status messages..................................................383  
Reports.................................................................287  
Stop fences.............................................................35  
Reset settings...............................................295, 348  
Subnet mask........................................................283  
Resolution..................................193, 221, 260, 263  
Supplies status.....................................................274  
Restore settings....................................................350  
Symbols..................................................................18  
448  
System.........................................................300, 333 WIA scanning...............................................28, 194  
System auto reset timer.......................................295  
System information..............................................309  
System settings............................................274, 315  
T
TCP/IP status.......................................................328  
Telephone line.................................................71, 79  
Telephone network.........................................71, 79  
Thick paper 1.........................................................90  
Thick paper 2.........................................................90  
Thin paper..............................................................90  
Time setting.........................................201, 295, 351  
Toner............................................................309, 393  
Toner density sensor............................................406  
Toner saver mode...............................................322  
Toner saving........................................................274  
Top cover...............................................................34  
Top page.............................................................307  
Trademarks............................................................11  
Transfer unit............................................................37  
Transmission mode..............................................209  
Trap......................................................................333  
Tray 1...............................................................34, 99  
Tray 2......................................................34, 83, 108  
Tray paper settings..............................................274  
TWAIN scanning.................................28, 194, 196  
TX/RX standby file list................................287, 292  
Type 1 model.........................................................15  
Type 2 model.........................................................15  
U
Unpacking..............................................................46  
USB connection........................................22, 67, 68  
USB flash disk port................................................68  
USB port..........................................................35, 67  
User code............................................................133  
User Tools key.......................................................38  
W
Waste toner bottle...............................37, 399, 424  
Web Image Monitor...........................................305  
449  
MEMO  
450  
MEMO  
451  
MEMO  
GB  
US  
452  
EN  
EN  
M1008604A  
© 2011  
EN GB EN US M100-8604A  

Xerox Copycentre C32 Color User Manual
Sanyo Ecoi Spw Cr365gxh56b User Manual
Samsung Amf09c2e User Manual
NEC MT830 User Manual
Minolta Di2510 User Manual
FUJITSU FS 1108AU User Manual
CRUX SWRGM 49N User Manual
BROTHER HL L2350DW 06 User Manual
ASUS WL 330N3G User Manual
ASUS STRIX H270F User Manual